15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 0 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
California Proposition 65 Warning
WARNING: This product contains or emits
chemicals known to the state of California to cause
cancer and birth defects or other reproductive
harm.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required,
and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the
vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that
have the special equipment, can read the information if they have
access to the vehicle or the EDR.
Event Data Recorders
The data belongs to the vehicle owner and may not be accessed by
anyone else except as legally required or with the permission of the
vehicle owner.
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder (EDR).
The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near
crash-like situations, such as an air bag deployment or hitting a
road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicle’s
systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related
to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of
time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle is
designed to record such data as:
• How various systems in your vehicle were operating;
• Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were
buckled/fastened;
• How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator
and/or brake pedal; and,
• How fast the vehicle was traveling.
These data can help provide a better understanding of the
circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur. NOTE: EDR data
are recorded by your vehicle only if a non-trivial crash situation
occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under normal driving
conditions and no personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and
crash location) are recorded. However, other parties, such as law
enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of
personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash
investigation.
00X31-T7A-6002
Service Diagnostic Recorders
This vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record
information about powertrain performance. The data can be used
to verify emissions law requirements and/or help technicians
diagnose and solve service problems. It may also be combined with
data from other sources for research purposes, but it remains
confidential.
California Perchlorate Contamination Prevention Act
The airbags, seat belt tensioners, and CR type batteries in this
vehicle may contain perchlorate materials - special handling may
apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate/
As you read this manual, you will find information that is preceded
by a NOTICE symbol. This information is intended to help you avoid
damage to your vehicle, other property, or the environment.
2016 I
HR-V
Owner's
Manual Ver.3
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
AOM02134
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 1 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
A Few Words About Safety
You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,
including:
Your safety, and the safety of others, is very important. And
operating this vehicle safely is an important responsibility.
● Safety Labels - on the vehicle.
● Safety Messages - preceded by a safety alert symbol 3 and
one of three signal words: DANGER, WARNING, or CAUTION.
These signal words mean:
To help you make informed decisions about safety, we have
provided operating procedures and other information on labels and
in this manual. This information alerts you to potential hazards that
could hurt you or others.
Of course, it is not practical or possible to warn you about all the
hazards associated with operating or maintaining your vehicle. You
must use your own good judgment.
3DANGER
You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you don't follow instructions.
3WARNING
You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you don't follow instructions.
3CAUTION
You CAN be HURT if you don't follow
instructions.
● Safety Headings - such as Important Safety Precautions.
● Safety Section - such as Safe Driving.
● Instructions - how to use this vehicle correctly and safely.
This entire book is filled with important safety information - please
read it carefully.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 2 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Contents
This owner’s manual should be considered a permanent part of the
vehicle and should remain with the vehicle when it is sold.
This owner’s manual covers all models of your vehicle. You may find
descriptions of equipment and features that are not on your
particular model.
Images throughout this owner’s manual (including the front cover)
represent features and equipment that are available on some, but
not all, models. Your particular model may not have some of these
features.
This owner’s manual is for vehicles sold in the United States and
Canada.
2 Safe Driving P. 29
For Safe Driving P. 30
Seat Belts P. 35
Airbags P. 44
2 Instrument Panel P. 71
Indicators P. 72
Gauges and Displays P. 88
2 Controls P. 93
Clock P. 94
Locking and Unlocking the Doors P. 96
Opening and Closing the Windows P. 119
Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel P. 122
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items P. 150
2 Features P. 175
Audio System P. 176
Audio System Basic Operation P. 182, 203
Customized Features P. 238
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® P. 260, 283
2 Driving P. 313
Before Driving P. 314
Towing a Trailer P. 319
Parking Your Vehicle P. 371
Multi-View Rear Camera P. 372
The information and specifications included in this publication were
in effect at the time of approval for printing. Honda Motor Co., Ltd.
reserves the right, however, to discontinue or change specifications
or design at any time without notice and without incurring any
obligation.
2 Maintenance P. 379
Before Performing Maintenance P. 380
Maintenance MinderTM P. 383
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades P. 407
Heating and Cooling System */Climate Control System * Maintenance P. 424
2 Handling the Unexpected P. 431
Tools P. 432
Overheating P. 449
If a Tire Goes Flat P. 434
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking P. 451
Fuses P. 456
2 Information P. 465
Specifications P. 466
Emissions Testing P. 471
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Identification Numbers P. 468
Warranty Coverages P. 473
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 3 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Contents
Quick Reference Guide
Child Safety P. 57
Exhaust Gas Hazard P. 69
P. 4
Safety Labels P. 70
Opening and Closing the Tailgate P. 113
Opening and Closing the Moonroof * P. 121
Adjusting the Mirrors P. 138
Heating and Cooling System * P. 161
Security System P. 116
Adjusting the Seats P. 140
Climate Control System * P. 165
Audio Error Messages P. 231
General Information on the Audio System P. 235
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines P. 323
Refueling P. 374
When Driving P. 325
Fuel Economy P. 376
Maintenance Under the Hood P. 387
Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 411
Cleaning P. 425
Replacing Light Bulbs P. 399
Battery P. 420
Engine Does Not Start P. 443
Emergency Towing P. 461
Jump Starting P. 446
Shift Lever Does Not Move P. 448
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate P. 462
Devices that Emit Radio Waves P. 469
Authorized Manuals P. 475
Reporting Safety Defects P. 470
Customer Service Information P. 476
Braking P. 363
Accessories and Modifications P. 377
Safe Driving
P. 29
Instrument Panel
P. 71
Controls
P. 93
Features
P. 175
Driving
P. 313
Maintenance
P. 379
Handling the Unexpected
P. 431
Information
P. 465
Index
P. 478
Remote Transmitter Care P. 422
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 4 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Quick Reference Guide
Visual Index
Quick Reference Guide
❙ System Indicators (P72)
❙ Gauges (P88)
❙ Information Display (P89)
❙ Hazard Warning Button
❙ Audio/Information Screen (P183, 204)
❙ Audio System (P176)
❙ Navigation System *
() See the Navigation System Manual
❙ Heating and Cooling System *
(P161)
❙ Climate Control System * (P165)
❙ Rear Window Defogger (P135)
❙ Heated Mirror Button * (P135)
❙ ENGINE START/STOP Button*1 (P123)
❙ Ignition Switch * (P122)
❙ Steering Wheel Adjustments (P137)
❙ ECON Button * (P343)
❙ Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Button * (P360)
❙ (Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®) System OFF) Button (P355)
❙ Heated Windshield Button * (P136)
❙ Lane Departure Warning (LDW) Button * (P352)
❙ Forward Collision Warning (FCW) Button * (P349)
*1 : Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 5 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Headlights/Turn Signals (P127)
❙ Fog Lights * (P130)
❙ LaneWatchTM* (P356)
❙ Paddle Shifter (Shift Down) * (P 339)
❙
(Display) Button * (P204)
❙ (Select/Reset) Knob (P89)
❙ Brightness Control (P134)
❙ Paddle Shifter (Shift Up) * (P339)
❙ Wipers/Washers (P132)
❙ Cruise Control Buttons (P344)
❙ Horn (Press an area around
.)
❙ Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® System
(P260, 283)
❙ Voice Control Buttons (P260, 283)
❙ Navigation System Voice Control Buttons *
() See the Navigation System Manual
❙ Audio Remote Control Buttons (P180)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
* Not available on all models
5
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 6 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Visual Index
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Power Window Switches (P119)
❙ Power Door Lock Master Switch (P107)
❙ Door Mirror Controls (P139)
❙ Interior Fuse Box (P458)
❙ Driver’s Front Airbag (P47)
❙ Passenger’s Front Airbag (P47)
❙ Seat Heater Icons * (P160)
❙ Glove Box (P152)
❙ Shift Lever
Continuously Variable
Transmission * (P334, 336)
Manual Transmission * (P340)
❙ Accessory Power Socket (P156)
❙ USB Port(s) (P177)
❙ HDMI® Port * (P178)
❙ Auxiliary Input Jack * (P178)
❙ Electric Parking Brake Switch (P363)
❙ Automatic Brake Hold Button (P366)
❙ Hood Release Handle (P388)
❙ Fuel Fill Door Release Handle (P375)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
6
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 7 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
❙ Map Lights (P151)
❙ Moonroof Switch * (P121)
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor (P41)
❙ Seat Belts (P35)
❙ Seat Belts (Installing a Child Seat) (P64)
❙ Seat Belt to Secure a Child Seat (P65)
❙ Grab Handle
❙ Coat Hook (P157)
❙ Ceiling Light (P150)
❙ Rearview Mirror (P138)
❙ Sun Visors
❙ Vanity Mirrors
❙ Side Curtain Airbags (P53)
❙ Side Airbags (P51)
❙ Front Seat (P140)
❙ Accessory Power Socket
❙ Rear Seat (P146)
❙ LATCH to Secure a Child Seat (P62)
❙ Cargo Area Light (P151)
❙ Tonneau Cover * (P159)
❙ Cargo Floor Box (P155)
❙ Accessory Power Socket * (P156)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(P156)
* Not available on all models
7
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 8 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Visual Index
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Maintenance Under the Hood (P387)
❙ Windshield Wipers (P132, 407)
❙ Power Door Mirrors (P139)
❙ Side Turn Signal Lights * (P127, 402)
❙ Door Lock/Unlock Control (P99)
❙ Headlights (P127, 399)
❙ Front Turn Signal/Parking Lights (P127, 400)
❙ Front Side Marker Lights (P127, 401)
❙ Tires (P411, 434)
❙ Fog Lights * (P130, 401)
❙ How to Refuel (P375)
❙ High-Mount Brake Light (P405)
❙ Rear Wiper (P133, 409)
❙ Rear License Plate Lights (P406)
❙ Opening/Closing the Tailgate (P113)
❙ Tailgate Release Button (P114)
❙ Lock Button (P101)
❙ Multi-View Rear Camera (P372)
❙ Back-Up Lights (P404)
❙ Brake/Tail/Rear Side Marker Lights (P405)
❙ Rear Turn Signal Lights (P403)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
8
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 9 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Eco Assist System
Quick Reference Guide
Ambient Meter
● Changes color to reflect your driving style.
Green: Fuel efficient driving
Light green: Moderate acceleration/deceleration
White: Aggressive acceleration/deceleration
● The ambient meter color changes in accordance with
your brake or accelerator pedal operation.
● You can change color while the vehicle is at a stop in
ACCESSORY (q , LOCK (0 or VEHICLE OFF with the
ambient meter on. Press the select/reset knob
repeatedly; the color changes from white*1, blue,
purple, pink, red, amber to yellow.
*1 : Default setting
2 Changing Ring Color (P92)
ECON Mode Indicator *
(P81)
Comes on when the ECON button is
pressed.
ECON Button * (P343)
Helps maximize your fuel economy.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
* Not available on all models
9
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 10 ページ
2015年6月29日
Safe Driving
月曜日
午前11時36分
(P 29)
Quick Reference Guide
Airbags (P44)
● Your vehicle is fitted with airbags to help protect you and
your passengers during a moderate-to-severe collision.
Child Safety (P57)
● All children 12 and younger should be seated in the rear seat.
● Smaller children should be properly restrained in a forward-facing child seat.
● Infants must be properly restrained in a rear-facing child seat.
Exhaust Gas Hazard (P69)
● Your vehicle emits dangerous exhaust gases that contain
carbon monoxide. Do not run the engine in confined spaces
where carbon monoxide gas can accumulate.
Seat Belts (P35)
● Fasten your seat belt and sit upright well
back in the seat.
● Check that your passengers are wearing
their seat belts correctly.
Before Driving Checklist (P314)
● Before driving, check that the front seats, head restraints,
steering wheel, and mirrors have been properly adjusted.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
10
Fasten your lap belt as
low as possible.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 11 ページ
2015年6月29日
Instrument Panel
月曜日
午前11時36分
(P71)
Lights Indicators
Fog Light Indicator
*
Speedometer
Information Display
Tachometer
System Indicators
Smart Entry System
Indicator *
High Beam Indicator
Lights On Indicator
U.S.
System Indicators
Canada
Malfunction Indicator
Lamp
Charging System
Indicator
Low Oil Pressure
Indicator
High Temperature
Indicator (Red)
Low Temperature
Indicator (Blue)
Vehicle Stability Assist
(VSA®) System Indicator
VSA® OFF Indicator
Electric Power Steering
(EPS) System Indicator
Automatic Brake Hold
System Indicator
U.S.
Automatic Brake Hold
Indicator
Canada
Electric Parking Brake
System Indicator
U.S.
Canada
Electric Parking Brake
Indicator
Starter System
Indicator *
Security System
Alarm Indicator
M (7-speed manual shift mode)
Indicator/Shift Indicator *
Supplemental Restraint
System Indicator
Immobilizer System
Indicator
Seat Belt Reminder
Indicator
Door and Tailgate
Open Indicator
Quick Reference Guide
Gauges (P88)/Information Display (P89)/System Indicators (P72)
Washer Level Indicator *
Fuel Gauge
Anti-lock Brake System
(ABS) Indicator
Shift Lever Position Indicator *
U.S.
System Indicators
Maintenance Minder
Indicator
Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning
Indicators
ECON Mode
Indicator *
Forward Collision
Warning (FCW)
Indicator *
Lane Departure
Warning (LDW)
Indicator *
System Indicators
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
CRUISE MAIN Indicator
CRUISE CONTROL
Indicator
U.S. models only
Low Tire Pressure/TPMS
Indicator
All-Wheel Drive (AWD)
System Indicator *
Brake System Indicator
(Red)
Canada
U.S.
Brake System Indicator
(Amber)
Canada
Low Fuel Indicator
Continuously variable
transmission models
Brake Depressing
Indicator
Manual transmission models
Brake Depressing
Indicator
* Not available on all models
11
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 12 ページ
Controls
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
(P93)
Quick Reference Guide
Clock (P94)
Models with display audio system
Models with color audio system
Models with navigation system
The navigation system receives signals from
GPS satellites, updating the clock
automatically.
HOME
VOL
Models without navigation system
MENU
BACK
a
Select the
Settings.
a
Press and hold the MENU/CLOCK
button.
b
Select System, Clock, then Clock
Adjustment.
b
Rotate
.
to change hour, then press
c
Touch the 3 / 4 icon to adjust the
numbers up or down.
c
Rotate
press
.
to change minute, then
d
Select OK.
d
Select SET, then press
Clock
The clock in the information display is
automatically updated along with the audio
system’s clock display.
(HOME) icon, then select
.
These indications are used to show how to
operate the LIST/SELECT (List/Selector) knob.
• Rotate
to select.
• Press
to enter.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
12
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 13 ページ
2015年6月29日
ENGINE START/STOP
Button * (P123)
午前11時36分
Turn Signals (P127)
Turn Signal Control Lever
Wipers and Washers
(P132)
Wiper/Washer Control Lever
Right
Adjustment Ring *
: Lower speed, fewer sweeps
: Higher speed, more sweeps
Pull toward
you to spray
washer fluid.
Left
Quick Reference Guide
Press the button to change the vehicle’s
power mode.
月曜日
Lights (P127)
Light Control Switches
High Beam
MIST
OFF
INT: Low speed with intermittent
LO: Low speed wipe
HI: High speed wipe
Low Beam
Flashing
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
* Not available on all models
13
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 14 ページ
2015年6月29日
Steering Wheel (P137)
Quick Reference Guide
● To adjust, pull the adjustment lever
towards you, adjust to the desired
position, then lock the lever back in place.
月曜日
午前11時36分
Unlocking the Front
Doors from the Inside
Tailgate (P113)
(P106)
● Pull either front door inner handle to
unlock and open it in one motion.
To adjust
To lock
Models without smart entry system
● Unlocking and opening the driver’s door
from the inner handle unlocks all the
other doors.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
14
● With all the doors unlocked, press the
tailgate release button and lift open the
tailgate.
Models with smart entry system
● Press the tailgate release button to
unlock and open the tailgate when you
carry the smart entry remote.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 15 ページ
2015年6月29日
Power Door Mirrors
(P139)
Selector Switch
午前11時36分
Power Windows (P119)
● With the ignition switch in ON (w *1, open
and close the power windows.
● If the power window lock button is in the
off position, each passenger’s window
can be opened and closed with its own
switch.
● If the power window lock button is in the
on position (indicator on), each
passenger’s window switch is disabled.
Power Window Lock Button
Quick Reference Guide
● With the ignition switch in ON (w *1, move
the selector switch to L or R.
● Push the appropriate edge of the
adjustment switch to adjust the mirror.
月曜日
Adjustment Switch
Window Switch
Indicator
*1 : Models with the smart entry system have an
ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition
switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 16 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Heating and Cooling System * (P161)
Quick Reference Guide
●
●
●
●
●
Rotate the fan control dial to adjust the fan speed.
Rotate the mode control dial (
/
/
/
/
) to select the vents air flows from.
Rotate the temperature control dial to adjust the temperature.
Rotate the fan control dial to OFF to turn the system off.
Rotate the mode control dial to
to defrost the windshield.
Air flows
from
dashboard
vents.
Air flows from
floor and
dashboard
vents.
Air flows
from floor
vents.
Air flows from
floor and
windshield
defroster vents.
Air flows from
windshield
defroster
vents.
Fan Control Dial
Temperature Control Dial
Mode Control Dial
A/C (Air Conditioning) Button
(Recirculation) Button
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
16
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 17 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Climate Control System * (P165)
Select the AUTO icon to activate the climate control system.
Select the
icon to turn the system on or off.
Select the
icon to defrost the windshield.
The climate control system is voice operable.
() See the Navigation System Manual for complete details.
Quick Reference Guide
●
●
●
●
Models without SYNC icon
Air flows from
dashboard
vents.
Air flows from
floor and
dashboard vents.
Air flows from
floor vents.
Air flows from
floor and
windshield
defroster vents.
Temperature Control Icons
Fan Control Icons
AUTO Icon
(On/Off) Icon
(Windshield Defroster) Icon
A/C (Air Conditioning) Icon
(Fresh Air) Icon
Mode Control Icon
(Recirculation) Icon
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
* Not available on all models
17
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 18 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Models with SYNC icon
Quick Reference Guide
Air flows from
dashboard
vents.
Air flows from
floor and
dashboard vents.
Air flows from
floor vents.
Fan Control Icons
Air flows from
floor and
windshield
defroster vents.
Mode Control Icon
Driver Side Temperature
Control Icons
Passenger Side
Temperature Control
Icons
AUTO Icon
(On/Off) Icon
(Windshield Defroster) Icon
SYNC (Synchronized) Icon
A/C (Air Conditioning) Icon
(Recirculation) Icon
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
18
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 19 ページ
Features
2015年6月29日
(P175)
(P180)
/
Audio System (P176)
Models with color audio system
Audio/Information Screen
Buttons
Button
CD Slot
(CD Eject) Button
(Phone) Button
RADIO Button
SOURCE Button
●
/
Button
Press to adjust the volume up/down.
● SOURCE Button
Press to change the audio mode: FM/AM/
CD/USB/iPod/Bluetooth/Pandora® */AhaTM*/
AUX.
●
/
Button
Radio:Press to change the preset station.
Press and hold to select the next or
previous strong station.
Quick Reference Guide
Audio Remote Controls
/
午前11時36分
For navigation system operation () See the Navigation System Manual
Models without navigation system
/
月曜日
CD/AUX Button
VOL /
(Volume/Power)
Knob
/
(Skip/Seek) Buttons
(Sound) Button
LIST/SELECT Knob
MENU/CLOCK Button
(Back) Button
Preset Buttons (1-6)
CD/USB device:
Press to skip to the beginning of
the next song or return to the
beginning of the current song.
Press and hold to change a folder.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
* Not available on all models
19
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 20 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Models with display audio system
Quick Reference Guide
Audio/Information Screen
CD Slot
(Power) Button
(CD Eject) Button
Button
(Home) Icon
HOME
VOL
VOL (Volume) Icons
(Menu) Icon
(Back) Icon
MENU
BACK
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
20
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 21 ページ
Driving
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
(P313)
(P334, 336)
● Shift to (P and depress the brake pedal when starting the engine.
Shifting
Models with
paddle shifters
Models without
paddle shifters
Depress the brake pedal and press
the release button to move out of (P .
Move the shift lever without
pressing the release button.
Press the release button to move
the shift lever.
Shift Lever
Park
Turn off or start the engine.
Transmission is locked.
Reverse
Used when reversing.
Release
Button
Neutral
Transmission is not locked.
Drive
Normal driving.
On models with paddle shifters, 7-speed
mode can be used temporarily.
Models with paddle shifters
Drive (S)
7-speed manual shift mode can
be used.
7-Speed Manual Shift Mode * (P338)
● Allows you to manually shift the transmission up or
down without removing your hands from the steering
wheel.
When the shift lever is in (S
● Pulling a paddle shifter changes the mode from
continuously variable transmission to 7-speed manual
shift mode.
● The M indicator and the selected speed number are
displayed in the shift indicator.
Quick Reference Guide
Manual Transmission * (P340)
Continuously Variable Transmission *
When the shift lever is in (D
● Pulling a paddle shifter temporarily changes the mode
from continuously variable transmission to 7-speed
manual shift mode. The selected speed number is
displayed in the shift indicator.
(M Indicator
Shift Down
Paddle Shifter
Shift Up
Paddle Shifter
Shift Indicator
Models without paddle shifters
Drive (S)
● Better acceleration
● Used to increase engine braking
● Used when going up or down hills
Models without paddle shifters
Low
● Used to further increase engine braking
● Used when going up or down hills
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
* Not available on all models
21
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 22 ページ
2015年6月29日
VSA® OFF Button (P355)
Quick Reference Guide
● The vehicle stability assist (VSA®) system
helps stabilize the vehicle during
cornering, and helps maintain traction
while accelerating on loose or slippery
road surfaces.
● VSA® comes on automatically every time
you start the engine.
● To turn VSA® on or off, press and hold
the button until you hear a beep.
月曜日
午前11時36分
Refueling (P374)
Fuel recommendation: Unleaded gasoline with a pump octane number 87 or
higher required
Fuel tank capacity: 13.2 US gal (50 L)
a
Pull the fuel fill door
release handle.
b
Turn the fuel fill cap
slowly to remove the
cap.
c
Place the cap in the
holder on the fuel fill
door.
d
After refueling, screw
the cap back on until it
clicks at least once.
Cruise Control (P344)
● Cruise control allows you to maintain a
set speed without keeping your foot on
the accelerator pedal.
● To use cruise control, press the CRUISE
button, then press the -/SET button once
you have achieved the desired speed
(above 25 mph or 40 km/h).
Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) (P359)
U.S. models only
● Detects a change in tire conditions and
overall dimensions due to decrease in tire
pressures.
● TPMS is turned on automatically every
time you start the engine.
● A calibration procedure must be
performed when certain conditions arise.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
22
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 23 ページ
2015年6月29日
Maintenance
月曜日
午前11時36分
(P379)
a
Pull the hood release handle under the corner of
the dashboard.
b
Locate the hood latch lever, push the lever, and lift
up the hood.
c
When finished, close the hood and make sure it is
firmly locked in place.
Quick Reference Guide
Under the Hood (P387)
● Check engine oil, engine coolant, and window washer
fluid. Add when necessary.
● Check brake fluid.
● Check the battery condition monthly.
Wiper Blades (P407)
● Replace blades if they leave streaks
across the windshield.
Tires (P411)
Lights (P399)
● Inspect tires and wheels regularly.
● Check tire pressures regularly.
● Install snow tires for winter driving.
● Inspect all lights regularly.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
23
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 24 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Handling the Unexpected
(P431)
Quick Reference Guide
Flat Tire (P434)
Engine Won’t Start (P443) Overheating (P449)
● Park in a safe location and replace the
flat tire with the compact spare tire in the
cargo area.
● If the battery is dead, jump start using a
booster battery.
Indicators Come On
Blown Fuse (P456)
Emergency Towing (P461)
(P451)
● Check for a blown fuse if an electrical
device does not operate.
● Call a professional towing service if you
need to tow your vehicle.
● Identify the indicator and consult the
owner’s manual.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
24
● Park in a safe location. If you do not see
steam under the hood, open the hood,
and let the engine cool down.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 25 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
What to Do If
Canadian models
The ignition switch does
not turn from (0 to (q *1.
Why?
●
Models without smart entry system
●
Try to turn the steering wheel left and
right while turning the ignition key.
Models with smart entry system
●
Models without smart entry system
The steering wheel may be locked.
Move the steering wheel left and right
while pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button at the same
time.
Quick Reference Guide
U.S. models with manual transmission
The shift lever should be moved to (P .
The ignition switch does
not turn from (q to (0 and
I cannot remove the key.
Why?
Models with smart entry system
The power mode does not
change from ON to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK). Why?
Why does the brake pedal
pulsate slightly when
applying the brakes?
This can occur when the ABS activates, and does not indicate a
problem. Apply firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. Never
pump the brake pedal.
*1 : Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
25
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 26 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Quick Reference Guide
The rear door cannot be
opened from inside the
vehicle. Why?
Check if the childproof lock is in the
lock position. If so, open the rear door
with the outside door handle.
To cancel this function, push the lever
to the unlock position.
Why do the doors lock
after I unlocked the doors
using a remote
transmitter?
If you do not open the doors within 30 seconds, the doors are
relocked automatically for security.
Why does the beeper
sound when I open the
driver’s door?
The beeper sounds when:
● The exterior lights are left on.
Models without smart entry system
●
The key is left in the ignition switch.
Models with smart entry system
●
The power mode is in ACCESSORY.
Why does the beeper
sound when I start driving?
The beeper sounds when driver and/or front passenger are not
wearing their seat belts.
Why do I hear a screeching
sound when I apply the
brake pedal?
The brake pads may need to be replaced. Have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
26
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 27 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Press the electric parking brake switch with the brake pedal
depressed.
Depressing the accelerator
pedal does not release the
parking brake
automatically. Why?
●
●
Fasten the driver’s seat belt.
Check if the transmission is in (P or (N . If so, select any other
position.
Quick Reference Guide
Pressing the electric
parking brake switch does
not release the parking
brake. Why?
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
27
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 28 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
28
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 29 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Safe Driving
You can find many safety recommendations throughout this chapter, and throughout this manual.
For Safe Driving
Important Safety Precautions ............. 30
Important Handling Information......... 32
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features............ 33
Seat Belts
About Your Seat Belts........................ 35
Fastening a Seat Belt.......................... 38
Seat Belt Inspection............................ 43
Airbags
Airbag System Components............... 44
Types of Airbags ................................ 47
Front Airbags (SRS) ............................ 47
Side Airbags ...................................... 51
Side Curtain Airbags .......................... 53
Airbag System Indicators.................... 54
Airbag Care ....................................... 56
Child Safety
Protecting Child Passengers ............... 57
Safety of Infants and Small Children .... 59
Safety of Larger Children ................... 67
Exhaust Gas Hazard
Carbon Monoxide Gas....................... 69
Safety Labels
Label Locations .................................. 70
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
29
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 30 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
For Safe Driving
The following pages explain your vehicle’s safety features and how to use them
properly. The safety precautions below are ones that we consider to be among the
most important.
Safe Driving
Important Safety Precautions
1Important Safety Precautions
■ Always wear your seat belt
A seat belt is your best protection in all types of collisions. Airbags are designed to
supplement seat belts, not replace them. So even though your vehicle is equipped
with airbags, make sure you and your passengers always wear your seat belts, and
wear them properly.
■ Restrain all children
Children ages 12 and under should ride properly restrained in a back seat, not the
front seat. Infants and small children should be restrained in a child seat. Larger
children should use a booster seat and a lap/shoulder seat belt until they can use the
belt properly without a booster seat.
■ Be aware of airbag hazards
While airbags can save lives, they can cause serious or fatal injuries to occupants
who sit too close to them, or are not properly restrained. Infants, young children,
and short adults are at the greatest risk. Be sure to follow all instructions and
warnings in this manual.
■ Don’t drink and drive
Alcohol and driving don’t mix. Even one drink can reduce your ability to respond to
changing conditions, and your reaction time gets worse with every additional drink.
So don’t drink and drive, and don’t let your friends drink and drive, either.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
30
Some states, provinces and territories prohibit the use
of cell phones other than hands-free devices by the
driver while driving.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 31 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuFor Safe DrivinguImportant Safety Precautions
■ Control your speed
Excessive speed is a major factor in crash injuries and deaths. Generally, the higher
the speed, the greater the risk, but serious injuries can also occur at lower speeds.
Never drive faster than is safe for current conditions, regardless of the maximum
speed posted.
Safe Driving
■ Pay appropriate attention to the task of driving safely
Engaging in cell phone conversation or other activities that keep you from paying
close attention to the road, other vehicles, and pedestrians could lead to a crash.
Remember, situations can change quickly, and only you can decide when it is safe to
divert some attention away from driving.
■ Keep your vehicle in safe condition
Having a tire blowout or a mechanical failure can be extremely hazardous.
To reduce the possibility of such problems, check your tire pressures and condition
frequently, and perform all regularly scheduled maintenance.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
31
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 32 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuFor Safe DrivinguImportant Handling Information
Important Handling Information
Safe Driving
Your vehicle has higher ground clearance than a passenger vehicle designed for use
only on pavement. Higher ground clearance has many advantages for off-highway
driving. It allows you to travel over bumps, obstacles, and rough terrain. It also
provides good visibility so you can anticipate problems earlier.
These advantages come at some cost. Because your vehicle is taller and rides higher
off the ground, it has a higher center gravity making it more susceptible to tripping
or roll over if you make abrupt turns. Utility vehicles have a significantly higher
rollover rate than other types of vehicles. In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt. As a reminder,
make sure you and your passengers always wear seat belts.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
32
1Important Handling Information
For information on how to reduce the risk of rollover,
read:
2 Driving Guidelines for Your Utility Vehicle
P. 332
2 Off-Highway Driving Guidelines P. 323
Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result
in a crash or a rollover.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 33 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuFor Safe DrivinguYour Vehicle’s Safety Features
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
1Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
9
8
Some features do not require any action on your part.
These include a strong steel framework that forms a
safety cage around the passenger compartment,
front and rear crush zones, a collapsible steering
column, and tensioners that tighten the front seat
belts in a sufficient crash.
6
10
7
8
10
11
7
6
7
8
9
10
11
Safety Cage
Crush Zones
Seats and Seat-Backs
Head Restraints
Collapsible Steering Column
Seat Belts
Front Airbags
Side Airbags
Side Curtain Airbags
Door Locks
Seat Belt Tensioners
Safe Driving
Your vehicle is equipped with many features that
work together to help protect you and your
passengers during a crash.
9
However, you and your passengers cannot take full
advantage of these features unless you remain seated
in the correct position and always wear your seat
belts. In fact, some safety features can contribute to
injuries if they are not used properly.
The following checklist will help you take an active role in protecting yourself and
your passengers.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
33
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 34 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuFor Safe DrivinguYour Vehicle’s Safety Features
■ Safety Checklist
1Safety Checklist
Safe Driving
For the safety of you and your passengers, make a habit of checking these items
each time before you drive.
• After everyone has entered the vehicle, be sure all doors and the tailgate are
closed and locked. Locking the doors and the tailgate helps prevent an occupant
from being ejected and an outsider from unexpectedly opening a door or the
tailgate.
2 Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside P. 105
• Adjust your seat to a position suitable for driving. Be sure the front seats are
adjusted as far to the rear as possible while allowing the driver to control the
vehicle. Sitting too close to a front airbag can result in serious or fatal injury in a
crash.
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 140
• Adjust head restraints to the proper position. Head restraints are most effective
when the center of the head restraint aligns with the center of your head. Taller
persons should adjust their head restraint to the highest position.
2 Adjusting the Head Restraints P. 142
• Always wear your seat belt, and make sure you wear it properly. Confirm that any
passengers are properly belted as well.
2 Fastening a Seat Belt P. 38
• Protect children by using seat belts or child seats according to a child’s age, height
and weight.
2 Child Safety P. 57
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
34
If the door and tailgate open indicator is on, a door
and/or the tailgate is not completely closed. Close all
doors and the tailgate tightly until the indicator goes
off.
2 Door and Tailgate Open Indicator P. 78
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 35 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Seat Belts
About Your Seat Belts
In addition, seat belts help protect you in almost every type of crash, including:
- frontal impacts
- side impacts
- rear impacts
- rollovers
■ Lap/shoulder seat belts
All five seating positions are equipped with lap/shoulder seat belts with emergency
locking retractors. In normal driving the retractor lets you move freely while keeping
some tension on the belt. During a collision or sudden stop the retractor locks to
restrain your body. The rear seat belts also have a lockable retractor for use with
child seats.
2 Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt P. 64
1About Your Seat Belts
3 WARNING
Not wearing a seat belt properly increases
the chance of serious injury or death in a
crash, even though your vehicle has
airbags.
Safe Driving
Seat belts are the single most effective safety device because they keep you
connected to the vehicle so that you can take advantage of many built-in safety
features. They also help keep you from being thrown against the inside of the
vehicle, against other passengers, or out of the vehicle. When worn properly, seat
belts also keep your body properly positioned in a crash so that you can take full
advantage of the additional protection provided by the airbags.
Be sure you and your passengers always
wear seat belts and wear them properly.
Seat belts cannot completely protect you in every
crash. But in most cases, seat belts can reduce your
risk of serious injury.
Most states and all Canadian provinces and territories
require you to wear seat belts.
The emergency locking retractor may lock if you lean
forward too quickly. Slower movements will allow
the belt to extend fully without locking.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
35
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 36 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuSeat BeltsuAbout Your Seat Belts
■ Proper use of seat belts
1About Your Seat Belts
Safe Driving
Follow these guidelines for proper use:
• All occupants should sit upright, well back in the seat, and remain in that position
for the duration of the trip. Slouching and leaning reduce the effectiveness of the
belt and can increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.
• Never place the shoulder part of a lap/shoulder seat belt under your arm or
behind your back. This could cause very serious injuries in a crash.
• Two people should never use the same seat belt. If they do, they could be very
seriously injured in a crash.
• Do not put any accessories on the seat belts. Devices intended to improve comfort
or reposition the shoulder part of a seat belt can reduce the protective capability
and increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.
■ Seat Belt Reminder
1Seat Belt Reminder
Your vehicle monitors front seat belt use. If
the ignition switch is turned to ON (w *1
before the driver’s seat belt is fastened, the
beeper will sound and the indicator will blink.
If the driver does not fasten the belt before
the beeper stops, the indicator will remain on.
The beeper will also periodically sound and
the indicator will blink while driving until the
driver’s and front passenger’s seat belts are
fastened.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
36
If a rear seat passenger moves around and extends
the seat belt, the lockable retractor may activate. If
this happens, release the retractor by unfastening the
seat belt and allow the belt to retract completely.
Then refasten the belt.
The indicator will also come on if a front passenger
does not fasten their seat belt within six seconds after
the ignition switch is turned to ON (w *1.
When no one is sitting in the front passenger’s seat,
the indicator will not come on and the beeper will not
sound. The indicator also may not come on and the
beeper may not sound when the occupant is not
heavy enough to trigger the weight sensor. Such
occupants (e.g., infants and smaller children) should
be moved to the rear seat as a deploying front airbag
likely will injure or kill them.
2 Protecting Child Passengers P. 57
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 37 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuSeat BeltsuAbout Your Seat Belts
■ Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
1Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
The front seats are equipped with automatic seat belt tensioners to enhance safety.
During a moderate-to-severe side impact, the
tensioner on that side of the vehicle also activates.
Safe Driving
The tensioners automatically tighten the front seat belts during a moderate-tosevere frontal collision, sometimes even if the collision is not severe enough to
inflate the front airbags.
The seat belt tensioners can only operate once.
If a tensioner is activated, the SRS indicator will come
on. Have a dealer replace the tensioner and
thoroughly inspect the seat belt system as it may not
offer protection in a subsequent crash.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
37
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 38 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
Fastening a Seat Belt
After adjusting a front seat to the proper position, and while sitting upright and well
back in the seat:
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 140
Safe Driving
Pull out slowly.
1. Pull the seat belt out slowly.
Correct
Seated
Posture.
Buckle
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
38
No one should sit in a seat with an inoperative seat
belt or one that does not appear to be working
correctly. Using a seat belt that is not working
properly may not protect the occupant in a crash.
Have a dealer check the belt as soon as possible.
Never insert any foreign objects into the buckle or
retractor mechanism.
2. Insert the latch plate into the buckle, then
tug on the belt to make sure the buckle is
secure.
u Make sure that the belt is not twisted or
caught on anything.
Latch
Plate
1Fastening a Seat Belt
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 39 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
1Fastening a Seat Belt
3 WARNING
Improperly positioning the seat belts can
cause serious injury or death in a crash.
Make sure all seat belts are properly
positioned before driving.
Safe Driving
Lap belt
as low as
possible
3. Position the lap part of the belt as low as
possible across your hips, then pull up on
the shoulder part of the belt so the lap part
fits snugly. This lets your strong pelvic
bones take the force of a crash and reduces
the chance of internal injuries.
4. If necessary, pull up on the belt again to
remove any slack, then check that the belt
rests across the center of your chest and
over your shoulder. This spreads the forces
of a crash over the strongest bones in your
upper body.
To release the belt, push the red PRESS button then
guide the belt by hand until it has retracted
completely.
When exiting the vehicle, be sure the belt is out of
the way and will not get caught by closing the door.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
39
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 40 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor
1Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor
Safe Driving
The front seats have adjustable shoulder anchors to accommodate taller and shorter
occupants.
1. Move the anchor up and down while
pulling the release outward.
2. Position the anchor so that the belt rests
across the center of your chest and over
your shoulder.
Pull outward
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
40
The shoulder anchor height can be adjusted to four
levels. If the belt contacts your neck, lower the height
one level at a time.
After an adjustment, make sure that the shoulder
anchor position is secure.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 41 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor
1Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor
3 WARNING
Using the seat belt with the detachable
anchor unlatched increases the chance of
serious injury or death in a crash.
Before using the seat belt, make sure the
detachable anchor is correctly latched.
Small Latch Plate
2. Line up the triangle marks on the small
latch plate and anchor buckle. Make sure
the seat belt is not twisted. Attach the belt
to the anchor buckle.
Safe Driving
1. Pull out the seat belt’s small latch plate and
the latch plate from each holding slot in the
ceiling.
Latch Plate
To unlatch the detachable anchor, insert the latch
plate into the slot on the side of the anchor buckle.
Anchor
Buckle
Latch Plate
3. Insert the latch plate into the buckle.
Properly fasten the seat belt the same way
you fasten the lap/shoulder seat belt.
Anchor
Buckle
Latch Plate
Buckle
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
41
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 42 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Advice for Pregnant Women
1Advice for Pregnant Women
Safe Driving
If you are pregnant, the best way to protect yourself and your unborn child when
driving or riding in a vehicle is to always wear a seat belt and keep the lap part of the
belt as low as possible across the hips.
Wear the shoulder belt
across the chest avoiding
the abdomen.
Wear the lap part of the
belt as low as possible
across the hips.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
42
Each time you have a checkup, ask your doctor if it is
okay for you to drive.
To reduce the risk of injuries to both you and your
unborn child that can be caused by an inflating front
airbag:
• When driving, sit upright and adjust the seat as far
back as possible while allowing full control of the
vehicle.
• When sitting in the front passenger’s seat, adjust
the seat as far back as possible.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 43 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuSeat BeltsuSeat Belt Inspection
Seat Belt Inspection
Regularly check the condition of your seat belts as follows:
1Seat Belt Inspection
Any belt that is not in good condition or working properly will not provide proper
protection and should be replaced as soon as possible.
A belt that has been worn during a crash may not provide the same level of
protection in a subsequent crash. Have your seat belts inspected by a dealer after
any collision.
3 WARNING
Not checking or maintaining seat belts can
result in serious injury or death if the seat
belts do not work properly when needed.
Check your seat belts regularly and have
any problem corrected as soon as possible.
Safe Driving
• Pull each belt out fully, and look for frays, cuts, burns, and wear.
• Check that the latches work smoothly and the belts retract easily.
u If a belt does not retract easily, cleaning the belt may correct the problem. Only
use a mild soap and warm water. Do not use bleach or cleaning solvents. Make
sure the belt is completely dry before allowing it to retract.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
43
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 44 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Airbags
Airbag System Components
Safe Driving
8
10
8
7
12
9
8
6
8
8
11
8
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
44
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 45 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Components
d An electronic control unit that continually
monitors and can record information
about the sensors, the airbag activators,
the seat belt tensioners, and driver and
front passenger seat belt use when the
ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
h Impact
sensors that can detect a
moderate-to-severe front or side impact.
i An
indicator near the shift lever that
alerts you that the front passenger’s front
airbag has been turned off.
a Two SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
front airbags. The driver’s airbag is stored
in the center of the steering wheel; the
front passenger’s airbag is stored in the
dashboard. Both are marked SRS
AIRBAG.
e Automatic
front seat belt tensioners. The
driver’s and front passenger’s seat belts
incorporate sensors that detect whether
or not they are fastened.
j An indicator on the instrument panel that
alerts you to a possible problem with your
airbag system or seat belt tensioners.
k Safing
Sensor
fA
b Two
side airbags, one for the driver and
one for a front passenger. The airbags are
stored in the outer edges of the seatbacks. Both are marked SIDE AIRBAG.
c Two
side curtain airbags, one for each
side of the vehicle. The airbags are stored
in the ceiling, above the side windows.
The front and rear pillars are marked
SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG.
driver’s seat position sensor. If the seat
is too far forward, the airbag will inflate
with less force.
Safe Driving
The front, front side, and side curtain
airbags are deployed according to the
direction and severity of impact. Both side
curtain airbags are deployed in a rollover.
The airbag system includes:
sensors in the front passenger’s
seat. The front passenger’s airbag will be
turned off if the weight on the seat is 65
lbs (29 kg) or less (the weight of an infant
or small child).
lA
rollover sensor that detects whether
the vehicle is about to roll over.
g Weight
*1 : Models with the smart entry system have an
ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition
switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
45
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 46 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Components
■ Important Facts About Your Airbags
1Important Facts About Your Airbags
Safe Driving
Airbags can pose serious hazards. To do their job, airbags must inflate with
tremendous force. So, while airbags help save lives, they can cause burns, bruises,
and other minor injuries, sometimes even fatal ones if occupants are not wearing
their seat belts properly and sitting correctly.
What you should do: Always wear your seat belt properly, and sit upright and as
far back from the steering wheel as possible while allowing full control of the
vehicle. A front passenger should move their seat as far back from the dashboard as
possible.
Remember, however, that no safety system can prevent all injuries or deaths that
can occur in a severe crash, even when seat belts are properly worn and the airbags
deploy.
Do not place hard or sharp objects between yourself and a front airbag.
Carrying hard or sharp objects on your lap, or driving with a pipe or other sharp
object in your mouth, can result in injuries if your front airbag inflates.
Do not attach or place objects on the front airbag covers. Objects on the
covers marked SRS AIRBAG could interfere with the proper operation of the airbags
or be propelled inside the vehicle and hurt someone if the airbags inflate.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
46
Do not attempt to deactivate your airbags. Together,
airbags and seat belts provide the best protection.
When driving, keep hands and arms out of the
deployment path of the front airbag by holding each
side of the steering wheel. Do not cross an arm over
the airbag cover.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 47 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAirbagsuTypes of Airbags
Types of Airbags
Your vehicle is equipped with three types of airbags:
• Front airbags: Airbags in front of the driver’s and front passenger’s seats.
• Side airbags: Airbags in the driver’s and front passenger’s seat-backs.
• Side curtain airbags: Airbags above the side windows.
Each is discussed in the following pages.
1Types of Airbags
Front Airbags (SRS)
1Front Airbags (SRS)
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) indicates that the airbags are designed to
supplement seat belts, not replace them. Seat belts are the occupant’s primary
restraint system.
■ Housing Locations
The front airbags are housed in the center of the steering wheel for the driver, and
in the dashboard for the front passenger. Both airbags are marked SRS AIRBAG.
After an airbag inflates in a crash, you may see a
small amount of smoke. This is from the combustion
process of the inflator material and is not harmful.
People with respiratory problems may experience
some temporary discomfort. If this occurs, get out of
the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so.
Safe Driving
The front SRS airbags inflate in a moderate-to-severe frontal collision to help protect
the head and chest of the driver and/or front passenger.
The airbags can inflate whenever the ignition switch
is in ON (w *1.
Dual-Stage, Multiple-Threshold Front Airbags
(SRS)
Your vehicle is equipped with dual-stage, multiplethreshold front airbags (SRS).
During a frontal crash severe enough to cause one or
both front airbags to deploy, the airbags can inflate
at different rates, depending on the severity of the
crash, whether or not the seat belts are latched, and/
or other factors. Frontal airbags are designed to
supplement the seat belts to help reduce the
likelihood of head and chest injuries in frontal
crashes.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
47
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 48 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
■ Operation
Safe Driving
Front airbags are designed to inflate during moderate-to-severe frontal collisions.
When the vehicle decelerates suddenly, the sensors send information to the control
unit which signals one or both front airbags to inflate.
A frontal collision can be either head-on or angled between two vehicles, or when a
vehicle crashes into a stationary object, such as a concrete wall.
■ How the Front Airbags Work
1How the Front Airbags Work
While your seat belt restrains your torso, the
front airbag provides supplemental protection
for your head and chest.
The front airbags deflate immediately so that
they won’t interfere with the driver’s visibility
or the ability to steer or operate other
controls.
The total time for inflation and deflation is so fast that most occupants are not
aware that the airbags deployed until they see them lying in front of them.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
48
Although the driver’s and front passenger’s airbags
normally inflate within a split second of each other, it
is possible for only one airbag to deploy. This can
happen if the severity of a collision is at the margin,
or threshold, that determines whether or not the
airbags will deploy. In such cases, the seat belt will
provide sufficient protection, and the supplemental
protection offered by the airbag would be minimal.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 49 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
Safe Driving
■ When front airbags should not deploy
Minor frontal crashes: Front airbags were designed to supplement seat belts and
help save lives, not to prevent minor scrapes, or even broken bones that might occur
during a less than moderate-to-severe frontal crash.
Side impacts: Front airbags can provide protection when a sudden deceleration
causes a driver or front passenger to move towards the front of the vehicle. Side
airbags and side curtain airbags have been specifically designed to help reduce the
severity of injuries that can occur during a moderate-to-severe side impact which
can cause the driver or passenger to move towards the side of the vehicle.
Rear impacts: Head restraints and seat belts are your best protection during a rear
impact. Front airbags cannot provide any significant protection and are not designed
to deploy in such collisions.
Rollovers: Seat belts and, in vehicles equipped with a rollover sensor, side airbags
and side curtain airbags offer the best protection in a rollover. Because front airbags
could provide little if any protection, they are not designed to deploy during a
rollover.
■ When front airbags deploy with little or no visible damage
Because the airbag system senses sudden deceleration, a strong impact to the
vehicle framework or suspension might cause one or more of the airbags to deploy.
Examples include running into a curb, the edge of a hole, or other low fixed object
that causes a sudden deceleration in the vehicle chassis. Since the impact is
underneath the vehicle, damage may not be readily apparent.
■ When front airbags may not deploy, even though exterior damage
appears severe
Since crushable body parts absorb crash energy during an impact, the amount of
visible damage does not always indicate proper airbag operation. In fact, some
collisions can result in severe damage but no airbag deployment because the airbags
would not have been needed or would not have provided protection even if they
had deployed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
49
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 50 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
■ Advanced Airbags
1Advanced Airbags
Safe Driving
Your front airbags have advanced features to help reduce the likelihood of airbag
related injuries to smaller occupants.
The driver’s advanced front airbag system
includes a seat position sensor.
Driver’s
Seat
Position
Sensor
If the seat is too far forward, the airbag
inflates with less force, regardless of the
severity of the impact.
The passenger’s advanced front airbag system
has weight sensors.
Passenger’s
Seat
Weight
Sensors
Although we recommend against carrying an
infant or small child in front, if the sensors
detect the weight of a child (up to about 65
lbs or 29 kg), the system will automatically
turn off the passenger’s front airbag.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
50
If there is a problem with the driver’s seat position
sensor, the SRS indicator will come on and the airbag
will inflate with full (normal) force, regardless of the
driver’s seating position.
For both advanced front airbags to work properly:
• Do not spill any liquid on or under the seats.
• Do not put any object under the passenger’s seat.
• Make sure any objects are positioned properly on
the floor. Improperly positioned objects can
interfere with the advanced airbag sensors.
• All occupants should sit upright and wear their seat
belts properly.
• Do not place any cover over the passenger side
dashboard.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 51 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAirbagsuSide Airbags
Side Airbags
The side airbags help protect the torso and pelvis of the driver or a front passenger
during a moderate-to-severe side impact.
The side airbags are housed in the outside
edge of the driver’s and passenger’s seatbacks.
Both are marked SIDE AIRBAG.
Do not attach accessories on or near the side airbags.
They can interfere with the proper operation of the
airbags, or hurt someone if an airbag inflates.
If the impact is on the passenger side, the airbag
deploys even if there is no passenger in the passenger
seat.
Housing Location
■ Operation
When
inflated
Make sure you and your front seat passenger always
sit upright. Leaning into the path of a side airbag can
prevent the airbag from deploying properly and
increases your risk of serious injury.
Safe Driving
■ Housing Locations
1Side Airbags
When the sensors detect a moderate-tosevere side impact, the control unit signals the
side airbag on the impact side to immediately
inflate.
Do not cover or replace the front seat-back covers
without consulting a dealer.
Improperly replacing or covering front seat-back
covers can prevent your side airbags from properly
deploying during a side impact.
Side Airbag
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
51
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 52 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAirbagsuSide Airbags
■ When a side airbag deploys with little or no visible damage
Safe Driving
Because the airbag system senses sudden acceleration, a strong impact to the side
of the vehicle’s framework can cause a side airbag to deploy. In such cases, there
may be little or no damage, but the side impact sensors detected a severe enough
impact to deploy the airbag.
■ When a side airbag may not deploy, even though visible damage appears
severe
It is possible for a side airbag to not deploy during an impact that results in
apparently severe damage. This can occur when the point of impact was towards
the far front or rear of the vehicle, or when the vehicle’s crushable body parts
absorbed most of the crash energy. In either case, the side airbag would not have
been needed nor provided protection even if it had deployed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
52
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 53 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAirbagsuSide Curtain Airbags
Side Curtain Airbags
■ Housing Locations
The side curtain airbags are located in the
ceiling above the side windows on both sides
of the vehicle.
1Side Curtain Airbags
If the SRS control unit senses that your vehicle is
about to rollover, it immediately deploys both side
curtain airbags and activates both front seat belt
tensioners.
If the impact is on the passenger’s side, the
passenger’s side curtain airbag will inflate even if
there are no occupants on that side of the vehicle.
Safe Driving
The side curtain airbags help protect the heads of the driver and passengers in outer
seating positions during a moderate-to-severe side impact. The side curtain airbags
equipped in this vehicle are also designed to help reduce the likelihood of partial and
complete ejection of vehicle occupants through side windows in crashes, particularly
rollover crashes.
To get the best protection from the side curtain
airbags, occupants should wear their seat belts
properly and sit upright and well back in their seats.
Do not attach any objects to the side windows or roof
pillars as they can interfere with the proper operation
of the side curtain airbags.
Side Curtain Airbag Storage
■ Operation
The side curtain airbag is designed to deploy
in a rollover or a moderate-to-severe side
impact.
Deployed Side Curtain Airbag
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
53
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 54 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Indicators
■ When side curtain airbags deploy in a frontal collision
Safe Driving
One or both side curtain airbags may inflate in a moderate-to-severe angled frontal
collision.
In this case, the side curtain airbags will deploy slightly after the front airbags.
Airbag System Indicators
1Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Indicator
If a problem occurs in the airbag system, the SRS indicator will come on.
■ Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Indicator
■ When the ignition switch is turned to
ON (w *1
The indicator comes on for a few seconds,
then goes off. This tells you the system is
working properly.
If the indicator comes on at any other time, or does not come on at all, have the
system checked by a dealer as soon as possible. If you don’t, your airbags and seat
belt tensioners may not work properly when they are needed.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
54
3 WARNING
Ignoring the SRS indicator can result in
serious injury or death if the airbag systems
or tensioners do not work properly.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer as
soon as possible if the SRS indicator alerts
you to a possible problem.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 55 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Indicators
■ Passenger Airbag Off Indicator
1Passenger Airbag Off Indicator
■ When the passenger airbag off
• An object hanging on the seat or in the seat-back
pocket.
Safe Driving
indicator comes on
The indicator comes on to alert you that the
passenger’s front airbag has been turned off.
This occurs when the front passenger’s weight
sensors detect 65 lbs (29 kg) or less, the
weight of an infant or small child, on the seat.
If the indicator comes on with no front passenger and
no objects on the passenger’s seat, or with an adult
riding there, something may be interfering with the
weight sensors, such as:
• A child seat or other object pressing against the
rear of the seat-back.
• A rear passenger pushing or pulling on the back of
U.S. models
the front passenger’s seat.
• The front seat or seat-back is forced back against
an object on the seat or floor behind it.
• An object placed under the front passenger’s seat.
If none of these conditions exist, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
The passenger airbag off indicator may come on and
goes off repeatedly if the total weight on the seat is
near the airbag cutoff threshold.
Canadian models
Infants and small children should always ride properly restrained in a back seat.
2 Child Safety P. 57
Objects placed on the seat can also cause the indicator to come on.
If the front passenger seat is empty, the passenger’s front airbag will not deploy and
the indicator will not come on.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
55
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 56 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAirbagsuAirbag Care
Airbag Care
You do not need to, and should not, perform any maintenance on or replace any
airbag system components yourself. However, you should have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer in the following situations:
Safe Driving
■ When the airbags have deployed
If an airbag has inflated, the control unit and other related parts must be replaced.
Similarly, once an automatic seat belt tensioner has been activated, it must be
replaced.
■ When the vehicle has been in a moderate-to-severe collision
Even if the airbags did not inflate, have your dealer inspect the following: the driver’s
seat position sensor, weight sensors in the passenger’s seat, front seat belt
tensioners, and each seat belt that was worn during the crash.
■ Do not remove or modify a front seat without consulting a dealer
This would likely disable the driver’s seat position sensor or the weight sensors in the
passenger’s seat. If it is necessary to remove or modify a front seat to accommodate
a person with disabilities, contact a Honda dealer, or for U.S. vehicles, American
Honda Automobile Customer Service at 800-999-1009 and for Canadian vehicles,
Honda Canada Customer Relations at 888-9-HONDA-9.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
56
1Airbag Care
We recommend against the use of salvaged airbag
system components, including the airbag, tensioners,
sensors, and control unit.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 57 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Child Safety
Protecting Child Passengers
Each year, many children are injured or killed in vehicle crashes because they are
either unrestrained or not properly restrained. In fact, vehicle accidents are the
number one cause of death of children ages 12 and under.
Children should sit properly restrained in a rear seat. This is because:
• An inflating front or side airbag can injure
or kill a child sitting in the front seat.
• A child in the front seat is more likely to
interfere with the driver’s ability to safely
control the vehicle.
• Statistics show that children of all sizes and
ages are safer when they are properly
restrained in a rear seat.
3 WARNING
Children who are unrestrained or
improperly restrained can be seriously
injured or killed in a crash.
Any child too small for a seat belt should be
properly restrained in a child seat. A larger
child should be properly restrained with a
seat belt, using a booster seat if necessary.
Safe Driving
To reduce the number of child deaths and injuries, every state, Canadian province
and territory requires that infants and children be properly restrained when they ride
in a vehicle.
1Protecting Child Passengers
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
and Transport Canada recommend that all children
ages 12 and under be properly restrained in a rear
seat. Some states or provinces/territories have laws
restricting where children may ride.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
57
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 58 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChild SafetyuProtecting Child Passengers
• Any child who is too small to wear a seat belt correctly must be restrained in an
approved child seat that is properly secured to the vehicle using either the lap belt
portion of the lap/shoulder belt or the lower anchors of the LATCH system.
Safe Driving
• Never hold a child on your lap because it is impossible to protect them in the
event of a collision.
• Never put a seat belt over yourself and a child. During a crash, the belt would
likely press deep into the child and cause serious or fatal injuries.
• Never let two children use the same seat belt. Both children could be very
seriously injured in a crash.
• Do not allow children to operate the doors, windows or seat adjustments.
• Do not leave children in the vehicle unattended, especially in hot weather when
the inside of the vehicle can get hot enough to kill them. They could also activate
vehicle controls causing it to move unexpectedly.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
58
1Protecting Child Passengers
3 WARNING
Allowing a child to play with a seat belt or
wrap one around their neck can result in
serious injury or death.
Instruct children not to play with any seat
belt and make sure any unused seat belt a
child can reach is buckled, fully retracted,
and locked.
To deactivate a lockable retractor, release the buckle
and allow the seat belt to wind up all the way.
To remind you of the passenger’s front airbag
hazards and child safety, your vehicle has warning
labels on the dashboard (U.S. models) and on the
front visors. Please read and follow the instructions
on these labels.
2 Safety Labels P. 70
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 59 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Safety of Infants and Small Children
■ Protecting Infants
1Protecting Infants
3 WARNING
Placing a rear-facing child seat in the front
seat can result in serious injury or death
during a crash.
Always place a rear-facing child seat in the
rear seat, not the front.
Safe Driving
An infant must be properly restrained in a rear-facing, reclining child seat until the
infant reaches the seat maker’s weight or height limit for the seat, and the infant is
at least one year old.
■ Positioning a rear-facing child seat
Child seats must be placed and secured in a
rear seating position.
Rear-facing child seats should never be installed in a
forward facing position.
Always refer to the child seat manufacturer’s
instructions before installation.
When properly installed, a rear-facing child seat may prevent the driver or a front
passenger from moving their seat all the way back, or from locking their seat-back
in the desired position.
It can also interfere with proper operation of the passenger’s advanced front airbag
system.
2 Airbags P. 44
If this occurs, we recommend that you install the child seat directly behind the front
passenger’s seat, move the seat as far forward as needed, and leave it unoccupied.
Or, you may wish to get a smaller rear-facing child seat.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
59
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 60 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Protecting Smaller Children
1Protecting Smaller Children
Safe Driving
If a child is at least one year old and within the weight range indicated by the child
seat manufacturer, the child should be properly restrained in a firmly secured
forward-facing child seat.
■ Forward-facing child seat placement
We strongly recommend placing a forwardfacing child seat in a rear seating position.
3 WARNING
Placing a forward-facing child seat in the
front seat can result in serious injury or
death if the front airbag inflates.
If you must place a forward-facing child
seat in front, move the vehicle seat as far
back as possible, and properly restrain the
child.
Educate yourself about the laws and regulations
regarding child seat use where you are driving, and
follow the child seat manufacturer’s instructions.
Placing a forward-facing child seat in the front seat can be hazardous, even with
advanced front airbags that automatically turn the passenger’s front airbag off. A
rear seat is the safest place for a child.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
60
Many experts recommend use of a rear-facing seat
for a child up to two years old if the child’s height and
weight are appropriate for a rear-facing seat.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 61 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Selecting a Child Seat
1Selecting a Child Seat
Installation of a LATCH-compatible child seat is
simple.
LATCH-compatible child seats have been developed
to simplify the installation process and reduce the
likelihood of injuries caused by incorrect installation.
Safe Driving
Most child seats are LATCH-compatible (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren).
Some have a rigid-type connector, while others have a flexible-type connector. Both
are equally easy to use. Some existing and previously owned child seats can only be
installed using the seat belt. Whichever type you choose, follow the child seat
manufacturer's use and care instructions as well as the instructions in this manual.
Proper installation is key to maximizing your child’s safety.
In seating positions and vehicles not equipped with LATCH, a LATCH compatible
child seat can be installed using the seat belt and a top tether for added security.
This is because all child seats are required to be designed so that they can be secured
with a lap belt or the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt. In addition, the child seat
manufacturer may advise that a seat belt be used to attach a LATCH-compatible seat
once a child reaches a specified weight. Please read the child seat owner’s manual
for proper installation instructions.
■ Important consideration when selecting a child seat
Make sure the child seat meets the following three requirements:
• The child seat is the correct type and size for the child.
• The child seat is the correct type for the seating position.
• The child seat is compliant with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
61
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 62 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Installing a LATCH-Compatible Child Seat
Safe Driving
A LATCH-compatible child seat can be installed in either of the two outer rear seats.
A child seat is attached to the lower anchors with either the rigid or flexible type of
connectors.
1. Locate the lower anchors under the marks.
Marks
2. Raise the head restraint to its highest
position.
Rigid Type
3. Place the child seat on the vehicle seat then
attach the child seat to the lower anchors
according to the instructions that came
with the child seat.
u When installing the child seat, make sure
that the lower anchors are not
obstructed by the seat belt or any other
object.
Lower Anchors
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
62
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 63 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
1Installing a LATCH-Compatible Child Seat
Flexible Type
Safe Driving
For your child’s safety, when using a child seat
installed using the LATCH system, make sure that the
seat is properly secured to the vehicle. A child seat
that is not properly secured will not adequately
protect a child in a crash and may cause injury to the
child or other vehicle occupants.
4. Remove the tonneau cover *.
Anchor
Tether Strap Hook
* Not available on all models
2 Tonneau Cover * P. 159
5. Route the tether strap between the head
restraint legs, and secure the tether strap
hook onto the anchor.
Make sure the strap is not twisted.
6. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child seat manufacturer.
7. Make sure the child seat is firmly secured by
rocking it forward and back and side to
side; little movement should be felt.
8. Make sure any unused seat belt that a child
can reach is buckled, the lockable retractor
is activated, and the belt is fully retracted
and locked.
9. Reinstall the tonneau cover *.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
63
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 64 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
Safe Driving
1. Raise the head restraint to its highest
position.
2. Place the child seat on the vehicle seat.
3. Route the seat belt through the child seat
according to the seat maker’s instructions,
and insert the latch plate into the buckle.
u Insert the latch plate fully until it clicks.
4. Slowly pull the shoulder part of the belt all
the way out until it stops. This activates the
lockable retractor.
5. Let the seat belt completely wind up into
the retractor, then try to pull it out to make
sure the retractor is locked.
u If you are able to pull the shoulder belt
out, the lockable retractor is not
activated. Pull the seat belt all the way
out, and repeat steps 4 – 5.
6. Grab the shoulder part of the seat belt near
the buckle, and pull up to remove any slack
from the lap part of the belt.
u When doing this, place your weight on
the child seat and push it into the vehicle
seat.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
64
1Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
A child seat that is not properly secured will not
adequately protect a child in a crash and may cause
injury to the child or other vehicle occupants.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 65 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Adding Security with a Tether
Tether
Anchorage
Points
1Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
To deactivate a lockable retractor, release the buckle
and allow the seat belt to wind up all the way.
Safe Driving
7. Make sure the child seat is firmly secured by
rocking it forward and back and side to
side; little movement should be felt.
8. Make sure any unused seat belt that a child
can reach is buckled, the lockable retractor
is activated, and the belt is fully retracted
and locked.
1Adding Security with a Tether
Two tether anchorage points are provided
behind the rear outer seating positions and
one in the ceiling for the rear center. A child
seat that is installed with a seat belt and
comes with a tether can use the tether for
additional security.
Since a tether can provide additional security to the
lap/shoulder seat belt installation, we recommend
using a tether whenever one is available.
Tether
Anchorage
Point
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
65
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 66 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Using an outer anchor
Anchor
1. Remove the tonneau cover *.
2 Tonneau Cover * P. 159
Safe Driving
2. Put the outer head restraint to its upper
most position, then route the tether strap
between the head restraint legs, and secure
the tether strap hook onto the anchor.
Make sure the strap is not twisted.
3. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child seat manufacturer.
4. Reinstall the tonneau cover *.
Tether Strap Hook
Anchor
Anchor Cover
66
* Not available on all models
■ Using the center anchor
1. Lower the head restraint to its lowest
position.
2. Open the anchor cover.
3. Route the tether strap over the head
restraint.
Make sure the strap is not twisted.
4. Secure the tether strap hook onto the
anchor.
5. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child seat manufacturer.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 67 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Larger Children
Safety of Larger Children
■ Protecting Larger Children
1Safety of Larger Children
■ Checking Seat Belt Fit
When a child is too big for a child seat, secure the child in a rear seat using the lap/
shoulder seat belt. Have the child sit upright and all the way back, then answer the
following questions.
■ Checklist
• Do the child’s knees bend comfortably over
the edge of the seat?
• Does the shoulder belt cross between the
child’s neck and arm?
• Is the lap part of the seat belt as low as
possible, touching the child’s thighs?
• Will the child be able to stay seated like this
for the whole trip?
If you answer yes to all these questions, the child is ready to wear the lap/shoulder
seat belt correctly. If you answer no to any question, the child needs to ride on a
booster seat until the seat belt fits properly without a booster seat.
3 WARNING
Allowing a child age 12 or under to sit in
front can result in injury or death if the
passenger’s front airbag inflates.
If a larger child must ride in front, move the
vehicle seat as far to the rear as possible,
have the child sit up properly and wear the
seat belt properly, using a booster seat if
needed.
Safe Driving
The following pages give instructions on how to check proper seat belt fit, what kind
of booster seat to use if one is needed, and important precautions for a child who
must sit in front.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
67
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 68 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Larger Children
■ Booster Seats
1Booster Seats
Safe Driving
If a lap/shoulder seat belt cannot be used
properly, position the child in a booster seat in
a rear seating position. For the child’s safety,
check that the child meets the booster seat
manufacturer’s recommendations.
When installing a booster seat, make sure to read the
instructions that came with it, and install the seat
accordingly.
There are high- and low-type booster seats. Choose a
booster seat that allows the child to wear the seat
belt correctly.
Some U.S. states and Canadian provinces and
territories require children to use a booster seat until
they reach a given age or weight (e.g. 6 years or 60
lbs). Be sure to check current laws in the state or
province, or territory where you intend to drive.
■ Protecting Larger Children-Final Checks
Your vehicle has a rear seat where children can be properly restrained. If you ever
have to carry a group of children, and a child must ride in front:
• Make sure you read and fully understand the instructions and safety information
in this manual.
• Move the front passenger seat as far back as possible.
• Have the child sit upright and well back in the seat.
• Check that the seat belt is properly positioned so that the child is secure in the
seat.
■ Monitoring child passengers
We strongly recommend that you keep an eye on child passengers. Even older, more
mature children sometimes need to be reminded to fasten their seat belts and sit up
properly.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
68
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 69 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Exhaust Gas Hazard
Carbon Monoxide Gas
The engine exhaust from this vehicle contains carbon monoxide, a colorless,
odorless, and highly toxic gas. As long as you properly maintain your vehicle, carbon
monoxide gas will not get into the interior.
• The exhaust system is making an unusual noise.
• The exhaust system may have been damaged.
• The vehicle is raised for an oil change.
3 WARNING
Carbon monoxide gas is toxic.
Breathing it can cause unconsciousness and
even kill you.
Avoid any enclosed areas or activities that
expose you to carbon monoxide.
When you operate a vehicle with the tailgate open, airflow can pull exhaust gas into
the interior and create a hazardous condition. If you must drive with the tailgate
open, open all the windows and set the heating and cooling system */climate control
system * as shown below.
1. Select the fresh air mode.
2. Select the
mode.
3. Set the fan speed to high.
4. Set the temperature control to a comfortable setting.
Safe Driving
■ Have the exhaust system inspected for leaks whenever
1Carbon Monoxide Gas
An enclosed area such as a garage can quickly fill up
with carbon monoxide gas.
Do not run the engine with the garage door closed.
Even when the garage door is open, drive out of the
garage immediately after starting the engine.
Adjust the heating and cooling system */climate control system * in the same manner
if you sit in your parked vehicle with the engine running.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
69
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 70 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Safety Labels
Label Locations
These labels are in the locations shown. They warn you of potential hazards that can cause serious injury or death. Read these labels
carefully.
Safe Driving
If a label comes off or becomes hard to read (except for the U.S. dashboard label which may be removed by the owner), contact a dealer
for a replacement.
Sun Visor
Sun Visor
U.S. models
U.S. models only
Canadian models
Doorjambs
U.S. models
Dashboard
U.S. models only
Doorjambs
Canadian models
Radiator Cap
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
70
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 71 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Instrument Panel
This chapter describes the buttons, indicators, and gauges that are used while driving.
Indicators ............................................ 72
Information Display Warning and
Information Messages...................... 85
Gauges and Displays
Gauges.............................................. 88
Information Display............................ 89
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
71
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 72 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Indicators
Indicator
Name
U.S.
Canada
On/Blinking
●
Instrument Panel
Brake System
Indicator
(Red)
●
●
Explanation
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
Comes on when the brake fluid level is
low.
Comes on if there is a problem with the
brake system.
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem with an
automatic brake hold system.
●
2 What to do when the indicator comes on while
driving P. 453
●
Canada
●
Brake System
Indicator
(Amber)
●
Comes on along with the ABS indicator - Have
your vehicle checked by a dealer.
2 If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
P. 453
(Red)
U.S.
Comes on while driving - Check the brake fluid
level.
Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle checked
by a dealer.
(Amber)
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
72
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 73 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
U.S.
Canada
●
●
●
Electric Parking
Brake System
Indicator
●
●
Automatic Brake
Hold System
Indicator
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off if the parking brake has been
released.
Comes on when the parking brake is
applied, and goes off when it is released.
Comes on for about 15 seconds when
you pull the electric parking brake switch
while the ignition switch is in LOCK (0 *1.
Stays on for about 15 seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1
while the electric parking brake is set.
●
Blinks and the electric parking brake system
indicator comes on at the same time - There is a
problem with the electric parking brake system. The
parking brake may not be set.
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem with the
electric parking brake system.
●
Comes on while driving - Avoid using the parking
brake and have your vehicle checked by a dealer
immediately.
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
Comes on when the automatic brake
hold system is on.
Instrument Panel
●
Electric Parking
Brake Indicator
Explanation
2 If the Electric Parking Brake System Indicator
Comes On P. 454
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 366
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
73
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 74 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
U.S.
Instrument Panel
Canada
On/Blinking
●
Automatic Brake
Hold Indicator
●
●
Continuously
variable
transmission
models
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
Comes on when the automatic brake
hold is activated.
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 366
●
●
Comes on when the electric parking
brake switch is pressed without
depressing the brake pedal while the
electric parking brake is in operation.
Automatic Brake Hold System
●
●
Comes on while driving - Press the electric
parking brake switch with the brake pedal
depressed.
2 Parking Brake P. 363
Electric Parking Brake System
Brake Depressing
Indicator
Manual
transmission
models
Explanation
Comes on when the automatic brake
hold button is pressed without
depressing the brake pedal while the
automatic brake hold is in operation.
Blinks if the automatic brake hold is
automatically canceled while it is in
operation. The beeper sounds.
●
Comes on while driving - Press the automatic
brake hold button with the brake pedal depressed.
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 366
●
Immediately depress the brake pedal.
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
74
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 75 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Low Oil Pressure
Indicator
●
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
●
●
●
Charging System
Indicator
Shift Lever Position
Indicator *
●
●
Comes on when you turn the ignition
switch to ON (w *1, and goes off when
the engine starts.
Comes on when the engine oil pressure
is low.
●
Comes on while driving - Immediately stop in a
safe place.
Comes on when you turn the ignition
switch to ON (w *1, and goes off either
when the engine starts or after several
seconds if the engine did not start. If
“readiness codes” have not been set, it
blinks five times before it goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem with the
emissions control system.
Blinks when a misfire in the engine’s
cylinders is detected.
●
Readiness codes are part of the on board diagnostics
for the emissions control systems.
●
Comes on while driving - Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
Blinks while driving - Stop in a safe place where
there are no flammable objects. Stop the engine for
10 minutes or more, and wait for it to cool down.
Then, take your vehicle to a dealer.
Comes on when you turn the ignition
switch to ON (w *1, and goes off when
the engine starts.
Comes on when the battery is not
charging.
●
2 If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On
P. 451
2 Testing of Readiness Codes P. 471
●
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
2 If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or
Blinks P. 452
Comes on while driving - Turn off the heating
and cooling system */climate control system * and
rear defogger in order to reduce electricity
consumption.
2 If the Charging System Indicator Comes On
P. 451
Indicates the current shift lever position.
2 Shifting P. 334, 336
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
75
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 76 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Transmission
Indicator *
Instrument Panel
M (7-speed manual
shift mode)
Indicator/Shift
Indicator *
On/Blinking
●
Blinks if the transmission system has a
problem.
●
Comes on when 7-speed manual shift
mode is applied.
●
●
Seat Belt Reminder
Indicator
●
●
Low Fuel Indicator
●
Explanation
●
Blinks while driving - Avoid sudden starts and
acceleration and have your vehicle checked by a
dealer immediately.
2 7-Speed Manual Shift Mode P. 338
Comes on and the beeper sounds if you
are not wearing a seat belt when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
If the front passenger is not wearing a
seat belt, the indicator comes on a few
seconds later.
Blinks while driving if either you or the
front passenger has not fastened a seat
belt. The beeper sounds and the
indicator blinks at regular intervals.
●
Comes on when the fuel reserve is
running low (approximately 1.98 U.S.
gal./7.5 Liter left).
Blinks if there is a problem with the fuel
gauge.
●
●
The beeper stops and the indicator goes off when
you and the front passenger fasten their seat belts.
Stays on after you or the front passenger has
fastened the seat belt - A detection error may
have occurred in the sensor. Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
2 Seat Belt Reminder P. 36
●
Comes on - Refuel your vehicle as soon as possible.
Blinks - Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
76
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 77 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Anti-lock Brake
System (ABS)
Indicator
●
Supplemental
Restraint System
Indicator
●
●
High Temperature
Indicator
(Red)
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
If it comes on at any other time, there is
a problem with the ABS.
●
Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle checked
by a dealer. With this indicator on, your vehicle still
has normal braking ability but no anti-lock function.
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
Comes on if a problem with any of the
following is detected:
- Supplemental restraint system
- Side airbag system
- Side curtain airbag system
- Seat belt tensioner
●
Stays on constantly or does not come on at all
- Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
Blinks when the engine coolant
temperature goes up, and stays on if the
temperature continues to rise.
●
Goes off, then comes on in blue when the engine
coolant temperature is low.
Blinks while driving - Drive slowly to prevent
overheating.
Stays on while driving - Immediately stop in a
safe place and allow the engine to cool.
2 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) P. 369
●
●
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
2 Overheating P. 449
Low Temperature
Indicator
(Blue)
●
Comes on while the engine coolant
temperature is low, then goes off once
the engine reaches normal operating
temperature.
●
If the indicator stays on after the engine has reached
normal operating temperature, there may be a
problem with the temperature sensors. Have your
vehicle inspected by a dealer.
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
77
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 78 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Instrument Panel
Vehicle Stability
Assist (VSA®) System
Indicator
Vehicle Stability
Assist (VSA®) OFF
Indicator
●
●
●
●
●
Door and Tailgate
Open Indicator
●
●
●
Electric Power
Steering (EPS)
System Indicator
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
Blinks when VSA® is active.
Comes on if there is a problem with the
VSA® system or hill start assist system.
Explanation
●
Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle checked
by a dealer.
2 Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic
Stability Control (ESC), System P. 354
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
Comes on when you deactivate VSA®.
2 VSA® OFF Button P. 355
Comes on for a few seconds if you turn
the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
Comes on if any door or the tailgate is
not completely closed.
The beeper sounds and the indicator
comes on if any door or the tailgate is
opened while driving.
●
Goes off when all doors and the tailgate are closed.
Comes on when you turn the ignition
switch to ON (w *1, and goes off when
the engine starts.
Comes on if there is a problem with the
EPS system.
●
Stays on constantly or does not come on at all
- Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
2 If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System
Indicator Comes On P. 453
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
78
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 79 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
Blinks for about one minute, and then
stays on if there is a problem with the
TPMS, or when a compact spare tire is
temporarily installed.
●
Blinks and remains on - Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer. If the vehicle is fitted with a
compact spare, get your regular tire repaired or
replaced and put back on your vehicle as soon as
you can.
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
set the power mode to ON, then goes
off.
Comes on as soon as a problem is
detected in the smart entry system or
push button starting system.
●
Stays on constantly or does not come on at all
- Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
●
Low Tire Pressure/
TPMS Indicator
Smart Entry System
Indicator *
●
●
●
Comes on while driving - Stop in a safe place,
check tire pressures, and inflate the tire(s) if
necessary.
Stays on after the tires are inflated to the
recommended pressures - The system needs to be
calibrated.
2 TPMS Calibration P. 359
Instrument Panel
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
May come on briefly if the ignition switch
is turned to ON (w *1 and the vehicle is
not moved within 45 seconds, to indicate
the calibration process is not yet
complete.
Comes on and stays on when:
- One or more tires’ pressures are
determined to be significantly low.
- The system has not been calibrated.
●
U.S.
models
only
Explanation
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
79
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 80 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
U.S.
Instrument Panel
Canada
On/Blinking
●
Starter System
Indicator *
Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning
Indicators
●
●
●
●
High Beam Indicator
Fog Light Indicator *
80
* Not available on all models
Comes on for a few seconds when you
set the power mode to ON, then goes off
when the engine starts.
Comes on if the starter system has a
problem.
●
As a temporary measure, press and hold the
ENGINE START/STOP button for up to 15 seconds
while pressing the brake pedal and clutch pedal
(manual transmission only), and manually start the
engine. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Blinks when you operate the turn signal
lever.
Blink if you press the hazard warning
button.
●
Does not blink or blinks rapidly - A turn signal
light bulb has blown. Change the bulb immediately.
2 Replacing Light Bulbs P. 400, 403
Comes on when the high beam
headlights are on.
●
Comes on whenever the light switch is
on, or in AUTO * when the exterior lights
are on.
●
Comes on when the fog lights are on.
Lights On Indicator
Explanation
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
—
●
If you remove the key from the ignition switch *, or
set the power mode * to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) while
the exterior lights are on, a chime sounds when the
driver’s door is opened.
—
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 81 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
●
Blinks Models without smart entry system
You cannot start the engine. Turn the ignition
switch to LOCK (0 , pull the key out, and then insert
the key and turn it to ON (w again.
Models with smart entry system
Immobilizer System
Indicator
●
●
●
ECON Mode
Indicator *
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
Comes on when you press the ECON
button.
You cannot start the engine. Set the power mode to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK), then select the ON mode
again.
Repeatedly blinks - The system may be
malfunctioning. Have your vehicle checked by a
dealer.
Do not attempt to alter this system or add other
devices to it. Electrical problems can occur.
Instrument Panel
Comes on briefly when you turn the
ignition switch to ON (w *1, then goes
off.
Comes on if the immobilizer system
cannot recognize the key information.
Explanation
2 ECON Button * P. 343
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
81
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 82 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Security System
Alarm Indicator
Explanation
Blinks when the security system alarm
has been set.
2 Security System Alarm P. 116
Indicator
Instrument Panel
CRUISE MAIN
Indicator
●
Comes on when you press the CRUISE
button.
2 Cruise Control P. 344
CRUISE CONTROL
Indicator
●
Comes on if you have set a speed for
cruise control.
2 Cruise Control P. 344
Washer Level
Indicator *
●
Maintenance
Minder Indicator
●
Comes on when the scheduled
maintenance is due soon.
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem with the
AWD.
Blinks when the AWD system is
overheated. The system is inactive.
All-Wheel Drive
(AWD) System
Indicator *
●
●
Comes on when the washer fluid gets
low.
●
Refill washer fluid.
2 Refilling Window Washer Fluid P. 398
2 Maintenance MinderTM P. 383
●
●
Stays on constantly - the engine drives only the
front wheels in this state. Have your vehicle checked
by a dealer.
Blinks while driving - the engine drives only the
front wheels in this state. Stop in a safe place, shift
to (P , and idle the engine until the indicator goes
off. If the indicator does not stop blinking, take your
vehicle to a dealer.
2 Real Time AWD with Intelligent Control
SystemTM * P. 358
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
82
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 83 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
●
Forward
Collision
Warning
(FCW)
Indicator *
●
Comes on for a few seconds
when you turn the ignition
switch to ON (w *1, then goes
off.
Comes on if there is a problem
with the FCW system.
Comes on when you have
customized FCW to turn off.
●
Stays on constantly without FCW off - Have
your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Blinks when the system detects
a likely collision with a vehicle in
front of you. The beeper
sounds.
●
Blinks while driving - Take appropriate action to
prevent a collision (apply the brakes, change lanes,
etc.).
Comes on when the FCW
system shuts itself off.
●
Message
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
—
Stays on - The temperature inside the FCW
system is too high. The system activates when the
temperature inside the system cools down.
2 Automatic shutoff P. 349
●
●
Stays on - The area around the camera is blocked
by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your vehicle in a safe place,
and wipe it off with a soft cloth.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if the
indicator and message come back on after you
cleaned the area around the camera.
2 Automatic shutoff P. 349
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
83
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 84 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Instrument Panel
●
●
Lane
Departure
Warning
(LDW)
Indicator *
●
Explanation
Comes on for a few seconds
when you turn the ignition
switch to ON (w *1, then goes
off.
Comes on if there is a problem
with the LDW system.
●
Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle checked
by a dealer.
Blinks when your vehicle is too
close to the lane lines. The
beeper sounds.
●
Blinks while driving - Take appropriate action to
keep your vehicle within the lane lines.
Comes on when the LDW
system shuts itself off.
●
Stays on - The temperature inside the LDW
camera is too high.
The system activates when the temperature inside
the camera cools down.
2 LDW Camera P. 352
●
●
Stays on - The area around the camera is blocked
by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your vehicle in a safe place,
and wipe it off with a soft cloth.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if the
indicator and message come back on after you
cleaned the area around the camera.
2 LDW Camera P. 352
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
84
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Message
—
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 85 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsuInformation Display Warning and Information Messages
Information Display Warning and Information Messages
The following messages appear only on the information display.
Message
Condition
●
Explanation
Appears when the fuel fill cap is loose or is not
installed.
2 Check Fuel Cap Message P. 452
Appears when there is a problem with the sensor on
the battery.
●
Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle checked
by a dealer.
Instrument Panel
●
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
85
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 86 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsuInformation Display Warning and Information Messages
Models with smart entry system
Message
Condition
●
Explanation
Appears if you push the ENGINE START/STOP
button to turn the engine off without the shift lever
in (P .
Push the ENGINE START/STOP button twice after
moving the shift lever to (P .
Instrument Panel
U.S. models with continuously variable transmission
●
●
Move the shift lever to (P .
Appears when the power mode is in ACCESSORY.
—
U.S. models with manual transmission
Canadian models
●
Move the steering wheel left and right while
pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button at the
same time.
●
Appears when the steering wheel is locked.
●
Appears when you close the door with the power
mode in ON without the smart entry remote inside
the vehicle.
●
Disappears when you bring the smart entry remote
back inside the vehicle and close the door.
●
Appears when the smart entry remote’s battery
becomes weak.
●
Replace the battery as soon as possible.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
86
Canadian models with continuously variable transmission
●
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 422
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 87 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicatorsuInformation Display Warning and Information Messages
Models with FCW
Message
Condition
●
Explanation
Appears when the warning distance setting has
been changed.
Instrument Panel
2 To change vehicle distance and to turn the
system on and off P. 349
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
87
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 88 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Gauges and Displays
Gauges
Gauges include the speedometer, tachometer and related indicators. They are
displayed when the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
■ Speedometer
Displays your driving speed in mph and km/h.
Instrument Panel
■ Tachometer
Shows the number of engine revolutions per minute.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
88
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 89 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuGauges and DisplaysuInformation Display
Information Display
1Switching the Display
The information display shows the fuel gauge, odometer, trip meter, engine oil life
and maintenance service item codes, and other gauges.
■ Switching the Display
Press the
Models with display audio system
Some of the items on the information display also
appear on the audio/information screen. They also
change along with the information display changes
while the fuel consumption is shown.
(select/reset) knob to change the display.
Instant Fuel Economy
Clock
Odometer
Trip Meter A
Outside Temperature
Fuel Gauge
Instant Fuel Economy
Clock
Range
Trip Meter A
Outside Temperature
Fuel Gauge
Instant Fuel Economy
Clock
Average Fuel Economy A
Trip Meter A
Outside Temperature
Fuel Gauge
Instant Fuel Economy
Clock
Average Fuel Economy B
Trip Meter B
Outside Temperature
Fuel Gauge
Instrument Panel
Select/Reset Knob
Instant Fuel Economy
Clock
Engine Oil Life
Fuel Gauge
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
89
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 90 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuGauges and DisplaysuInformation Display
■ Instant Fuel Economy
Shows the instant fuel economy as a bar graph in mpg (U.S.) or l/100 km (Canada).
■ Odometer
Instrument Panel
Shows the total number of miles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada) that your vehicle has
accumulated.
■ Trip Meter
1Trip Meter
Shows the total number of miles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada) driven since the last
reset. TRIP A and B can be used to measure two separate trips.
■ Resetting a trip meter
To reset a trip meter, display it, then press and hold the
reset to 0.0.
knob. The trip meter is
■ Range
Shows the estimated distance you can travel on the remaining fuel. This distance is
estimated from the fuel economy of your previous trips.
■ Average Fuel Economy
Shows the estimated average fuel economy of each trip meter in mpg (U.S.) or l/100
km (Canada). The display is updated at set intervals. When a trip meter is reset, the
average fuel economy is also reset.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
90
Switch between trip meter A and trip meter B by
pressing the
knob.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 91 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuGauges and DisplaysuInformation Display
■ Outside Temperature
1Outside Temperature
Shows the outside temperature in Fahrenheit (U.S.) or Celsius (Canada).
It may take several minutes for the display to be
updated after the temperature reading has stabilized.
When the engine oil life is shown on the information
display, you cannot adjust the outside temperature.
Push the
knob to select the other display.
Instrument Panel
■ Adjusting the outside temperature indicator
Adjust the temperature reading up to ± 5°F or ± 3°C if the temperature reading
seems incorrect.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Press and hold the
(Select/Reset) knob for 10 seconds or more while the
outside temperature is shown on the information display.
u The information display goes into temperature adjustment mode. The display
starts showing from -5°F to +5°F (U.S.) or -3°C to +3°C (Canada).
3. Release the
knob when the right adjustment amount is shown.
u The adjustment is complete.
The temperature sensor is in the front bumper.
Road heat and exhaust from another vehicle can
affect the temperature reading when your vehicle
speed is less than 19 mph (30 km/h).
■ Engine Oil Life and Maintenance Items
Shows the remaining oil life and Maintenance MinderTM.
2 Maintenance MinderTM P. 383
■ Fuel Gauge
1Fuel Gauge
NOTICE
Displays the amount of fuel left in the fuel tank.
You should refuel when the reading approaches E .
Running out of fuel can cause the engine to misfire,
damaging the catalytic converter.
The actual amount of remaining fuel may differ from
the fuel gauge reading.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
91
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 92 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuGauges and DisplaysuInformation Display
■ Changing Ring Color
Select/Reset Knob
Instrument Panel
The center ring illumination can be changed to a color of your choice. With the
ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (q or LOCK (0 *1 position and with the meter
ring illuminated, press the select/reset knob. Each time the knob is pressed, the
colors change in the following order:
White Blue Purple Pink Red Amber Yellow
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
92
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 93 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Controls
This chapter explains how to operate the various controls necessary for driving.
Clock.................................................................... 94
Locking and Unlocking the Doors
Key Types and Functions................................... 96
Low Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength * ........ 98
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside... 99
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside.....105
Childproof Door Locks.................................... 108
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking......................... 109
Customizing the Auto Door Locking/Unlocking
Setting ......................................................... 110
Opening and Closing the Tailgate .................. 113
Using the Tailgate Release Button................... 114
Security System................................................ 116
Immobilizer System......................................... 116
Security System Alarm .................................... 116
Opening and Closing the Windows................ 119
Opening and Closing the Moonroof * ............. 121
* Not available on all models
Operating the Switches Around the Steering
Wheel
Models without smart entry system
Ignition Switch.......................................... 122
Models with smart entry system
ENGINE START/STOP Button ..................... 123
Ignition Switch and Power Mode Comparison ...126
Turn Signals.............................................. 127
Light Switches .......................................... 127
Fog Lights * ............................................... 130
Daytime Running Lights ............................ 131
Wipers and Washers ................................. 132
Brightness Control .................................... 134
Defogger/Heated Door Mirror*/Heater Windshield*....135
Adjusting the Steering Wheel ................... 137
Adjusting the Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirror.............................138
Power Door Mirrors ...................................139
Adjusting the Seats
Adjusting the Seat Positions.......................140
Rear Seats .................................................146
Armrest .....................................................149
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items
Interior Lights ............................................150
Interior Convenience Items ........................152
Heating and Cooling System *
Using Vents, Heating and A/C ...................161
Climate Control System *
Using Automatic Climate Control ..............165
Synchronized Mode * .................................172
Automatic Climate Control Sensors ...........173
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
93
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 94 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Clock
Adjusting the Clock
1Adjusting the Time
Models without navigation system
You can adjust the time in the clock display with the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
■ Adjusting the Time
The clock in the information display is automatically
adjusted along with the audio system’s clock display.
Models with navigation system
■ Display audio system *
Controls
1. Select the
(HOME) icon, then select
Settings.
2. Select System, Clock, then Clock
Adjustment.
3. Adjust the hours and minutes by selecting
3/4.
4. Select OK to set the time.
The clock is automatically updated through the
navigation system, so the time does not need to be
adjusted.
Models without navigation system
You can customize the clock display to show the 12
hour clock or 24 hour clock.
2 Customized Features P. 238
1Display audio system *
You can turn the clock display on and off.
2 Customized Features P. 238
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
94
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 95 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuClockuAdjusting the Clock
■ Color audio system *
1Color audio system *
1. Press and hold the MENU/CLOCK button.
u Adjust Clock is selected.
2. Rotate
to change hour, then press .
3. Rotate
to change minute, then press
.
4. To enter the selection, rotate
and select
Set, then press .
These indications are used to show how to operate
the LIST/SELECT (List/Selector) knob.
Rotate
to select.
Press
to enter.
You can also select Adjust Clock by pressing the
MENU/CLOCK button.
Rotate
to select Adjust Clock, then press
.
Controls
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
95
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 96 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Locking and Unlocking the Doors
Key Types and Functions
This vehicle comes with the following keys:
1Key Types and Functions
■ Keys
Models with smart entry system
Smart
Entry
Remote *
Controls
96
Use the smart entry remote to start and stop
the engine, and to lock and unlock all the
doors and tailgate. You can also use the smart
entry system to lock and unlock the doors and
tailgate.
Models without smart entry system
Ignition Key
with Remote
Transmitter *
* Not available on all models
Use the key to start and stop the engine, and
to lock and unlock all the doors and tailgate.
You can also use the remote transmitter to
lock and unlock the doors and tailgate.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
All the keys have an immobilizer system. The
immobilizer system helps to protect against vehicle
theft.
2 Immobilizer System P. 116
The keys contain precision electronics.
Adhere to the following advice to prevent damage to
the electronics:
• Do not leave the keys in direct sunlight, or in
locations with high temperature or high humidity.
• Do not drop the keys or set heavy objects on them.
• Keep the keys away from liquids.
• Do not take the keys apart except for replacing the
battery.
If the circuits in the keys are damaged, the engine
may not start, and the remote transmitter/smart entry
system * may not work.
If the keys do not work properly, have them
inspected by a dealer.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 97 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuKey Types and Functions
■ Smart entry remote *
Release Knob
Built-in Key
The built-in key can be used to lock/unlock the
doors when the smart entry remote battery
becomes weak and the power door lock/
unlock operation is disabled.
■ Key Number Tag
1Key Number Tag
Contains a number that you will need if you
purchase a replacement key.
Controls
To remove the built-in key, pull it out while
sliding the release knob. To reinstall the builtin key, push the built-in key into the smart
entry remote until it clicks.
Keep the key number tag separate from the key in a
safe place outside of a vehicle.
If you wish to purchase an additional key, contact a
dealer.
If you lose your key and you cannot start the engine,
contact a dealer.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
97
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 98 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLow Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength *
Low Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength *
The vehicle transmits radio waves to locate the smart entry remote when locking/
unlocking the doors and tailgate, or to start the engine.
In the following cases, locking/unlocking the doors and tailgate, or starting the
engine may be inhibited or operation may be unstable:
• Strong radio waves are being transmitted by nearby equipment.
• You are carrying the smart entry remote together with telecommunications
equipment, laptop computers, cell phones, or wireless devices.
• A metallic object is touching or covering the smart entry remote.
Controls
98
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
1Low Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength *
Communication between the smart entry remote and
the vehicle consumes the smart entry remote’s
battery.
Battery life is about two years, but this varies
depending on regularity of use.
The battery is consumed whenever the smart entry
remote is receiving strong radio waves. Avoid placing
it near electrical appliances such as televisions and
personal computers.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 99 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Using the Remote Transmitter
Unlock Button
Lock Button
LED
Unlock Button
■ Locking the doors
Press the lock button.
Once:
u Some exterior lights flash, all the doors
and tailgate lock, and the security system
sets.
Twice (within five seconds after the first
push):
u A beeper sounds and verifies the security
system is set.
If you do not open a door within 30 seconds of
unlocking the vehicle with the remote transmitter,
the doors will automatically relock.
If the interior light switch is in the door activated
position, the interior lights come on when you press
the unlock button.
No doors opened: The lights fade out after 30
seconds.
Doors relocked with the remote transmitter: The
lights go off immediately.
The remote transmitter uses low-power signals, so
the operating range may vary depending on the
surroundings.
Lock Button
Controls
LED
1Using the Remote Transmitter
The remote transmitter will not lock the vehicle when
a door is open.
Models without smart entry system
The remote transmitter will not work when the key is
in the ignition switch.
Models with smart entry system
You can lock or unlock doors using the remote
transmitter or smart entry system only when the
power mode is in VEHICLE OFF.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
99
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 100 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Unlocking the doors
1Using the Remote Transmitter
Press the unlock button.
Once:
u Some exterior lights flash twice, and the driver’s door unlocks.
Twice:
u The remaining doors and the tailgate unlock.
Controls
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
100
If the distance at which the remote transmitter works
varies, the battery is probably low. Replace the
button battery as soon as possible.
If the LED does not come on when you press a
button, the battery is dead.
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 422
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 101 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Using the Smart Entry with Push Button Start System *
When you carry the smart entry remote, you
can lock/unlock the doors and the tailgate.
You can lock/unlock the doors and the
tailgate within a radius of about 32 inches (80
cm) of the outside door handle. You can open
the tailgate within about 32 inches (80 cm)
radius from the tailgate release button.
1Using the Smart Entry with Push Button Start System *
• Do not leave the smart entry remote in the vehicle
when you get out. Carry it with you.
• Even if you are not carrying the smart entry remote,
•
Door Lock
Button
■ Locking the doors and tailgate
Press the door lock button on the front door
or the tailgate.
u Some exterior lights flash; the beeper
sounds; all the doors and tailgate lock;
and the security system sets.
•
•
•
•
If the distance at which the remote transmitter works
varies, the battery is probably low. Replace the
button battery as soon as possible.
If the LED does not come on when you press a
button, the battery is dead.
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 422
Lock Button
* Not available on all models
Controls
•
you can lock/unlock the doors and the tailgate
while someone else with the remote is within
range.
The door may be unlocked if the door handle is
covered with water in heavy rain or in a car wash if
the smart entry remote is within range.
If you grip a front door handle wearing gloves, the
door sensor may be slow to respond or may not
respond by unlocking the doors.
You cannot unlock the door by gripping the handle
after two seconds of locking it.
The door might not open if you pull it immediately
after gripping the door handle. Grip the handle
again and confirm that the door is unlocked before
pulling the handle.
Even within the 32 inches (80 cm) radius, you may
not be able to lock/unlock the doors and the
tailgate with the smart entry remote if it is above or
below the outside handle.
The smart entry remote may not operate if it is too
close to the door and door glass.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
101
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 102 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Unlocking the doors and tailgate
Controls
Grab the driver’s door handle:
u The driver’s door unlocks.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and the
beeper sounds twice.
Grab the front passenger’s door handle:
u All the doors and the tailgate unlock.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and the
beeper sounds twice.
Press the tailgate release button:
u The tailgate unlocks.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and the
beeper sounds twice.
2 Using the Tailgate Release Button
P. 114
Tailgate Release
Button
102
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
1Using the Smart Entry with Push Button Start System *
If you do not open a door or the tailgate within 30
seconds of unlocking the vehicle, the doors will
automatically relock.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 103 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Locking/Unlocking the Doors Using a Key
1Locking/Unlocking the Doors Using a Key
Fully insert the key and turn it.
Lock
Unlock
Controls
When you lock the driver’s door with a key, all
the other doors and tailgate lock at the same
time. When unlocking, the driver’s door
unlocks first. Turn the key a second time
within a few seconds to unlock the remaining
doors and the tailgate.
If you unlock the doors with the key, the alarm goes
off when you open the hood or move the shift lever
out of (P (continuously variable transmission
models).
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
103
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 104 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Locking a Door Without Using a Key
1Locking a Door Without Using a Key
■ Locking the driver’s door
Push the lock tab forward a or push the
master door lock switch in the lock direction
b, and close the door.
■ Locking the passengers’ doors
Push the lock tab forward and close the door.
Controls
■ Lockout prevention system
Models without smart entry system
The doors and the tailgate cannot be locked when the key is in the ignition switch.
Models with smart entry system
The doors and the tailgate cannot be locked when the smart entry remote is inside
the vehicle.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
104
When you lock the driver’s door, all the other doors
and tailgate lock at the same time.
Make sure you have the key in your hand before
locking the door to prevent it from being locked in
the vehicle.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 105 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
■ Using the Lock Tab
To Lock
To Unlock
Lock Tab
1Using the Lock Tab
When you lock the door using the lock tab on the
driver’s door, all the other doors and the tailgate lock
at the same time.
When you unlock the door using the lock tab on the
driver’s door, only the driver’s door will unlock.
■ Locking a door
Push the lock tab forward.
■ Unlocking a door
Pull the lock tab rearward.
Controls
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
105
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 106 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
■ Unlocking Using the Front Door Inner Handle
Pull the front door inner handle.
u The door unlocks and opens in one
motion.
The front door inner handles are designed to allow
front seat occupants to open the door in one motion.
However this feature requires that front seat
occupants never pull a front door inner handle while
the vehicle is in motion.
Children should always ride in a rear seat where
childproof door locks are provided.
2 Childproof Door Locks P. 108
Inner Handle
Controls
Unlocking and opening the driver’s door from the inner handle unlocks all the other
doors.
To prevent all the doors unlocking, use the lock tab on the driver’s door to unlock,
then lock again before opening the door.
u This setting works for one time only. If you do not want all the doors to unlock
all the time, customize the Auto Door Unlock setting to Off using the master
door lock switch.
2 Auto Door Locking/Unlocking P. 109
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
106
1Unlocking Using the Front Door Inner Handle
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 107 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
■ Using the Master Door Lock Switch
1Using the Master Door Lock Switch
Press the master door lock switch in as shown
to lock or unlock all doors and the tailgate.
When you lock/unlock the driver’s door using the
master lock switch, all the other doors and the
tailgate lock/unlock at the same time.
To Lock
Master Door
Lock Switch
Controls
To Unlock
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
107
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 108 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuChildproof Door Locks
Childproof Door Locks
The childproof door locks prevent the rear doors from being opened from the inside
regardless of the position of the lock tab.
■ Setting the Childproof Door Locks
1Childproof Door Locks
Slide the lever in the rear door to the lock
position, and close the door.
Unlock
■ When opening the door
Controls
Open the door using the outside door handle.
Lock
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
108
To open the door from the inside when the
childproof door lock is on, put the lock tab in the
unlock position, lower the rear window, put your
hand out of the window, and pull the outside door
handle.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 109 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuAuto Door Locking/Unlocking
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking
Your vehicle locks and unlocks all doors automatically when a certain condition is
met.
■ Auto Door Locking
■ Drive lock mode
All doors lock when the vehicle’s speed reaches about 10 mph (15 km/h).
1Auto Door Locking/Unlocking
You can turn off or change to another auto door
locking/unlocking setting using the master door lock
switch.
2 Customizing the Auto Door Locking/
Unlocking Setting P. 110
■ Auto Door Unlocking
Controls
■ Driver’s door open mode
All doors unlock when the driver’s door is opened.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
109
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 110 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuCustomizing the Auto Door Locking/Unlocking Setting
Customizing the Auto Door Locking/Unlocking Setting
You can customize the auto door locking/unlocking setting to your liking using the master door lock switch.
■ List of the Auto Door Locking/Unlocking Customizable Options
■ Auto door locking
Mode
Description
Drive Lock Mode*1
All doors lock when the vehicle’s speed reaches about 10 mph (15 km/h).
Off
The auto door locking is deactivated all the time.
Controls
■ Auto door unlocking
Mode
Driver’s Door Open
Unlock Mode*1
Continuously variable
transmission models
Description
All doors unlock when the driver’s door is opened.
All doors unlock when the shift lever is moved into (P with the brake pedal depressed.
Park Unlock Mode
Off
The auto door unlocking is deactivated all the time.
*1 : Default setting
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
110
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 111 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuCustomizing the Auto Door Locking/Unlocking Setting
■ Customizing Flow for Auto Door Locking Options
Steps
Drive Lock Mode*1
Off
1
Apply the parking brake.
2
The driver’s door must be closed at this stage.
3
Turn the ignition switch to ON (w .
Push the ENGINE START/STOP button twice without depressing the brake pedal*3.
Open the driver’s door.
*2
Controls
Press and hold the front of the master door lock switch on the driver’s door. You will hear a click more than five seconds elapsed.
Release the switch.
4
5
Turn the ignition switch to OFF (0 within 20 seconds*2.
Push the ENGINE START/STOP button once without depressing the brake pedal*3.
u Customization is completed.
u All doors unlock and all turn signals blink three times.
*1 : Default setting
*2 : Models without smart entry system
*3 : Models with smart entry system
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
111
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 112 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuCustomizing the Auto Door Locking/Unlocking Setting
■ Customizing Flow for Auto Door Unlocking Options
Steps
Driver Door Open Unlock Mode*1
Continuously variable transmission models
Park Unlock Mode
Apply the parking brake.
1
Continuously variable transmission models
Move the shift lever out of (P with the
brake pedal depressed.
Apply the parking brake.
Move the shift lever to (P .
Controls
2
The driver’s door must be closed at this stage.
3
Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *2.
Push the ENGINE START/STOP button twice without depressing the brake pedal*3.
Off
Apply the parking brake.
Continuously variable transmission models
Move the shift lever to (P .
Open the driver’s door.
Press and hold the rear of the master door lock switch on the driver’s door. You will hear a click more than five seconds elapsed.
Release the switch.
4
5
Turn the ignition switch to OFF (0 within 20 seconds*2.
Push the ENGINE START/STOP button once without depressing the brake pedal*3.
u Customization is completed.
u All doors lock and all turn signals blink three times.
*1 : Default setting
*2 : Models without smart entry system
*3 : Models with smart entry system
112
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 113 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Opening and Closing the Tailgate
Precautions for Opening/Closing the Tailgate
Always make sure individuals and objects are clear of the tailgate before opening or
closing it.
■ Opening the tailgate
• Open the tailgate all the way.
u If it is not fully opened, the tailgate may come down accidentally by its own
weight.
• Be careful when it is windy. The wind may cause the tailgate to close.
1Precautions for Opening/Closing the Tailgate
Be careful not to hit your head on the tailgate or to
put your hands between the tailgate and the cargo
area when closing the tailgate.
When you are storing or picking up luggage from the
cargo area while the engine is idling, do not stand in
front of the exhaust pipe. You may get burned.
Keep the tailgate closed while driving to:
u Avoid possible damage.
u Prevent exhaust gas from leaking into the vehicle.
Controls
Do not allow any passenger in the cargo space. They
may get hurt during hard braking, a sudden
acceleration, or a crash.
■ Closing the tailgate
2 Carbon Monoxide Gas P. 69
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
113
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 114 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuUsing the Tailgate Release Button
Using the Tailgate Release Button
Tailgate
Release
Button
When all the doors are unlocked or you press
the tailgate unlock button on the remote
transmitter, the tailgate is unlocked. Press the
tailgate release button and lift open the
tailgate.
Models with smart entry system
Controls
Even if the tailgate is locked, you can open the
tailgate if you carry the smart entry remote.
To close the tailgate, grab the inner handle,
pull the tailgate down, and push it closed
from outside.
Inner
Handle
If you close the tailgate when all the doors are
locked, the tailgate locks automatically.
u Some exterior lights flash.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
114
1Using the Tailgate Release Button
Models with smart entry system
• Do not leave the smart entry remote in the vehicle
when you get out. Carry it with you.
• Even if you are not carrying the smart entry remote,
you can unlock the tailgate while someone else is
with the remote is within range.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 115 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuUsing the Tailgate Release Button
■ Remote Transmitter
1Remote Transmitter
Press the tailgate unlock button to unlock the
tailgate.
Controls
Tailgate
Unlock
Button
If you have unlocked and opened the tailgate using
the remote transmitter, or smart entry remote, when
closing, the tailgate locks automatically.
Tailgate
Unlock
Button
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
115
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 116 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Security System
Immobilizer System
The immobilizer system prevents a key that has not been pre-registered from
starting the engine. Each key contains electronic transmitters that use electronic
signals to verify the key.
Controls
Pay attention to the following when inserting the key into the ignition switch or
pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button:
• Do not allow objects that emit strong radio waves near the ignition switch or the
ENGINE START/STOP button.
• Make sure the key is not covered by or touching a metal object.
• Do not bring a key from another vehicle’s immobilizer system near the ignition
switch.
Security System Alarm
NOTICE
Leaving the ignition key in the vehicle can result in
theft or accidental movement of the vehicle.
Always take the ignition key with you whenever you
leave the vehicle unattended.
Do not alter the system or add other devices to it.
Doing so may damage the system and make your
vehicle inoperable.
1Security System Alarm
The security system alarm activates when the tailgate, hood or doors are forcibly
opened. The alarm does not go off if the tailgate or doors are opened with the key,
remote transmitter or smart entry system.
However, the alarm goes off when a door is opened with the key, then the shift
lever is moved out of (P (continuously variable transmission models) or the hood is
opened before the ignition switch is turned to ON (w *1.
■ When the security system alarm activates
The horn sounds intermittently and all of the exterior lights flash.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
116
1Immobilizer System
The security alarm continues for a maximum of two
minutes until the security system deactivates.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 117 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuSecurity SystemuSecurity System Alarm
■ To deactivate the security system alarm
Unlock the vehicle using the remote transmitter or smart entry remote, or turn the
ignition switch to ON (w *1. The system, along with the horn and flashing lights, is
deactivated.
■ When the security system alarm sets
The security system alarm indicator in the instrument panel blinks. When the
blinking interval changes after about 15 seconds, the security system alarm is set.
Do not set the security system alarm when someone
is in the vehicle or a window is open. The system can
accidentally activate when:
• Unlocking the door with the lock tab.
• Opening the hood with the hood release handle.
Continuously variable transmission models
• Moving the shift lever out of (P .
If the battery goes dead after you have set the
security system alarm, the security alarm may go off
once the battery is recharged or replaced.
If this occurs, deactivate the security system alarm by
unlocking a door using the key, remote transmitter,
or smart entry system.
Controls
■ Setting the security system alarm
The security system alarm automatically sets when the following conditions have
been met:
• The ignition switch is in LOCK (0 *1, and the key has been removed from the
ignition switch.
• The hood is closed.
• All doors and the tailgate are locked from outside with the key, remote
transmitter, or smart entry system.
1Security System Alarm
Do not attempt to alter this system or add another
device to it.
■ To cancel the security system alarm
The security system alarm is canceled when the vehicle is unlocked using the remote
transmitter or smart entry system, or the ignition switch is turned to ON (w *1. The
security system alarm indicator goes off at the same time.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
117
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 118 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuSecurity SystemuSecurity System Alarm
■ Panic Mode
■ The panic button on the remote
transmitter
If you press the panic button for
approximately one second, the following will
occur for about 30 seconds:
• The horn sounds.
• Some exterior lights flash.
Controls
Panic Button
■ Canceling panic mode
Press any button on the remote transmitter, or turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
118
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 119 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Opening and Closing the Windows
Opening/Closing the Power Windows
The power windows can be opened and closed when the ignition switch is in ON
(w *1, using the switches on the doors. The driver’s side switches can be used to
open and close all of the windows.
The power window lock button on the driver’s side must be switched off (not
pushed in, indicator off) to open and close the windows from anywhere other than
the driver’s seat.
■ Opening/Closing Windows with Auto-Open/Close Function
Driver’s
Window
Switch
On
Off
Indicator
Power Window Lock Button
■ Automatic operation
To open: Push the switch down firmly.
To close: Pull the switch up firmly.
The window opens or closes completely. To
stop the window at any time, push or pull the
switch briefly.
3 WARNING
Closing a power window on someone’s
hands or fingers can cause serious injury.
Make sure your passengers are away from
the windows before closing them.
The power windows can be operated for up to 10
minutes after you turn the ignition switch to LOCK
(0 *1. Opening either front door cancels this function.
Controls
When the power window lock button is pushed in, the indicator comes on and you
can only operate the driver’s window. Turn the power window lock button on when
children are in the vehicle.
1Opening/Closing the Power Windows
Auto Reverse
If a power window senses resistance when closing
automatically, it will stop closing and reverse
direction.
The driver’s window auto reverse function is disabled
when you continuously pull up the switch.
The auto reverse function stops sensing when the
window is almost closed to ensure that it fully closes.
■ Manual operation
To open: Push the switch down lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Pull the switch up lightly, and hold it
until the desired position is reached.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
119
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 120 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOpening and Closing the WindowsuOpening/Closing the Power Windows
■ Opening/Closing Windows without Auto-Open/Close
Function
Close
To open: Push the switch down lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Pull the switch up lightly, and hold it
until the desired position is reached.
Open
Controls
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
120
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 121 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Opening and Closing the Moonroof *
■ Opening/Closing the Moonroof
1Opening/Closing the Moonroof
You can only operate the moonroof when the ignition switch is in ON (w *1. Use the
switch in the front of the ceiling to open and close the moonroof.
■ Automatic operation
To open: Pull the switch back firmly.
Open
To close: Push the switch forward firmly.
Tilt
■ Manual operation
To open: Pull the switch back lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Push the switch forward lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
■ Tilting the moonroof up
To tilt: Push on the center of the moonroof
switch.
To close: Push the switch forward firmly,
then release.
Opening or closing the moonroof on
someone's hands or fingers can cause
serious injury.
Make sure all hands and fingers are clear of
the moonroof before opening or closing it.
NOTICE
Opening the moonroof in below freezing
temperature or when it is covered with snow or ice
can damage the moonroof panel or motor.
Controls
Close
The moonroof will automatically open or close
all the way. To stop the moonroof midway,
touch the switch briefly.
3 WARNING
The power moonroof can be operated for up to 10
minutes after you turn the ignition switch to LOCK
(0 *1. Opening either front door cancels this function.
When resistance is detected, the auto reverse
function causes the moonroof to change directions,
then stop. Auto reverse stops sensing when the
moonroof is almost closed to ensure that it fully
closes.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
121
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 122 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel
Models without smart entry system
Ignition Switch
1Ignition Switch
Manual transmission models
3 WARNING
(0 LOCK: Insert and remove the key in this
position.
(q ACCESSORY: Operate the audio system and
other accessories in this position.
(w ON: This is the position when driving.
Controls
(e START: This position is for starting the engine.
The switch returns to ON (w when you let go of
the key.
Removing the key from the ignition switch
while driving locks the steering. This can
cause you to lose control of the vehicle.
Remove the key from the ignition switch
only when parked.
Continuously variable transmission models
You cannot take the key out unless the shift lever is
in (P .
All models
If you open the driver’s door when the key is in LOCK
(0 or ACCESSORY (q , a warning buzzer will sound
to remind you to take the key out.
If the key won’t turn from LOCK (0 to ACCESSORY
(q , turn the key while moving the steering wheel left
and right. The steering wheel will unlock, allowing
the key to turn.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
122
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 123 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluENGINE START/STOP Button
Models with smart entry system
ENGINE START/STOP Button
1ENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Changing the Power Mode
Continuously Variable Transmission
ENGINE START/STOP Button Operating Range
Operating Range
Manual Transmission
Indicator
Indicator
You can start the engine when the smart entry
remote is inside the vehicle.The engine may also run
if the smart entry remote is close to the door or
window, even if it is outside the vehicle.
ACCESSORY
Indicator in the button is on.
Indicator in the button blinks
(from ON to ACCESSORY).
Operate the audio system and
other accessories in this position.
ON mode:
Indicator in the button is off, if the engine is running.
If the smart entry remote battery is weak, beeper
sounds and the
message appears in the
information display.
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
P. 444
ON
Indicator in the button is on.
All electrical components can
be used.
Without depressing
the clutch pedal
Without depressing
the brake pedal
Press the button without the shift lever in (P .
Except U.S. models with continuously variable transmission
Press the button.
U.S. models
Do not leave the power mode in ACCESSORY or ON
when you get out.
If the power mode does not change from VEHICLE
OFF to ACCESSORY, press the ENGINE START/STOP
button while moving the steering wheel left and
right. The steering wheel will unlock, allowing the
mode to change.
Shift to (P then press the button.
Shift to (P .
*1 : Except U.S. models with continuously variable transmission
Controls
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
Indicator in the button is off.
The steering wheel is locked.*1
The power to all electrical
components is turned off.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
123
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 124 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Automatic Power Off
If you leave the vehicle for 30 to 60 minutes with the shift lever in (P *1 and the
power mode in ACCESSORY, the vehicle automatically goes into the mode similar to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) to avoid the battery drain.
Except U.S. models with continuously variable transmission
Controls
When in this mode:
The steering wheel does not lock.
You cannot lock or unlock doors with the remote transmitter or the smart entry
system.
Press the ENGINE START/STOP button to switch the mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
*1: Continuously variable transmission models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
124
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 125 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Power Mode Reminder
If you open the driver’s door when the power mode is set to ACCESSORY, a warning
buzzer sounds.
■ Smart Entry Remote Reminder
1Smart Entry Remote Reminder
■ When the power mode is in ON
If the smart entry remote is taken out of the
vehicle, and the driver’s door is closed,
warning buzzers sound from both inside and
outside the vehicle. A warning message on
the information display notifies the driver
inside that the remote is out.
■ When the power mode is in
ACCESSORY
If the smart entry remote is taken out of the
vehicle, and all the doors are closed, a
warning buzzer sounds from outside the
vehicle.
When the smart entry remote is within the system’s
operational range, and the driver’s door is closed, the
warning function cancels.
If the smart entry remote is taken out of the vehicle
after the engine has been started, you can no longer
change the ENGINE START/STOP button mode or
restart the engine. Always make sure if the remote is
in your vehicle when you operate the ENGINE
START/STOP button.
Controls
Warning buzzers may sound from inside or/
and outside the vehicle to remind you that the
smart entry remote is out of the vehicle. If the
buzzer continues even after the remote is put
back inside, place it to be within its
operational range.
Removing the smart entry remote from the vehicle
through a window does not activate the warning
buzzer.
Do not put the smart entry remote on the dashboard
or in the glove box. It may cause the warning buzzer
to go off. Under some other conditions that can
prevent the vehicle from locating the remote, the
warning buzzer may also go off even if the remote is
within the system’s operational range.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
125
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 126 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluIgnition Switch and Power Mode Comparison
Ignition Switch and Power Mode Comparison
Ignition Switch
Position
Without Smart
Entry System
LOCK (0
(with/without
the key)
●
●
Controls
●
Power Mode
Engine is turned off and
power is shut down.
The steering wheel is
locked.
No electrical components
can be used.
VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK)
ACCESSORY (q
●
●
Engine is turned off.
Some electrical
components such as the
audio system and the
accessory power socket
can be operated.
ACCESSORY
ON (w
●
●
Normal key position
while driving.
All electrical components
can be used.
ON
Indicator is:
With Smart Entry
System and
ENGINE START/
STOP Button
Indicator-Off
Indicator-On or blinking
● Engine is turned off and
● Engine is turned off.
● Some electrical
power is shut down.
● The steering wheel is
components such as the
locked.*1
audio system and the
● No electrical components
accessory power socket
can be used.
can be operated.
*1 : Except U.S. models with continuously variable transmission
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
126
START (e
●
●
Use this position to start
the engine.
The ignition switch
returns to ON (w when
you release the key.
START
On
Off
IndicatorIndicator-Off
● The mode automatically
On (engine is turned off)
returns to ON after the
Off (engine is running)
● All electrical components
engine starts.
can be used.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 127 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluTurn Signals
Turn Signals
The turn signals can be used when the ignition
switch is in ON (w *1.
Right Turn
■ One-touch turn signal
When you lightly push up or down and release
the turn signal lever, the exterior turn signals
and turn signal indicator blink three times.
Left Turn
Light Switches
1Light Switches
Models without smart entry system
■ Manual Operation
High Beams
Flashing the high beams
Low Beams
Turns on parking, side marker,
tail, and rear license plate lights
Controls
This feature can be used when signaling for a
lane change.
Rotating the light switch turns the lights on
and off, regardless of the position of the
ignition switch*1.
■ High beams
Push the lever forward until you hear a click.
■ Low beams
When in high beams, pull the lever back to
return to low beams.
■ Flashing the high beams
Pull the lever back, and release it.
If you remove the key from the ignition switch while
the lights are on, a chime sounds when the driver’s
door is opened.
Models with smart entry system
If you leave the power mode in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
while the lights are on, a chime sounds when the
driver’s door is opened.
All models
Do not leave the lights on when the engine is off
because it will cause the battery to discharge.
If you sense that the level of the headlights is
abnormal, have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
Turns on headlights, parking, side
marker, tail, and rear license plate
lights
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
127
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 128 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
■ Automatic Lighting Control *
1Automatic Lighting Control *
Automatic lighting control can be used when
the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
We recommend that you turn on the lights manually
when driving at night, in a dense fog, or in dark areas
such as long tunnels or parking facilities.
When you turn the light switch to AUTO, the
headlights and other exterior lights will switch
on and off automatically depending on the
ambient brightness.
The light sensor is in the location shown below.
Do not cover this light sensor with anything;
otherwise, the automatic lighting system may not
work properly.
Controls
Light Sensor
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
128
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 129 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
■ Headlight Integration with Wipers *
1Headlight Integration with Wipers *
The headlights automatically come on when the wipers are used several times within
a certain intervals with the headlight switch in AUTO.
The headlights automatically go off a few minutes later if the wipers are stopped.
■ Automatic Lighting Off Feature
If you turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1 with the headlight switch on, but do
not open the door, the lights turn off after 10 minutes (3 minutes, if the switch is in
the AUTO position).
When the ambient light is at dark, the automatic
lighting control feature overrides, and the headlights
come on with or without the wipers sweeping more
than several times.
Controls
The headlights, all other exterior lights, and the instrument panel lights turn off 15
seconds after you remove the key or set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK),
take the remote with you, and close the driver's door.
This feature activates while the headlights are off in
AUTO.
The instrument panel brightness does not change
when the headlights come on.
The lights turn on again when you unlock or open the driver's door. If you unlock
the door, but do not open it within 15 seconds, the lights go off. If you open the
driver's door, you will hear a lights on reminder chime.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
129
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 130 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluFog Lights *
Fog Lights *
When the low beam headlights are on, turn
the fog light switch on to use the fog lights.
1Fog Lights *
When the fog lights are on, the indicator in the
instrument panel will be on.
2 Fog Light Indicator * P. 80
The fog lights go off when the headlights turn off, or
when the daytime running lights are on.
Fog Light Switch
Controls
130
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 131 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDaytime Running Lights
Daytime Running Lights
The headlights come on slightly dimmer than normal when the following conditions
have been met:
• The ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
• The headlight switch is off, or in
.
• The parking brake is released.
The lights remain on even if you set the parking brake. Turning off the ignition
switch or setting the power mode to VEHICLE OFF will turn off the daytime running
lights.
Controls
The headlights return to the original brightness once the headlight switch is turned
on.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
131
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 132 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
Wipers and Washers
■ Front Wiper/Washer
1Wipers and Washers
The windshield wipers and washers can be
used when the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
Pull to
use
washer.
Controls
Intermittent Time
Adjustment Ring *
■ MIST
The wipers run at high speed until you release
the lever.
■ Wiper switch (OFF, INT, LO, HI)
Change the wiper switch setting according to
the amount of rain.
■ Adjusting wiper operation *
MIST
OFF
INT: Low speed with
intermittent
LO: Low speed wipe
HI: High speed wipe
Turn the adjustment ring to adjust the wiper
operation.
Lower speed, fewer sweeps
Higher speed, more sweeps
■ Washer
Sprays while you pull the lever toward you.
When you release the lever, the wipers make
two or three more sweeps before stopping.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
132
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
NOTICE
Do not use the wipers when the windshield is dry.
The windshield will get scratched, or the rubber
blades will get damaged.
NOTICE
In cold weather, the blades may freeze to the
windshield, becoming stuck.
Operating the wipers in this condition may damage
the wipers. Use the defroster to warm the
windshield, then turn the wipers on.
Models with adjustment ring
If the vehicle speeds up while the wipers are
operating intermittently, the length of the wipe
interval shortens. When the vehicle starts moving, the
wipers make a single sweep.
When the vehicle speeds up, the wiper operation's
shortest delay ( ) and the LO setting become the
same.
All models
Turn the washers off if no washer fluid comes out.
The pump may get damaged.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 133 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
■ Rear Wiper/Washer
1Wipers and Washers
The rear wiper and washer can be used when
the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
■ Wiper switch (OFF, INT, ON)
Change the wiper switch setting according to
the amount of rain.
INT: Intermittent
)
Sprays while you rotate the switch to this
position.
OFF
Washer
Rotate the wiper switch to OFF, and turn the ignition
switch to ACCESSORY (q or LOCK (0 *1, then
remove the obstacle.
The wiper motor is equipped with a breaker that may
stop motor operation temporarily to prevent an
overload. Wiper operation will return to normal
within a few minutes, once the circuit has returned to
normal.
Controls
ON
■ Washer (
If the wiper stops operating due to any obstacle such
as the build-up of snow, park the vehicle in a safe
place.
Hold it to activate the wiper and to spray the
washer. Once released, it stops operating
after a few more sweeps.
■ Operating in reverse
When you shift the transmission to (R with the front wiper activated, the rear wiper
operates automatically as follows even if its switch is off.
Front Wiper Position
Rear Wiper Operation
INT (Intermittent)
Intermittent
LO (Low speed wipe)
HI (High speed wipe)
Continuous
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
133
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 134 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluBrightness Control
Brightness Control
When the ignition switch is in ON (w *1, you
can use the
(select/reset) knob to adjust
instrument panel brightness.
Brighten: Turn the knob to the right.
Dim: Turn the knob to the left.
(Select/Reset) Knob
Controls
You will hear a beep when the brightness
reaches minimum or maximum. The
information display will return to its original
state several seconds after you adjust the
brightness.
■ Brightness level indicator
The brightness level is shown on the
information display while you are adjusting it.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
134
1Brightness Control
Instrument panel brightness varies, depending on
whether the exterior lights are on or off. The
instrument panel dims to reduce glare when they are
on.
Pressing the
knob switches the display between
the brightness level and other available information.
If you turn the knob to the right until the brightness
display is up to max, the beeper sounds. This cancels
the reduced instrument panel brightness when the
parking lights are on.
The brightness can be set differently for when the
exterior lights are on, and when they are off.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 135 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDefogger/Heated Door Mirror */Heater Windshield *
Defogger/Heated Door Mirror */Heater Windshield *
■ Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror * Button
Models with heating and cooling system
1Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror * Button
Press the rear defogger button or touch the
icon to defog the rear window and mirrors
when the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
NOTICE
When cleaning the inside of the rear window, be
careful not to damage the heating wires.
It is critical to wipe the window from side to side
along the defogger heating wires.
Models with climate control system
This system consumes a lot of power, so turn it off
when the window has been defogged.
Also, do not use the system for a long period when
the engine is idling. This may weaken the battery,
making it difficult to start the engine.
Controls
Models with climate control system
The rear defogger and heated door mirrors
automatically switch off after 10-30 minutes
depending on the outside temperature.
However, if the outside temperature is 32°F
(0°C) or below, they do not automatically
switch off.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
135
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 136 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDefogger/Heated Door Mirror */Heater Windshield *
Canadian models
1Heated Windshield Button
■ Heated Windshield Button
This system consumes a lot of power, so turn it off
when the window has been defogged or deiced.
Press the heated windshield button to deice
the windshield when the ignition switch is
turned to ON (w *1.
The heated windshield automatically switch
off after 15 minutes.
Controls
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
136
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 137 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluAdjusting the Steering Wheel
Adjusting the Steering Wheel
1Adjusting the Steering Wheel
3 WARNING
Adjusting the steering wheel position while
driving may cause you to lose control of the
vehicle and be seriously injured in a crash.
Adjust the steering wheel only when the
vehicle is stopped.
Make any steering wheel adjustments before you
start driving.
Controls
The steering wheel height and distance from your body can be adjusted so that you
can comfortably grip the steering wheel in an appropriate driving posture.
1. Pull the steering wheel adjustment lever up.
To adjust
u The steering wheel adjustment lever is
under the steering column.
2. Move the steering wheel up or down, and
in or out.
To lock
u Make sure you can see the instrument
panel gauges and indicators.
3. Push the steering wheel adjustment lever
Lever
down to lock the steering wheel in position.
u After adjusting the position, make sure
you have securely locked the steering
wheel in place by trying to move it up,
down, in, and out.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
137
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 138 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Adjusting the Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirror
Adjust the angle of the rearview mirror when you are sitting in the correct driving
position.
■ Rearview Mirror with Day and Night Positions *
Tab
Up
Flip the tab to switch the position.
The night position will help to reduce the glare
from headlights behind you when driving
after dark.
Keep the inside and outside mirrors clean and
adjusted for best visibility.
Adjust the mirrors before you start driving.
2 Adjusting the Seat Positions P. 140
Controls
Daytime
Position
Down
Night Position
■ Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror *
1Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror *
When driving after dark, the automatic
dimming rearview mirror reduces the glare
from headlights behind you. Press the auto
button to turn this function on and off. When
activated, the auto indicator comes on.
Indicator
138
1Adjusting the Mirrors
Sensor
Auto Button
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
The auto dimming function cancels when the shift
lever is in (R .
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 139 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAdjusting the MirrorsuPower Door Mirrors
Power Door Mirrors
Selector Switch
Adjustment Switch
You can adjust the door mirrors when the
ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
■ Expanded View Driver's Mirror
Outer Segment
1Expanded View Driver's Mirror
The driver side door mirror has outer and inner
segments.
The outer segment is slightly curved to provide
a wider angle view than a standard flat mirror.
This wider view may help you check areas that
are not visible using a standard door mirror.
Controls
■ Mirror position adjustment
L/R selector switch: Select the left or right
mirror. After adjusting the mirror, return the
switch to the center position.
Mirror position adjustment switch: Press
the switch left, right, up, or down to move the
mirror.
Objects visible in the outer segment of the driver side
door mirror appear smaller than objects in the rest of
the mirror. But in fact, they are closer than they
appear.
Do not rely on your mirrors. Always look to the side
and behind your vehicle before changing lanes.
Inner Segment
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
139
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 140 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Adjusting the Seats
Adjusting the Seat Positions
Allow sufficient
space.
Move back.
Controls
Adjust the driver’s seat as far back as possible
while allowing you to maintain full control of
the vehicle. You should be able to sit upright,
well back in the seat and be able to
adequately press the pedals without leaning
forward, and grip the steering wheel
comfortably. The passenger’s seat should be
adjusted in a similar manner, so that it is as far
back from the front airbag in the dashboard
as possible.
1Adjusting the Seats
3 WARNING
Sitting too close to a front airbag can result
in serious injury or death if the front
airbags inflate.
Always sit as far back from the front
airbags as possible while maintaining
control of the vehicle.
■ Adjusting the front seat
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
and Transport Canada recommend that drivers allow
at least 10 inches (25 cm) between the center of the
steering wheel and the chest.
Height Adjustment
(Driver side only)
Pull up or push down the lever
to raise or lower the seat.
Always make seat adjustments before driving.
1Adjusting the front seat
Once a seat is adjusted correctly, rock it back and
forth to make sure it is locked in position.
Horizontal Position
Adjustment
Seat-back Angle Adjustment
Pull up on the bar to move the
seat, then release the bar.
Pull up the lever to change the
angle.
Driver’s seat is shown.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
140
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 141 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
■ Adjusting the Seat-Backs
1Adjusting the Seat-Backs
Adjust the driver’s seat-back to a comfortable,
upright position, leaving ample space
between your chest and the airbag cover in
the center of the steering wheel.
Reclining a seat-back so that the shoulder part of the belt no longer rests against the
occupant’s chest reduces the protective capability of the belt. It also increases the
chance of sliding under the belt in a crash and being seriously injured. The farther a
seat-back is reclined, the greater the risk of injury.
Reclining the seat-back too far can result in
serious injury or death in a crash.
Adjust the seat-back to an upright position,
and sit well back in the seat.
Do not put a cushion, or other object, between the
seat-back and your back.
Controls
The front seat passenger should also adjust
their seat-back to a comfortable, upright
position.
3 WARNING
Doing so may interfere with proper seat belt or airbag
operation.
If you cannot get far enough away from the steering
wheel and still reach the controls, we recommend
that you investigate whether some type of adaptive
equipment may help.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
141
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 142 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
■ Adjusting the Head Restraints
1Adjusting the Head Restraints
Your vehicle is equipped with head restraints
in all seating positions.
Controls
Position head in the center
of the head restraint.
Head restraints are most effective for
protection against whiplash and other rearimpact crash injuries when the center of the
back of the occupant’s head rests against the
center of the restraint. The tops of the
occupant’s ears should be level with the
center height of the restraint.
■ Adjusting the front head restraint positions
To raise the head restraint:
Pull it upward.
To lower the head restraint:
Push it down while pressing the release
button.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
142
3 WARNING
Improperly positioning head restraints
reduces their effectiveness and increases
the likelihood of serious injury in a crash.
Make sure head restraints are in place and
positioned properly before driving.
In order for the head restraint system to work
properly:
• Do not hang any items on the head restraints, or
from the restraint legs.
• Do not place any objects between an occupant and
the seat-back.
• Install each restraint in its proper location.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 143 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
■ Changing the Rear Seat Head Restraint Positions
Outer
Center
Controls
A passenger sitting in a back seating position
should adjust the height of their head restraint
to an appropriate position before the vehicle
begins moving.
To raise the head restraint:
Pull it upward.
To lower the head restraint:
Push it down while pressing the release
button.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
143
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 144 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
■ Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints
3 WARNING
Head restraints can be removed for cleaning or repair.
To remove a head restraint:
Pull the restraint up as far as it will go. Then push the release button, and pull the
restraint up and out.
Controls
To reinstall a head restraint:
Insert the legs back in place, then adjust the head restraint to an appropriate height
while pressing the release button. Pull up on the restraint to make sure it is locked
in position.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
144
1Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints
Failure to reinstall, or correctly reinstall, the
head restraints can result in severe injury
during a crash.
Always replace the head restraints before
driving.
To remove and install the rear outer head restraint,
recline the seat-back slightly forward as the space
between the ceiling and the seat-back is limited.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 145 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
■ Maintain a Proper Sitting Position
1Maintain a Proper Sitting Position
3 WARNING
Sitting improperly or out of position can
result in serious injury or death in a crash.
Always sit upright, well back in the seat,
with your feet on the floor.
Controls
After all occupants have adjusted their seats and head restraints, and put on their
seat belts, it is very important that they continue to sit upright, well back in their
seats, with their feet on the floor, until the vehicle is safely parked and the engine is
off.
Sitting improperly can increase the chance of injury during a crash. For example, if
an occupant slouches, lies down, turns sideways, sits forward, leans forward or
sideways, or puts one or both feet up, the chance of injury during a crash is greatly
increased.
In addition, an occupant who is out of position in the front seat can be seriously or
fatally injured in a crash by striking interior parts of the vehicle or being struck by an
inflating front airbag.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
145
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 146 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuRear Seats
Rear Seats
■ Adjusting the Rear Seat-Backs
Pull the lever on the right to change the angle
of the right half of the seat-back, and left for
the left half.
Controls
Release Lever
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
146
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 147 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuRear Seats
■ Folding Down the Rear Seats
1Folding Down the Rear Seats
The rear seats can be folded down separately to allow for additional storage space.
Anchor
Buckle
Remove any items from the rear seat cushion and
floor before you fold down the rear seat.
To lock the seat-back upright, push it backwards until
it locks.
2 Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor P. 41
Latch Plate
3. Lower the head restraint to its lowest
position.
4. Pull the release lever and fold down the
seat-back.
Make sure the seat-back, head restraints and seat
cushion are securely latched back into place before
driving. Also, make sure all rear shoulder belts are
positioned in front of the seat-back, and the center
shoulder belt is re-positioned in the holding slot.
To return the seat to the original position, pull
up the seat-back in the upright position.
Make sure that the folded seat-back does not press
against the front passenger seat, as this can cause the
weight sensors in the front passenger seat to work
improperly.
2 Passenger Airbag Off Indicator P. 55
Controls
■ To fold down the seat
1. Store the center seat belt first. Insert the
latch plate into the slot on the side of the
anchor buckle.
2. Retract the seat belt into the holder on the
ceiling.
Make sure all items in the cargo area or items
extending to the rear seats are properly
secured. Loose items can fly forward if you have
to brake hard.
Release Lever
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
147
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 148 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuRear Seats
■ Folding the Rear Seat Up
1Folding the Rear Seat Up
Separately lift up the left and right halves of
the rear seat cushions to make room for cargo
area.
Loop
■ Lifting up the seat cushion
1. Make sure the seat belt buckles are in their
loops on the seat.
Controls
2. Pull up the rear seat cushion.
3. Fold the seat leg down while pushing the
seat cushion firmly against the seat-back to
lock it.
Seat Leg
Seat Leg
Latch
Floor Guide
■ Putting the seat in the original position
1. Hold the seat cushion in the upright
position, and pull up the seat leg fully.
u The seat cushion can abruptly fall down
once you pull up the seat leg.
2. Slowly put down the seat cushion and set
the seat leg in the floor guide.
u A latch comes out when the leg is set
properly.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
148
After you fold the seat up, or put it back in the
original position, make sure the seat is firmly secured
by rocking it forward and back.
Check if there are any items on the seat before you
pull the seat cushion up. Check if there are any
obstacles around the floor guide before you put the
seat back in the original position.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 149 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuArmrest
Armrest
■ Using the Front Seat Armrest
The console lid can be used as an armrest.
To adjust:
Slide the armrest to the desired position.
Controls
■ Using the Rear Seat Armrest *
Pull down the armrest in the center seat-back.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
149
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 150 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items
Interior Lights
■ Interior Light Switches
1Interior Light Switches
■ ON
Front *
Off
Controls
Door Activated Position
The interior lights come on regardless of
whether the doors are open or closed.
■ Door activated
The interior lights come on in the following
situations:
• When any of the doors are opened.
• You unlock the driver’s door.
Models without smart entry system
Rear
Door Activated Position
On
Off
• You remove the key from the ignition
switch.
In the door activated position, the interior lights fade
out and go off about 30 seconds after the doors are
closed.
The lights go off after 30 seconds in the following
situations:
• When you unlock the driver’s door but do not open it.
Models without smart entry system
• When you remove the key from the ignition switch
but do not open a door.
Models with smart entry system
• When you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) but do not open a door.
• When the power mode is set to VEHICLE
OFF (LOCK).
The interior lights go off immediately in the following
situations:
• When you lock the driver’s door.
• When you turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
■ OFF
• When you close the driver’s door with the key in
Models with smart entry system
Models without smart entry system
The interior lights remain off regardless of
whether the doors are open or closed.
the ignition switch.
Models with smart entry system
• When you close the driver’s door in ACCESSORY
mode.
If you leave any of the doors open in VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) mode, or without the key in the ignition
switch, the interior lights go off after about 15
minutes.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE
START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
150
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 151 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Lights
■ Map Lights
Models with moonroof
1Map Lights
The map lights can be turned on and off by
pressing the lenses.
Models with moonroof
When the interior light switch is in the door activated
position and any door is open, the map light will not
go off when you press the lens.
Controls
Models without moonroof
■ Cargo Area Light
On
Off
■ ON
The light comes on when you open the
tailgate, and goes off when closed.
■ OFF
The light stays off with or without opening the
tailgate.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
151
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 152 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Interior Convenience Items
■ Glove Box
1Glove Box
Pull the handle to open the glove box.
3 WARNING
An open glove box can cause serious injury
to your passenger in a crash, even if the
passenger is wearing the seat belt.
Always keep the glove box closed while
driving.
Controls
■ Console Compartment
Pull the handle to open the console
compartment.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
152
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 153 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Beverage Holders
1Beverage Holders
NOTICE
■ Front seat beverage holders
Front Door
Spilled liquids can damage the upholstery, carpeting,
and electrical components in the interior.
Be careful when you are using the beverage holders.
Hot liquid can scald you.
Controls
■ Center console beverage holders
To put a short-size beverage: Push down
the bottom plate.
Center Console
Bottom plate
To put a tall-size beverage: Pull up the
bottom plate.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
153
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 154 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Rear Door
■ Rear seat beverage holders
Controls
At the Back of the Center Console
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
154
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 155 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Cargo Floor Box
Pull up the cargo area floor lid.
2WD models
Controls
Cargo Floor Box
AWD models
Cargo Floor Box
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
155
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 156 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Accessory Power Sockets
1Accessory Power Sockets
The accessory power socket can be used when the ignition switch is in ACCESSORY
(q or ON (w *1.
■ Accessory power socket (console panel)
Open the cover to use it.
NOTICE
Do not insert an automotive type cigarette lighter
element.
This can overheat the power socket.
Each accessory power socket is designed to supply
power for 12 volt DC accessories that are rated 180
watts (15 amps) or less.
Controls
To prevent battery drain, only use the power socket
with the engine running.
Cover
■ Accessory power socket (rearward of
center console)
Open the cover to use it.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
156
When both sockets are being used, the combined
power rating of the accessories should not exceed
180 watts (15 amps).
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 157 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Accessory power socket (cargo area) *
Open the cover to use it.
1Coat Hook
There is a coat hook on the rear left grab
handle. Pull it down to use it.
* Not available on all models
The coat hook is not designed for large or heavy
items.
Controls
■ Coat Hook
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
157
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 158 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Tie-down Anchors
The tie-down anchors on the cargo area floor
can be used to install a net for securing items.
Front Anchors
Controls
Rear Anchors
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
158
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 159 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Tonneau Cover *
1Tonneau Cover *
The tonneau cover can be used to conceal
your items and protect them from direct
sunlight.
■ To remove:
Pull out the tonneau cover rearwards and
remove it.
* Not available on all models
Do not stack objects higher than the top of the seat
in the cargo area. They could block your view and be
thrown about the vehicle during a sudden stop.
To prevent tonneau cover damage, do not:
• Place items on the tonneau cover.
• Put weight on the tonneau cover.
When reinstalling the tonneau cover, put the tagged
side first.
Controls
■ To fold:
The tonneau cover is collapsible.
1. Take the opposite sides, fold the cover
halfway, then twist into opposite ways.
2. Curl to narrow the cover as shown.
Do not let anyone access items in the cargo area
while driving. Loose items can cause injury if you have
to brake hard.
Tag
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
159
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 160 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Seat Heaters *
1Seat Heaters *
The ignition switch must be in ON (w *1 to use
the seat heaters. The HI setting heats the seats
faster than the LO setting.
Heat induced burns are possible when
using seat heaters.
Controls
Persons with a diminished ability to sense
temperature (e.g., persons with diabetes,
lower-limb nerve damage, or paralysis) or
with sensitive skin should not use seat
heaters.
Touch the seat heater icon.
Once - The HI setting (two indicators on)
Twice - The LO setting
Three times - The OFF setting (no indicator on)
When a comfortable temperature is reached
while using the seat heater in HI, select LO to
keep the seat warm.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
160
3 WARNING
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Do not use the seat heaters even in LO when the
engine is off. Under such conditions, the battery may
be weakened, making the engine difficult to start.
In the LO setting, the heater runs continuously and
does not automatically turn off.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 161 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Heating and Cooling System *
Using Vents, Heating and A/C
Dashboard
vents
Dashboard
and floor
vents
Floor vents
Floor and
defroster
vents
Defroster
vents
Mode Control Dial
Adjusts the fan speed. Rotate the dial all
the way to OFF to turn everything off.
Changes airflow.
Controls
Fan Control Dial
Temperature Control Dial
Adjusts the interior temperature.
(Recirculation) Button
A/C Button
Press the
button and switch the mode depending on
environmental conditions.
Press to cool the interior or dehumidify
while heating.
Recirculation mode (indicator on):
Recirculates air from the vehicle’s interior through the system.
Fresh air mode (indicator off):
Maintains outside ventilation. Keep the system in fresh air mode in
normal situations.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
161
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 162 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuHeating and Cooling System * uUsing Vents, Heating and A/C
■ Passenger Side Vents
Three separate front passenger side air vents allow for different air flow rates
through the vehicle. Passengers can separately:
• Adjust each vent to optimize airflow
Adjust from side to side or up and
throughout the vehicle.
down
Controls
Mid
Low
High
• Close individual vents to adjust passenger
comfort levels.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
162
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 163 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuHeating and Cooling System * uUsing Vents, Heating and A/C
■ Heating
1Heating
The heater uses heat from the engine coolant
to warm the air.
1. Adjust the fan speed using the fan control
dial.
2. Select
.
3. Adjust the temperature using the
temperature control dial.
1To rapidly warm up the interior
Controls
■ To rapidly warm up the interior
1. Set the fan to the maximum speed.
2. Select
.
3. Set the temperature to maximum warm.
4. Press the
button (the indicator on).
When you select
, the mode automatically
switches to fresh air.
Change to fresh air mode as soon as the interior gets
warm enough. The windows may fog up if kept in
recirculation mode.
■ To dehumidify the interior
When used in combination with the heater, the air conditioning system makes the
interior warm and dry and can prevent the windows from fogging up.
1. Turn the fan on.
2. Press the A/C button to turn on the air conditioning.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
163
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 164 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuHeating and Cooling System * uUsing Vents, Heating and A/C
■ Cooling
1To rapidly cool down the interior
1. Adjust the fan speed using the fan control
dial.
2. Select
.
3. Adjust the temperature using the
temperature control dial.
4. Press the A/C button (indicator on).
Models with ECON button
While in ECON mode, the system has greater
temperature fluctuations.
Controls
■ To rapidly cool down the interior
1. Set the fan to the maximum speed.
2. Set the temperature to maximum cool.
3. Press the
button (the indicator on).
1Defrosting the Windshield and Windows
■ Defrosting the Windshield and Windows
Selecting
turns the air conditioning
system on and automatically switches the
system to fresh air mode.
■ To rapidly defrost the windows
1. Set the fan to the maximum speed.
2. Select
.
3. Press the
button.
4. Set the temperature to maximum warm.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
164
If the interior is very warm, you can cool it down
more rapidly by partially opening the windows.
For your safety, make sure you have a clear view
through all the windows before driving.
Do not set the temperature near the upper or lower
limit.
When cold air hits the windshield, the outside of the
windshield may fog up.
If the side windows fog up, adjust the vents so that
the air hits the side windows.
1To rapidly defrost the windows
After defrosting the windows, switch over to fresh air
mode.
If you keep the system in recirculation mode, the
windows may fog up from humidity. This impedes
visibility.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 165 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Climate Control System *
Using Automatic Climate Control
The automatic climate control system maintains the interior temperature you select.
The system also selects the proper mix of heated or cooled air that raises or lowers
the interior temperature to your preference as quickly as possible.
Models without SYNC icon
Temperature Control
Icons
Dashboard
and floor
vents
If any icons are selected while using the climate
control system in auto, the function of the icon that
was selected will take priority.
The AUTO indicator will go off, but functions
unrelated to the icon that was selected will be
controlled automatically.
To prevent cold air from blowing in from outside, the
fan may not start immediately when the AUTO icon
is selected.
Floor vents Floor and
defroster
vents
Mode Control Icon
Fan Control Icons
If the interior is very warm, you can cool it down
more rapidly by partially opening the windows,
turning the system on auto, and setting the
temperature to low. Change the fresh air mode to
recirculation mode until the temperature cools down.
Controls
Dashboard
vents
1Using Automatic Climate Control
When you set the temperature to the lower or upper
limit, Lo or Hi is displayed.
You can raise or lower the temperature or fan speed
setting flicking either control icon.
AUTO Icon
(On/Off) Icon
A/C (Air Conditioning) Icon
(Fresh Air) Icon
(Recirculation) Icon
Use the system when the engine is running.
1. Select the AUTO icon.
2. Adjust the interior temperature using the temperature control icons.
3. Select the
icon to cancel.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
165
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 166 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuClimate Control System * uUsing Automatic Climate Control
Models with SYNC icon
1Using Automatic Climate Control
Selecting the
icon switches the climate control
system between on and off. When turned on, the
system returns to your last selection.
Dashboard
vents
Controls
Driver Side
Temperature Control
Icons
Dashboard
and floor
vents
The climate control system is voice operable. See the
navigation system manual.
Floor vents Floor and
defroster
vents
Models with ECON button
While in ECON mode, the system has greater
temperature fluctuations.
Mode Control Icon
Passenger Side
Temperature
Control Icons
AUTO Icon
(On/Off) Icon
SYNC Icon
(Recirculation) Icon
A/C (Air Conditioning) Icon
Use the system when the engine is running.
1. Select the AUTO icon.
2. Adjust the interior temperature using the driver side temperature control icons.
3. Select the
icon to cancel.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
166
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 167 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuClimate Control System * uUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ Switching between the recirculation and fresh air modes
Models without SYNC icon
Select the
(recirculation) or
(fresh air) icon to switch the mode
depending on environmental conditions.
Recirculation mode (indicator on): Recirculates air from the vehicle’s interior
through the system.
Fresh air mode (indicator on): Maintains outside ventilation. Keep the system
in fresh air mode in normal situations.
Models with SYNC icon
Controls
Select the
(recirculation) icon to switch the mode depending on
environmental conditions.
Recirculation mode (indicator on): Recirculates air from the vehicle’s interior through
the system.
Fresh air mode (indicator off): Maintains outside ventilation. Keep the system in
fresh air mode in normal situations.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
167
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 168 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuClimate Control System * uUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ Defrosting the Windshield and Windows
Models without SYNC icon
1Defrosting the Windshield and Windows
Select the
icon to turn the air conditioning
system on and automatically switch the
system to fresh air mode.
Select the
icon again to turn off, the
system returns to the previous settings.
Do not set the temperature near the upper or lower
limit.
When cold air hits the windshield, the outside of the
windshield may fog up.
Controls
If the side windows fog up, adjust the vents so that
the air hits the side windows.
Models with SYNC icon
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
168
For your safety, make sure you have a clear view
through all the windows before driving.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 169 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuClimate Control System * uUsing Automatic Climate Control
Models without SYNC icon
■ To rapidly defrost the windows
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select the
icon.
1To rapidly defrost the windows
After defrosting the windows, switch over to fresh air
mode. If you keep the system in recirculation mode,
the windows may fog up from humidity. This
impedes visibility.
Controls
Models with SYNC icon
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
169
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 170 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuClimate Control System * uUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ Turning On and Off the Touch Screen Beep
1Turning On and Off the Touch Screen Beep
Controls
You hear the beep when operating the climate control system on the touch screen.
This can be turned on and off.
To turn off the beep:
Models without SYNC icon
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Touch the
of the temperature control
icon five times while pressing and holding
the
.
3. Release the
, after -- blinks five times
and OF is displayed.
Models with SYNC icon
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
170
If you touch any other icons during this procedure,
the setting may fail. In this case, once you turn the
ignition switch to OFF (0 *1, then follow this
procedure again.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 171 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuClimate Control System * uUsing Automatic Climate Control
Models without SYNC icon
To turn on the beep:
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Touch the
of the temperature control
icon five times while pressing and holding
the
.
3. Release the
, after OF blinks five times
and -- is displayed.
Controls
Models with SYNC icon
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
171
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 172 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuClimate Control System * uSynchronized Mode *
Synchronized Mode *
1Synchronized Mode *
When the system is in dual mode, the driver side
temperature and the passenger side temperature can
be set separately.
Controls
Driver Side
Temperature
Control Icon
Passenger Side
Temperature
Control Icon
SYNC Icon
You can set the temperature synchronously for the driver side and the passenger
side in synchronized mode.
1. Select the SYNC icon.
u The system switches to synchronized mode.
2. Adjust the temperature using the driver’s side temperature control icon.
Select the SYNC icon to return to dual mode.
172
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 173 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuClimate Control System * uAutomatic Climate Control Sensors
Automatic Climate Control Sensors
Sensor
The automatic climate control system is
equipped with sensors. Do not cover or spill
any liquid on them.
Controls
Sensor
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
173
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 174 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
174
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 175 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Features
This chapter describes how to operate technology features.
Audio System
About Your Audio System.................... 176
USB Port(s) ........................................... 177
HDMI® Port * ........................................ 178
Auxiliary Input Jack *............................. 178
Audio System Theft Protection ............. 179
Audio Remote Controls........................ 180
Models with color audio system
Audio System Basic Operation............. 182
Audio/Information Screen .................... 183
Adjusting the Sound ............................ 187
Display Setup ....................................... 188
Playing the AM/FM Radio ..................... 189
Playing a CD ........................................ 191
Playing an iPod..................................... 194
* Not available on all models
Playing a USB Flash Drive ..................... 197
Playing Bluetooth® Audio..................... 200
Models with display audio system
Audio System Basic Operation ............ 203
Audio/Information Screen .................... 204
Adjusting the Sound ............................ 209
Display Setup ....................................... 210
Playing the AM/FM Radio..................... 211
Playing a CD ........................................ 214
Playing an iPod .................................... 217
Playing Internet Radio .......................... 220
Playing a USB Flash Drive ..................... 222
Playing Bluetooth® Audio..................... 225
Playing a Video Using the HDMI® ......... 227
Smartphone Apps ................................ 229
Siri Eyes Free.........................................230
Audio Error Messages ...........................231
General Information on the Audio
System ............................................. 235
Customized Features.............................238
Models with color audio system
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®..................260
Models with display audio system
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®..................283
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
175
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 176 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Audio System
About Your Audio System
Models with navigation system
1About Your Audio System
See the navigation system manual for operation of the audio system.
Video CDs, DVDs, and 3-inch (8-cm) mini CDs are not
supported.
Models without navigation system
The audio system features AM/FM radio. It can also play audio CDs, WMA/MP3/AAC
files, USB flash drives, and iPod, iPhone and Bluetooth® devices.
You can operate the audio system from the buttons and switches on the panel, the
remote controls on the steering wheel, or the icons on the touchscreen interface *.
Features
USB Flash Drive
iPod
HDMI®
*1
Remote Controls
USB Port*1, *2
HDMI® Port*1
Auxiliary Input Jack*2
USB Port*1
*1:Models with display audio system
*2:Models with color audio system
176
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
iPod, iPhone and iTunes are trademarks of Apple Inc.
State or local laws may prohibit the operation of
handheld electronic devices while operating a
vehicle.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 177 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio SystemuUSB Port(s)
USB Port(s)
1. Open the cover.
2. Install the iPod dock connector or the USB
flash drive to the USB port.
1USB Port(s)
• Do not leave the iPod or USB flash drive in the
•
•
USB Port
•
•
vehicle. Direct sunlight and high temperatures may
damage it.
Do not connect the iPod or USB flash drive using a
hub.
Do not use a device such as a card reader or hard
disk drive, as the device or your files may be
damaged.
We recommend your data backed up before using
the device in your vehicle.
Displayed messages may vary depending on the
device model and software version.
Features
If the audio system does not recognize the iPod, try
reconnecting it a few times or reboot the device. To
reboot, follow the manufacturer’s instructions
provided with the iPod or visit www.apple.com/ipod.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
177
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 178 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio SystemuHDMI® Port *
HDMI® Port *
1. Open the cover.
2. Install the HDMI® cable to the HDMI® port.
1HDMI® Port *
• Do not leave the HDMI® connected device in the
vehicle. Direct sunlight and high temperatures may
damage it.
• We recommend your data backed up before using
the device in your vehicle.
• Displayed messages may vary depending on the
device model and software version.
HDMI Port
Features
The terms HDMI and HDMI High-Definition
Multimedia Interface, and the HDMI Logo are
trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI
Licensing LLC in the United States and other
countries.
Auxiliary Input Jack *
1Auxiliary Input Jack *
Use the jack to connect standard audio devices.
1. Open the AUX cover.
2. Connect a standard audio device to the
input jack using a 1/8 inch (3.5 mm) stereo
miniplug.
u The audio system automatically switches
to the AUX mode.
178
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
To switch mode, press any of the audio mode
buttons. You can return to AUX mode by pressing
the CD/AUX button.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 179 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio SystemuAudio System Theft Protection
Audio System Theft Protection
The audio system is disabled when it is disconnected from the power source, such as
when the battery is disconnected or goes dead. In certain conditions, the system
may display ENTER CODE*2/Enter code*3. If this occurs, reactivate the audio
system.
■ Reactivating the audio system
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Turn on the audio system.
3. Press and hold the audio system power button for more than two seconds.
u The audio system is reactivated when the audio control unit establishes a
connection with the vehicle control unit. If the control unit fails to recognize
the audio unit, you must go to a dealer and have the audio unit checked.
Features
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
*2: Models with color audio system.
*3: Models with display audio system.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
179
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 180 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio SystemuAudio Remote Controls
Audio Remote Controls
Allow you to operate the audio system while driving.
SOURCE Button
Button
Cycles through the audio modes as follows:
Button
FM AM CD USB iPod Bluetooth®
Button
Audio Pandora® *AhaTM*Apps *, *1
AUX */AUX HDMI® *
Button
SOURCE
Button
(Menu)
Button *
Press
Press
(Volume) Buttons
: To increase the volume.
: To decrease the volume.
Features
Button
• When listening to the radio
Press : To select the next preset radio station.
Press : To select the previous preset radio station.
Press and hold : To select the next strong radio station.
Press and hold : To select the previous strong radio station.
• When listening to a CD, iPod, USB flash drive, or Bluetooth® Audio
Press : To skip to the next song.
Press : To go back to the beginning of the current or previous song.
• When listening to a CD or USB flash drive
Press and hold : To skip to the next folder.
Press and hold : To go back to the previous folder.
• When listening to Internet radio *
Press : To skip to the next song.
Press and hold : To select the next station.
Press and hold : To select the previous station.
*1: Appears only when connected to HondaLinkTM.
180
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
1Audio Remote Controls
Some mode appear only when an appropriate device
or medium is used.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 181 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio SystemuAudio Remote Controls
Models with display audio system
1Audio Remote Controls
* Not available on all models
The
button is available only when the audio
mode is FM, AM, CD, USB, iPod, Pandora® *, AhaTM*,
or Bluetooth® Audio.
Features
Steering Wheel
(Menu) Button
• When listening to the radio
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Scan, Save Preset, or
Seek.
• When listening to a CD or USB flash drive
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Scan, Repeat, or Random.
• When listening to an iPod
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Repeat or Shuffle.
• When listening to a Bluetooth® Audio
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Pause or Play.
• When listening to a Pandora® *
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Bookmark, or Play/Pause.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
181
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 182 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Audio System Basic Operation
Models with color audio system
1Audio System Basic Operation
To use the audio system, the ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY (q or ON (w .
Use the selector knob or MENU/CLOCK
(Sound)
Button
button to access some audio functions.
Button
These indications are used to show how to operate
the selector knob.
Rotate
Press
Press
to switch between the normal and
extended display for some functions.
(Back)
Button
MENU/
CLOCK
Button
Features
Selector Knob
Selector knob: Rotate left or right to scroll
through the available choices. Press
to set
your selection.
MENU/CLOCK button: Press to select any
mode.
The available mode includes the wallpaper,
display, clock, language setup, and play
modes. Play modes can be also selected from
scan, random, repeat, and so on.
(Back) button: Press to go back to the previous display.
button: Press to select the sound setting mode.
button: Press to change the audio/information screen brightness.
Press
, then adjust the brightness using
.
u Each time you press
, the mode switches between the daytime mode,
nighttime mode and OFF mode.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
182
to select.
to enter.
Menu Items
2 Adjust Clock P. 95
2 Wallpaper Setup P. 185
2 Display Setup P. 188
2 Scan P. 190, 193, 199
2 Play Mode P. 193, 196, 199
2 RDS Settings P. 190
2 Bluetooth P. 242, 266
Press the SOURCE,
,
,
or
button on the
steering wheel to change any audio setting.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 180
One of the operating system used in this unit is eCos.
For software license terms and conditions, visit their
website (eCos license URL: http://
ecos.sourceware.org/license-overview.html)
For source code disclosure and other details
regarding eCos, visit: http://
www.hondaopensource2.com
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 183 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Audio/Information Screen
Displays the audio status and wallpaper. From this screen, you can go to various
setup options.
■ Switching the Display
Audio/Information Screen
Audio
Features
Clock/Wallpaper
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
183
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 184 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Audio
Shows the current audio information.
■ Clock/Wallpaper
Shows a clock screen or an image you import.
■ Change display
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Display Change, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press .
u If you want to return to the audio display, select Audio.
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
184
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 185 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Wallpaper Setup
1Wallpaper Setup
You can change, store, and delete the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.
■ Import wallpaper
You can import up to three images, one at a time, for wallpaper from a USB flash
drive.
1. Connect the USB flash drive to the USB
port.
• When importing wallpaper files, the image must be
•
•
•
•
2 USB Port(s) P. 177
•
•
Features
2. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
3. Rotate
to select Settings, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press
.
5. Rotate
to select Import, then press .
u The picture name is displayed on the list.
6. Rotate
to select a desired picture, then
press .
u The selected picture is displayed.
7. Press
to save the picture.
8. Press
to select OK.
9. Rotate
to select a location to save the
picture, then press .
u The display will return to the wallpaper
setting screen.
in the USB flash drive’s root directory. Images in a
folder cannot be imported.
The file name must be fewer than 64 characters.
The file format of the image that can be imported
is BMP (bmp) or JPEG (jpg).
The individual file size limit is 2 MB.
The maximum image size is 1,920 x 936 pixels. If
the image size is less than 480 × 234 pixels, the
image is displayed in the middle of the screen with
the extra area appearing in black.
Up to 255 files can be selected.
If the USB flash drive does not have any pictures,
the No files detected message appears.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
185
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 186 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Select wallpaper
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Select, then press .
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
5. Rotate
to select a desired wallpaper, then press
1Wallpaper Setup
To go back to the previous screen, press the
(Back) button.
When the file size is large, it takes a while to be
previewed.
.
■ Delete wallpaper
Features
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Delete, then press .
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
5. Rotate
to select a wallpaper that you want to delete, then press
6. Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
u The display will return to the wallpaper setting screen.
.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
186
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 187 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAdjusting the Sound
Adjusting the Sound
Button
Press the
(sound) button, and rotate
to scroll through the following choices:
1Adjusting the Sound
The SVC has four modes: Off, Low, Mid, and High.
SVC adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle
speed. As you go faster, audio volume increases. As
you slow down, audio volume decreases.
LIST/SELECT (Selector) Knob
TRE is selectable.
Bass
TRE
Treble
FAD
Fader
BAL
Balance
SVC
Speed-sensitive
Volume
Compensation
Features
BAS
Rotate
to adjust the sound setting, then
press .
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
187
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 188 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuDisplay Setup
Display Setup
You can change the brightness or color theme of the audio/information screen.
■ Changing the Screen Brightness
1Changing the Screen Brightness
Features
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select Display Adjustment,
then press .
4. Rotate
to select Brightness, then press
.
5. Rotate
to adjust the setting, then press
.
■ Changing the Screen’s Color Theme
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select Color Theme, then
press .
4. Rotate
to select the setting you want,
then press .
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
188
You can change the Contrast and Black level
settings in the same manner.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 189 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying the AM/FM Radio
Playing the AM/FM Radio
RADIO Button
Press to select a band.
Audio/Information Screen
Selector Knob
Turn to tune the radio frequency.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to search up and down
the selected band for a station with a strong
signal.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
Preset Buttons (1-6)
To store a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Pick a preset button and hold it until you hear a beep.
To listen to a stored station, select a band, then press the preset button.
Features
VOL/
(Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous
display or cancel a setting.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
189
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 190 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying the AM/FM Radio
■ Radio Data System (RDS)
1Playing the AM/FM Radio
Provides text data information related to your selected RDS capable FM station.
■ To find an RDS station from Station List
1. Press
while listening to an FM station.
2. Rotate
to select the station, then press
You can store 6 AM stations and 12 FM stations into
the preset memory.
.
Switching the Audio Mode
Press the SOURCE button on the steering wheel.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 180
■ Update List
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Press
while listening to an FM station.
2. Rotate
to select Update List, then press
.
Features
■ Radio text
1Radio Data System (RDS)
Displays the radio text information of the selected RDS station.
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select RDS Settings, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Radio Text, then press .
■ Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Scan, then press .
To turn off scan, press
.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
190
The ST indicator appears on the display indicating
stereo FM broadcasts.
Stereo reproduction in AM is not available.
When you select an RDS-capable FM station, the RDS
automatically turns on, and the frequency display
changes to the station name. However, when the
signals of that station become weak, the display
changes from the station name to the frequency.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 191 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
Playing a CD
Your audio system supports audio CDs, CD-Rs, and CD-RWs in either MP3 or WMA,
or AAC*1 format. With the CD loaded, press the CD/AUX button.
Audio/Information Screen
CD Slot
Insert a CD about halfway into the CD slot.
(CD Eject) Button
Press to eject a CD.
Features
CD/AUX Button
Press to play a CD.
VOL/
(Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Selector Knob
Turn to change tracks/files. Press
to display a track/folder list.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to change tracks
(files in MP3, WMA, or AAC).
Press and hold to move rapidly within a
track/file.
Play Mode Buttons (1-6)
Press to select a play mode.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous
display or cancel a setting.
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
191
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 192 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
■ How to Select a File from a Folder with the Selector Knob
(MP3/WMA/AAC)
1Playing a CD
NOTICE
1. Press
to switch the display to a folder list.
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can
cause the CD to jam in the unit.
WMA files protected by digital rights management
(DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays UNPLAYABLE FILE, then
skips to the next file.
Features
Folder
Selection
2. Rotate
to select a folder.
If you eject the CD but do not remove it from the slot,
the system reloads the CD automatically after several
seconds.
Track
Selection
3. Press
to display a list of tracks in that
folder.
4. Rotate
to select a track, then press .
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
192
Text data appears on the display under the following
circumstances:
• When you select a new folder, file, or track.
• When you change the audio mode to CD.
• When you insert a CD.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 193 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
■ How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat, random, and scan modes when playing a track or file.
Available mode icons appear above the play
mode buttons.
Press the button corresponding to the mode
you want to select.
Play Mode Menu Items
Repeat
Repeat One Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC):
Repeats all files in the current folder.
Repeat One Track: Repeats the current
track/file.
Random
Random in Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Plays
all files in the current folder in random order.
Random All: Plays all tracks/files in random
order.
Play Mode Buttons
Scan Folders (MP3/WMA/AAC): Provides
10-second sampling of the first file in each of the
main folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of
all tracks on the CD (all files in the current folder in
MP3, WMA, or AAC).
Press the selected button.
Features
Scan
■ To turn off a play mode
You can also select a play mode by pressing the
MENU/CLOCK button.
Rotate
to select Play Mode, then press
.
Rotate
to select a mode, then press
.
To turn it off, rotate
to select Normal Play, then
press
.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
193
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 194 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Playing an iPod
Connect the iPod using your dock connector to the USB port, then press the CD/
AUX button.
2 USB Port(s) P. 177
Audio/Information Screen
USB Indicator
Appears when an iPod is connected.
Features
CD/AUX Button
Press to select iPod (if connected).
VOL/
(Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Selector Knob
Turn to change songs.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to change songs.
Press and hold to move rapidly within a song.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
Album Art
Play Mode Buttons
Press to select a play mode.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
194
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous
display or cancel a setting.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 195 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Song from the iPod Music List with the
Selector Knob
1. Press
to display the iPod music list.
1Playing an iPod
Available operating functions vary on models or
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle’s audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio display.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 232
Item
Selection
2. Rotate
to select a category.
Features
Category
Selection
3. Press
to display a list of items in the
category.
4. Rotate
to select an item, then press .
u Press
and rotate
repeatedly until a
desired item you want to listen is
displayed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
195
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 196 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat and shuffle modes when playing a song.
Available mode icons appear above the play
mode buttons.
Press the button corresponding to the mode
you want to select.
You can also select a play mode by pressing the
MENU/CLOCK button.
Rotate
to select Play Mode, then press
.
Rotate
to select a mode, then press
.
To turn it off, rotate
to select Normal Play, then
press
.
Play Mode Buttons
Features
■ To turn off a play mode
Press the selected button.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
196
Play Mode Menu Items
Shuffle Album: Plays all available albums in
a selected category (playlists, artists, albums, songs,
genres, or composers) in random order.
Shuffle All: Plays all available songs in a
selected category (playlists, artists, albums, songs,
genres, or composers) in random order.
Repeat One Track: Repeats the current
song.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 197 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Playing a USB Flash Drive
Your audio system reads and plays sound files on a USB flash drive in either MP3,
WMA or AAC*1 format.
Connect your USB flash drive to the USB port, then press the CD/AUX button.
2 USB Port(s) P. 177
Audio/Information Screen
USB Indicator
Appears when a USB flash drive is connected.
Features
CD/AUX Button
Press to select USB flash drive
(if connected).
VOL/
(Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Selector Knob
Turn to change files.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to change files.
Press and hold to move rapidly within a file.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
Play Mode Buttons (1-6)
Press to select a play mode.
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous display.
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
197
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 198 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a File from a Folder with the Selector Knob
1. Press
to display a folder list.
1Playing a USB Flash Drive
Use the recommended USB flash drives.
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 235
Files in WMA format protected by digital rights
management (DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays UNPLAYABLE FILE, and
then skips to the next file.
Folder
Selection
2. Rotate
to select a folder.
Features
Track
Selection
3. Press
to display a list of files in that
folder.
4. Rotate
to select a file, then press .
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
198
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 232
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 199 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat, random, and scan modes when playing a file.
Available mode icons appear above the play
mode buttons.
Press the button corresponding to the mode
you want to select.
Play Mode Menu Items
Repeat
Repeat One Folder: Repeats all files in the
current folder.
Repeat One Track: Repeats the current file.
Random
Random in Folder: Plays all files in the
current folder in random order.
Random All: Plays all files in random order.
Scan
Play Mode Buttons
■ To turn off a play mode
Press the selected button.
Features
Scan Folders: Provides 10-second sampling
of the first file in each of the main folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of
all files in the current folder.
You can also select a play mode by pressing the
MENU/CLOCK button.
Rotate
to select Play Mode, then press
.
Rotate
to select a mode, then press
.
To turn it off, rotate
to select Normal Play, then
press
.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
199
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 200 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Your audio system allows you to listen to music from your Bluetooth-compatible
phone.
This function is available when the phone is paired and connected to the vehicle’s
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) system.
2 Phone Setup P. 266
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your phone is connected to HFL.
CD/AUX Button
Press to select
Bluetooth® Audio.
Audio/Information Screen
Not all Bluetooth-enabled phones with streaming
audio capabilities are compatible with the system.
For a list of compatible phones:
• U.S.: Visit www.handsfreelink.honda.com, or call
1-888-528-7876.
• Canada: Visit www.handsfreelink.ca, or call 1-888528-7876.
In some states, it may be illegal to perform some data
device functions while driving.
Features
Only one phone can be used with HFL at a time.
When there are more than two paired phones in the
vehicle, the first paired phone the system finds is
automatically connected.
If more than one phone is paired to the HFL system,
there will be a delay before the system begins to play.
VOL/
(Volume/
Power) Knob
Press to turn
the audio
system on and
off.
Turn to adjust
the volume.
Pause Button (Preset 2)
Press to pause playing a
file.
MENU/CLOCK
Button
Press to display
the menu
items.
Play Button (Preset 1)
Press to resume playing a file.
/
Press
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
or
to change files.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
200
1Playing Bluetooth® Audio
In some cases, the name of the artist, album, or track
may not appear correctly.
Some functions may not be available on some
devices.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 201 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
■ To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
CD/AUX Button
Pause Button
Play Button
1To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
1. Make sure that your phone is paired and
connected to HFL.
2. Press the CD/AUX button until the
Bluetooth Audio Source is selected.
If the phone is not recognized, another HFLcompatible phone, which is not compatible
for Bluetooth® Audio, may already be
connected.
To play the audio files, you may need to operate your
phone. If so, follow the phone maker's operating
instructions.
The pause function may not be available on some
phones.
If any audio device is connected to the auxiliary input
jack or USB port, you may need to press the CD/AUX
button repeatedly to select the Bluetooth® Audio
system.
■ To pause or resume a file
Press a Play or Pause button to select a mode.
Features
Switching to another mode pauses the music playing
from your phone.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
201
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 202 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
■ How to Select a Song from the Music Search List with the
Selector Knob
1. Press
Features
Category
Selection
Item
Selection
2. Rotate
to display the music search list.
to select a category.
3. Press
to display a list of items in the
category.
4. Rotate
to select an item, then press .
u Press
and rotate
repeatedly until a
desired item you want to listen is
displayed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
202
1How to Select a Song from the Music Search List with the Selector
Knob
Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect,
some or all of the categories may not be displayed.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 203 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Audio System Basic Operation
Models with display audio system
1Audio System Basic Operation
To use the audio system function, the ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY (q or
ON (w *1.
: Select to go to the HOME screen.
(HOME)
Button
2 Switching the Display P. 204
Icon
HOME
VOL
MENU
BACK
(MENU) Icon
button: Press to change the audio/
information screen brightness.
Press
once and select
or
to make
an adjustment.
u Each time you press
, the mode
switches between the daytime mode,
nighttime mode and OFF mode.
Features
(BACK) Icon
: Touch to select any mode.
The available mode includes Change Source,
Station List, Save Preset, Radio Text,
Music Search, and play modes. Play modes
can be also selected from Scan, Random/
Repeat, and so on.
: Select to go back to the previous display
when it is displayed.
Audio Menu Items
2 Station List P. 212
2 Music Search P. 215, 218, 223
2 Random/Repeat P. 216, 224
2 Scan P. 213, 216, 224
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
203
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 204 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Audio/Information Screen
Displays the audio status and wallpaper. From this screen, you can go to various
setup options.
■ Switching the Display
Using the
Press the
button
(display) button on the steering wheel to change the display.
(Display) Button
Audio/Information Screen
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
204
1Audio/Information Screen
• Use simple gestures — including touching,
swiping, and scrolling — to operate certain audio
functions.
• Wearing gloves may limit or prevent touchscreen
response.
• You can use the microfiber soft cleaning cloth to
remove dust or fingerprints from the touchscreen.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 205 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Using the HOME screen
HOME screen
Features
Select HOME to go to the HOME screen.
Select Phone, Info, Audio, Settings, or HondaLink.
■ Phone
Shows the HFL information.
2 Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® P. 283
■ Info
Shows the Trip Computer, Clock/Wallpaper, Voice Info, or System/Device
Information.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
205
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 206 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Audio
Shows the current audio information.
■ Settings
Enters the customizing menu screen.
2 Customized Features P. 238
■ HondaLink Apps
Connects with your smartphone*1 to play personalized music, information, and
social media streams.
2 Smartphone Apps P. 229
Features
*1: Available on specific phones only. Check handsfreelink.honda.com for compatible phones
and hondalink.com for feature details.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
206
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 207 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Wallpaper Setup
1Wallpaper Setup
You can change, store, and delete the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.
■ Import wallpaper
You can import up to five images, one at a time, for wallpaper from a USB flash
drive.
1. Connect the USB flash drive to the USB
port.
• When importing wallpaper files, the image must be
•
•
•
•
2 USB Port(s) P. 177
•
•
Features
2. Select Settings to go to the Settings
screen.
3. Select Info.
4. Select Clock/Wallpaper Type, then the
Wallpaper tab.
5. Select Add New.
u The picture name is displayed on the list.
6. Select a desired picture.
u The preview is displayed on the left side
on the screen.
7. Select Start Import to save the data.
u Then the display will return to the
wallpaper list.
in the USB flash drive’s root directory. Images in a
folder cannot be imported.
The file name must be fewer than 256 characters.
The file format of the image that can be imported
is BMP (bmp) or JPEG (jpg).
The individual file size limit is 5 MB.
The maximum image size is 4,096 x 4,096 pixels. If
the image size is less than 800 × 480 pixels, the
image is displayed in the middle of the screen with
the extra area appearing in black.
Up to 5 files can be selected.
If the USB flash drive does not have any pictures,
the No files detected message appears.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
207
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 208 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Select wallpaper
1Wallpaper Setup
1. Select Settings to go to the Settings screen.
2. Select Info.
3. Select Clock/Wallpaper Type, then the Wallpaper tab.
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
4. Select a desired wallpaper.
u The preview is displayed on the left side on the screen.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
5. Select Set.
u The display will return to the wallpaper list.
From the pop-up menu, select Preview to see a
preview at full-size screen.
■ Delete wallpaper
Features
1. Select Settings to go to the Settings screen.
2. Select Info.
3. Select Clock/Wallpaper Type, then the Wallpaper tab.
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
4. Select a wallpaper that you want to delete.
u The preview is displayed on the left side on the screen.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
5. Select Delete.
u The confirmation message will appear.
6. Select Yes to delete completely.
u The display will return to the wallpaper list.
To go back to the previous screen, select OK, or
BACK.
When the file size is large, it takes a while to be
previewed.
To delete all wallpapers you add, select Delete All,
then Yes.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
208
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 209 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAdjusting the Sound
Adjusting the Sound
1. Select HOME.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Audio.
4. Select Sound.
1Adjusting the Sound
The SVC has four modes: Off, Low, Mid, and High.
SVC adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle
speed. As you go faster, audio volume increases. As
you slow down, audio volume decreases.
Select the tabs to adjust the following choices:
BASS, TREBLE, FADER, BALANCE, SVC
(Speed-sensitive Volume Compensation)
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
209
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 210 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuDisplay Setup
Display Setup
You can change the brightness or color theme of the audio/information screen.
■ Changing the Screen Brightness
1Changing the Screen Brightness
1. Select HOME.
2. Select Settings to go to the Settings
screen.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Display tab.
5. Select Display Settings.
6. Select the setting you want.
7. Select OK.
Features
■ Changing the Screen’s Color Theme
1. Select HOME.
2. Select Settings to go to the Settings
screen.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Display tab.
5. Select Background Color.
6. Select the setting you want.
7. Select OK.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
210
You can change the Contrast and Black Level
settings in the same manner.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 211 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying the AM/FM Radio
Playing the AM/FM Radio
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Audio/Information Screen
HOME
(MENU) Icon
Select to display the menu items.
VOL
Seek Icons
Select
or
to search
up and down the selected band
for a station with a strong
signal.
MENU
BACK
(BACK) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Scan
Select to scan each station with a
strong signal.
Tune Icons
Select
or
frequency.
Features
VOL (Volume) Icons
Select to adjust the volume.
Open/Close Icon*1
Displays/hides the detailed
information.
to tune the radio
Preset Icons
Turn the radio frequency for preset memory.
Select and hold the preset icon to store that station.
Select
to display preset 7 onwards.
*1:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
211
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 212 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying the AM/FM Radio
■ Preset Memory
1Playing the AM/FM Radio
The ST indicator appears on the display indicating
stereo FM broadcasts.
Stereo reproduction in AM is not available.
To store a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Select MENU.
3. Select Save Preset.
4. Select the preset number you want to store that station.
Switching the Audio Mode
Press the SOURCE button on the steering wheel or
select SOURCE on the list.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 180
You can also switch the mode by selecting Change
Source on the MENU screen.
Features
You can store 6 AM stations and 12 FM stations into
the preset memory.
■ Radio Data System (RDS)
1Radio Data System (RDS)
Provides text data information related to your selected RDS-capable FM station.
■ To find an RDS station from Station List
1. Select MENU while listening to an FM station.
2. Select Station List.
3. Select the station.
■ Manual update
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Select MENU while listening to an FM station.
2. Select Station List.
3. Select Refresh.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
212
When you select an RDS-capable FM station, the RDS
automatically turns on, and the frequency display
changes to the station name. However, when the
signals of that station become weak, the display
changes from the station name to the frequency.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 213 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying the AM/FM Radio
■ Radio text
Displays the radio text information of the selected RDS station.
1. Select MENU.
2. Select View Radio Text.
■ Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.
1. Select MENU.
2. Select Scan.
To turn off scan, select Cancel.
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
213
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 214 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
Playing a CD
Your audio system supports audio CDs, CD-Rs, and CD-RWs in either MP3 or WMA,
or AAC*1 format. With the CD loaded, select the CD mode.
Audio/Information Screen
CD Slot
Insert a CD about halfway into the CD slot.
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
(CD Eject) Button
Press to eject a CD.
HOME
Features
VOL (Volume) Icons
Select to adjust the volume.
(MENU) Icon
Select to display the menu items.
VOL
Open/Close Icon*2
Displays/hides the detailed
information.
MENU
BACK
(BACK) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Folder Icons
Select
to skip to the next folder,
and
to skip to the beginning of
the previous folder in MP3, WMA, or
AAC.
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
*2:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
214
Track Icons
Select
or
to change tracks
(files in MP3, WMA, or AAC).
Select and hold to move rapidly within
a track.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 215 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
■ How to Select a File from the Music Search List (MP3/WMA/
AAC)
1Playing a CD
NOTICE
1. Select MENU and select Music Search.
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can
cause the CD to jam in the unit.
WMA files protected by digital rights management
(DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, then
skips to the next file.
2. Select a folder.
If you eject the CD but do not remove it from the slot,
the system reloads the CD automatically after several
seconds.
Track
Selection
Features
Folder
Selection
Text data appears on the display under the following
circumstances:
• When you select a new folder, file, or track.
• When you change the audio mode to CD.
• When you insert a CD.
3. Select a track.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
215
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 216 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
■ How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
You can select scan, repeat, and random modes when playing a track or file.
1. Select MENU.
2. Select Scan or Random/Repeat.
3. Select a mode.
Random/Repeat
Repeat Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Repeats all files
in the current folder.
Repeat Track: Repeats the current track/file.
Random in Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Plays all files
in the current folder in random order.
Random All Tracks: Plays all tracks/files in random
order.
Random/Repeat is selected.
Features
■ To turn off a play mode
1. Select MENU.
2. Select the mode you want to turn off.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
216
Play Mode Menu Items
Scan
Scan Folders (MP3/WMA/AAC): Provides 10second sampling of the first file in each of the main
folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of all
tracks on the CD (all files in the current folder in MP3,
WMA, or AAC).
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 217 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Playing an iPod
Connect the iPod using your dock connector to the USB port, then select the iPod
mode.
2 USB Port(s) P. 177
Audio/Information Screen
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
USB Indicator
Appears when an iPod is connected.
Features
HOME
VOL (Volume) Icons
Select to adjust the volume.
(MENU) Icon
Select to display the menu items.
VOL
Open/Close Icon*1
Displays/hides the detailed
information.
MENU
BACK
(BACK) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Songs Icons
Select
or
to change songs.
Select and hold to move rapidly within a song.
Cover Art
*1:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
217
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 218 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Song from the Music Search List
1. Select MENU and select Music Search.
2. Select the items on that menu.
1How to Select a Song from the Music Search List
Available operating functions vary on models or
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle’s audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 232
If you operate the music app on your iPhone/iPod
while the phone is connected to the display audio
system, you may no longer be able to operate the
same app on the display audio. Reconnect the device
if necessary.
Folder
Selection
Features
Track
Selection
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
218
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 219 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat and shuffle modes when playing a file.
1. Select MENU.
2. Select Shuffle/Repeat.
3. Select a mode.
Play Mode Menu Items
Repeat Song: Repeats the current file.
Shuffle Albums: Plays all available albums in a
selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs, genres,
or composers) in random order.
Shuffle All Songs: Plays all available files in a
selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs, genres,
or composers) in random order.
Features
■ To turn off a play mode
1. Select MENU.
2. Select the mode you want to turn off.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
219
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 220 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Internet Radio
U.S. models
Compatible phones only
Playing Internet Radio
1Playing Internet Radio
Pandora®, the Pandora logo, and the Pandora trade
dress are trademarks or registered trademarks of
Pandora Media, Inc., used with permission. Pandora
is currently available exclusively in the United States.
Connect a compatible phone through Bluetooth®.
2 Phone Setup P. 291
iPhone only
You can also connect the phone using your dock connector to the USB port. Select
Source to select Pandora mode.
Cover Art
Audio/Information Screen
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio
system on and off.
Open/Close Icon*1
Displays/hides the detailed
information.
Features
VOL (Volume) Icons
Select to adjust the
volume.
(MENU) Icon
Select to display
the menu items.
(BACK) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Station Up/Down Icons
Select to change a station.
Skip Icon
Select to skip a song.
*1:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
220
Like/Dislike Icons
Select to evaluate a
song.
Play/Pause Icon
Select to resume or play
a song.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
To find out if your phone is compatible with this
feature, visit www.handsfreelink.honda.com, or call
1-888-528-7876
To use this service in your vehicle, the Pandora® app
must first be installed on your phone. Visit
www.pandora.com. for more information.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 221 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Internet Radio
■ Pandora® Menu
1Playing Internet Radio
You can operate some of the Pandora® menu items from your vehicle’s audio
system. The available items are:
• Bookmark
• Station List
• New Station
• Change Source
• Sound
■ Operating a menu item
If you cannot operate Pandora® through the audio
system, it may be streaming through Bluetooth®
Audio. Make sure Pandora® mode on your audio
system is selected.
Changing Stations
To change stations, activate the Pandora® menu,
select Station List, and then select a new station.
Features
1. Select MENU.
2. Select an item.
Pandora® is free, personalized radio that plays music
and comedy you’ll love. Just start with the name of
one of your favorite artists, songs, comedians or
composers and Pandora® will create a custom station
that plays similar tracks. Pandora® also features
hundreds of genre stations ranging from Dubstep to
Smooth Jazz to Power Workout.
1Pandora® Menu
Available operating functions vary on software
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle’s audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 Pandora® P. 233
Pandora® may limit the total number of skips allowed
on the service. If you dislike a track after the skip limit
has been reached, your feedback will be saved but
the current track will continue to play.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
221
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 222 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Playing a USB Flash Drive
Your audio system reads and plays sound files on a USB flash drive in either MP3,
WMA or AAC*1 format.
Connect your USB flash drive to the USB port, then select the USB mode.
2 USB Port(s) P. 177
Audio/Information Screen
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
USB Indicator
Appears when a USB flash drive is connected.
Features
HOME
VOL (Volume) Icons
Select to adjust the volume.
(MENU) Icon
Select to display the menu items.
VOL
Open/Close Icon*2
Displays/hides the detailed
information.
MENU
BACK
(BACK) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Folder Icons
Select
to skip to the next folder,
and
to skip to the beginning of
the previous folder.
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
*2:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
222
Track Icons
Select
or
to change files.
Select and hold to move rapidly within
a track.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 223 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a File from the Music Research List
1Playing a USB Flash Drive
1. Select MENU and select Music Search.
Use the recommended USB flash drives.
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 235
Files in WMA format protected by digital rights
management (DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, and then
skips to the next file.
2. Select a folder.
Track
Selection
3. Select a track.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 232
Features
Folder
Selection
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
223
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 224 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
You can select scan, repeat, and random modes when playing a file.
1. Select MENU.
2. Select Scan or Random/Repeat.
3. Select a mode.
Random/Repeat
Repeat Folder: Repeats all files in the current folder.
Repeat Track: Repeats the current file.
Random in Folder: Plays all files in the current
folder in random order.
Random All Tracks: Plays all files in random order.
Random/Repeat is selected.
Features
■ To turn off a play mode
1. Select MENU.
2. Select the mode you want to turn off.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
224
Play Mode Menu Items
Scan
Scan Folders: Provides 10-second sampling of the
first file in each of the main folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of all files
in the current folder.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 225 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Your audio system allows you to listen to music from your Bluetooth-compatible
phone.
This function is available when the phone is paired and connected to the vehicle’s
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) system.
2 Phone Setup P. 291
Audio/Information Screen
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your phone is
connected to HFL.
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio
system on and off.
Open/Close Icon*1
Displays/hides the detailed
information.
(MENU) Icon
Select to display the
menu items.
Only one phone can be used with HFL at a time.
When there are more than two paired phones in the
vehicle, the first paired phone the system finds is
automatically linked.
In some cases, the name of the artist, album, or track
may not appear correctly.
MENU
BACK
A No Device Connected message may be displayed if:
(BACK) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Pause Icon
In some states, it may be illegal to perform some data
device functions while driving.
If more than one phone is paired to the HFL system,
there may be a delay before the system begins to play.
VOL
Play Icon
Not all Bluetooth-enabled phones with streaming
audio capabilities are compatible with the system.
For a list of compatible phones:
• U.S.: Visit www.handsfreelink.honda.com, or call
1-888-528-7876.
• Canada: Visit www.handsfreelink.ca, or call 1-888528-7876.
Features
HOME
VOL (Volume) Icons
Select to adjust the
volume.
1Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Track Icons
Select
or
change tracks.
Group Icons
Select
or
to
to change group.
*1:Depending on the Bluetooth device you connect, some or all of the lists may not
be displayed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
• The phone is not linked to HFL.
• The phone is not turned on.
• The phone is not in the vehicle.
• An incompatible phone is connected.
The following functions may not be available on
some devices:
• Pause function
• Group selection
225
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 226 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
■ To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
1To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
1. Make sure that your phone is paired and
connected to HFL.
2. Press the Bluetooth® Audio mode.
▲
▲
If the phone is not recognized, another HFLcompatible phone, which is not compatible
for Bluetooth® Audio, may already be
connected.
Switching to another mode pauses the music playing
from your phone.
Features
■ To pause or resume a file
Select the play icon or pause icon.
■ Searching for Music
1Searching for Music
1. Select MENU.
2. Select Music Search.
3. Select a search category (e.g., Albums).
4. Select an item.
u The selection begins playing.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
226
To play the audio files, you may need to operate your
phone. If so, follow the phone maker's operating
instructions.
Depending on the Bluetooth device you connect,
some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 227 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a Video Using the HDMI®
Playing a Video Using the HDMI®
Your audio system allows you to play videos from an HDMI®-compatible device
when parked.
Connect the device, using an HDMI® cable, then select the HDMI® mode.
2 HDMI® Port * P. 178
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Audio/Information Screen
Features
HOME
VOL (Volume) Icons
Select to adjust the volume.
(MENU) Icon
Select to display the menu
items.
VOL
MENU
BACK
(BACK) Icon
Select to go back to the previous display.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
227
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 228 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a Video Using the HDMI®
■ Changing the Screen Aspect
1Playing a Video Using the HDMI®
1. Select HOME.
2. Select Settings to go to the Settings
screen.
3. Select Audio.
4. Select Aspect Ratio Adjustment.
5. Select the setting you want.
6. Select OK.
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
228
This feature is limited while driving. To play videos,
stop your vehicle and apply the parking brake.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 229 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSmartphone Apps
Smartphone Apps
You can connect a compatible smartphone to the system to enable integration
between the smartphone’s approved apps and the vehicle. This allows you to
control the phone through the vehicle display. To check smart phone compatibility,
download the HondaLink app, and view connection instructions, visit
handsfreelink.honda.com. For the latest apps and feature details, check
hondalink.com.
(HOME) Icon
Select to go back to HOME or to a previous
display.
Microphone
Microphone
Park in a safe place before connecting your phone
and while operating the displayed apps.
Not all phones and apps are compatible with the
system. The system does not display all the available
apps on smartphone, and some apps need to be
preinstalled. Ask a dealer for details.
You need to switch the Bluetooth connection to your
smartphone if another electronic device is connected.
2 Changing the currently paired phone
P. 292
VOL
MENU
Features
The following may vary by phone type:
• How to connect a smartphone to the system.
• Apps that can be operated on the screen.
• Display response time/update time.
We do not support every app operation on the
display audio.
Ask the app provider for any questions on the app’s
features.
HOME
(MENU) Icon
Select to display
the menu on the
app you selected.
(Not available on
all apps.)
1Smartphone Apps
BACK
(BACK) Icon
Select to go back to the previous display.
(Not available on all phones.)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
229
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 230 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSiri Eyes Free
Siri Eyes Free
You can talk to Siri using the Talk button on the steering wheel when your iPhone is
paired to Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®.
1Siri Eyes Free
Siri is a trademark of Apple Inc.
2 Phone Setup P. 291
Check Apple Inc. website for features available for
Siri.
When operating the vehicle, only use Siri through the
Talk button.
■ Using Eyes Free
1Using Eyes Free
Some commands work only on specific phone
features or apps.
Features
Appears
when Siri is
activated in
Eyes Free
While in Eyes Free:
The display remains the same.
No feedback or commands
appear.
(Talk) button:
Press and hold until the display changes as shown.
(Hang-up/back) button:
Press to deactivate Siri.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
230
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 231 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Audio Error Messages
CD Player
If a disc error occurs, you may see the following error messages.
Error Message
Unplayable File
Solution
Track/file format not supported
Mechanical error
●
Current track/file will be skipped. The next supported track/file
plays automatically.
●
Press the
(eject) button and remove the disc, and check that the
error message is cleared.
Check that the disc is not damaged or deformed, and insert the
disc again.
●
2 Protecting CDs P. 236
●
Mecha Error
●
Bad Disc
Please Check Owner’s
Manual*1
Bad Disc
Please Check
Owners Manual*2
Servo error
Check Disc
Disc error
Heat Error
High temperature
●
●
If the error message reappears, press the
button, and pull out
the disc.
Insert a different disc.
If the new disc plays, there is a problem with the first disc.
If the error message repeats, or the disc cannot be removed,
contact a dealer.
Do not try to force the disc out of the player.
Features
Bad Disc
Please check Owner’s
Manual
Please push eject button*1
Bad Disc
Please Check
Owners Manual
Push Eject*2
Cause
Check that the disc is not damaged or deformed.
2 Protecting CDs P. 236
●
Turn the audio system off and allow the player to cool down until
the error message is cleared.
*1 : Display audio system
*2 : Color audio system
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
231
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 232 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio Error MessagesuiPod/USB Flash Drive
iPod/USB Flash Drive
If an error occurs while playing an iPod or USB flash drive, you may see the following
error messages. If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.
Error Message
Solution
Features
USB Error
Appears when there is a problem with the USB adapter unit. Check if the device is compatible
with the USB adapter unit.
The connected USB device has a problem.
See Owner’s Manual*1
Bad USB Device*2
Appears when an incompatible device is connected. Disconnect the device. Then turn the
audio system off, and turn it on again. Do not reconnect the device that caused the error.
Unsupported Version*1
Unsupported Ver*2
Appears when an unsupported iPod is connected. If it appears when a supported iPod is
connected, update the iPod software to the newer version.
Connect Retry*1
Retry Connection*2
Appears when the system does not acknowledge the iPod. Reconnect the iPod.
Unplayable File
Appears when the files in the USB flash drive are DRM or an unsupported format. This error
message appears for about 3 seconds, then plays the next song.
iPod
Appears when the iPod is empty.
No Data*1, *2
USB No Song*2
iPod No Song*2
USB flash drive
Appears when the USB flash drive is empty or there are no MP3, WMA, or AAC files in the
USB flash drive.
iPod and USB flash drive
Check that compatible files are stored on the device.
Unsupported
Appears when an unsupported device is connected. If it appears when a supported device is
connected, reconnect the device.
*1 : Display audio system
*2 : Color audio system
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
232
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 233 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio Error MessagesuPandora®
Models with display audio system
Pandora®
If an error occurs while playing Pandora®, you may see the following error messages.
If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.
Error Message
Solution
The maximum number of stations has been created.
To create more, please delete one or more previously created
stations.
●
Appears when the number of stations that can be created is
exceeded. Follow the message.
●
Appears when the commanded operation is failed. Try again
later.
●
Appears when the station you selected is not available. Change a
station, or try again later.
●
Appears when you have not logged into Pandora®. Follow the
message.
●
Appears when failed to connect. Check your device and try again.
Unable to create new station. Please try again.
Unable to play Pandora. Please try again later.
This Pandora station is currently not available. Please select
another station.
Unable to play Pandora. When stopped, log-in to Pandora.
Features
Unable to save bookmark.
Unable to connect to Pandora. When stopped, check your
mobile phone.
Unable to play Pandora. Please try again later.
Connect Retry
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
233
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 234 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuAudio Error MessagesuPandora®
Error Message
Solution
Unsupported
●
Appears when the device is not supported. Use another device.
Unsupported Version
●
Appears when Pandora® version is not supported. Update
Pandora® to the latest version.
●
Appears when Pandora® is unable to play music. Check the
Bluetooth status on your device.
●
Appears when no data is available with Pandora® activated.
Reboot the app and reconnect the device.
●
Appears when an incompatible device is connected. Disconnect
the device. Then turn the audio system off, and turn it again. Do
not reconnect the device that caused the error.
●
Appears when there is no station list on the device. Create one on
your device.
●
Appears when you try to skip a song or select dislike over the
predetermined number of times in an hour.
Pandora App version is not supported
Unable to connect to the phone.
Please make sure the phone’s Bluetooth setting is ON and try
again.
No Data
Features
The connected USB device has a problem.
See Owner’s Manual
No stations found. Please create a station.
The maximum number of tracks that can be skipped per hour
has been reached.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
234
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 235 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
General Information on the Audio System
Recommended CDs
• Use only high-quality CD-R or CD-RW discs labeled for audio use.
• Use only CD-R or CD-RW discs on which the recordings are closed.
• Play only standard round-shaped CDs.
1Recommended CDs
A Dual-disc cannot play on this audio unit. If recorded
under certain conditions, a CD-R or CD-RW may not
play either.
The CD packages or jackets should have one of these marks.
■ CDs with MP3, WMA, or AAC files
Features
• Some software files may not allow for audio play or text data display.
• Some versions of MP3, WMA, or AAC formats may be unsupported.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
235
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 236 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuRecommended CDs
■ Protecting CDs
1Protecting CDs
Follow these precautions when handling or storing CDs:
• Store a CD in its case when it is not being played.
• When wiping a CD, use a soft clean cloth from the center to the outside edge.
• Handle a CD by its edge. Never touch either surface.
• Never insert foreign objects into the CD player.
• Keep CDs out of direct sunlight and extreme heat.
• Do not place stabilizer rings or labels on the CD.
• Avoid fingerprints, liquids, and felt-tip pens on the CD.
NOTICE
Do not insert a damaged CD. It may be stuck inside
and damage the audio unit.
Examples:
●
Bubbled, wrinkled, labeled, and
excessively thick CDs
Bubbled/
Wrinkled
Features
●
●
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Using
Printer Label
Kit
Sealed
With Plastic Ring
● Poor quality
Damaged CDs
CDs
Chipped/
Cracked
Small CDs
3-inch (8-cm)
CD
236
With Label/
Sticker
Warped
Burrs
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 237 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuCompatible iPod, iPhone, and USB Flash Drives
Compatible iPod, iPhone, and USB Flash Drives
■ iPod and iPhone Model Compatibility
1iPod and iPhone Model Compatibility
Model
iPod (5th generation)
iPod classic 80GB/160GB (launch in 2007)
iPod classic 120GB (launch in 2008)
iPod classic 160GB (launch in 2009)
iPod nano
iPod touch
iPhone 3G/iPhone 3GS/iPhone 4/iPhone 4S/iPhone 5
■ USB Flash Drives
1USB Flash Drives
Use a recommended USB flash drive of 256 MB or higher.
Some digital audio players may not be compatible.
Some USB flash drives (e.g., a device with security lockout) may not work.
Some software files may not allow for audio play or text data display.
Some versions of MP3, WMA, or AAC formats may be unsupported.
Files on the USB flash drive are played in their stored
order. This order may be different from the order
displayed on your PC or device.
Features
•
•
•
•
•
This system may not work with all software versions
of these devices.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
237
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 238 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Customized Features
Use the audio/information screen to customize certain features.
1Customized Features
When you customize settings:
• Make sure that the vehicle is at a complete stop.
Models with navigation system
See the navigation system manual for information of the customized features.
Continuously variable transmission models
• Shift to (P .
Models with color audio system
Manual transmission models
■ How to customize
• Set the parking brake.
While the vehicle is at a complete stop with the ignition switch in ON (w , press the
MENU/CLOCK button, then select Settings. To customize the phone settings,
press the
button, then select Phone Setup.
Audio/Information Screen
Features
(Phone) Button
These indications are used to show how to operate
the selector knob.
Rotate
to select.
Press
to enter.
To customize other features, select Settings, rotate
, then press
.
2 List of customizable options P. 242
MENU/CLOCK Button
Selector Knob
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
238
1How to customize
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 239 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Models with color audio system
■ Customization Flow
Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
Adjust Clock
Settings
Bluetooth
Add New Device
Connect an Audio Device
Features
Display Adjustment
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Rear Camera
Camera Guideline
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
239
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 240 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Display Change
Audio
Wallpaper
Wallpaper
Select
Import
Delete
Features
Color Theme
Blue
Red
Amber
Gray
Language
Clock Format
12h
24h
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
240
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 241 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Press the
button and rotate
to select Phone Setup, then press
Bluetooth Setup
.
Add New Device
Connect a Phone
Connect an Audio Device
Disconnect All Devices
Delete Device
Pass-Key
Ringtone
Features
Speed Dial
Fixed
Mobile Phone
Caller ID Info
Name Priority
Number Priority
System Clear
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
241
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 242 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Models with color audio system
■ List of customizable options
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Description
Adjusts the clock.
Adjust Clock
—
2 Clock P. 94
Add New Device
Bluetooth
Features
Brightness
Settings
Display
Contrast
Adjustment
Black Level
Rear
Camera
Pairs a new phone to HFL, edits and deletes a
paired phone, and create a code for a paired
phone.
—
2 Phone Setup P. 266
Connect an Audio
Device
Camera Guideline
Connects, disconnects or pairs a Bluetooth®
Audio device to HFL.
Changes the brightness of the audio/
information screen.
Changes the contrast of the audio/
information screen.
Changes the black level of the audio/
information screen.
Selects whether the guidelines come on the
audio/information screen.
*1:Default Setting
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
242
Selectable Settings
—
—
—
—
On*1/Off
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 243 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Display Change
Select
Wallpaper
Import
Delete
Settings
Color Theme
Language
Changes the display type.
Changes the wallpaper type.
Selectable Settings
Audio*1/Wallpaper
Clock*1/Image1/Image2/
Image3
Imports an image file for a new wallpaper.
—
2 Wallpaper Setup P. 185
Deletes an image file for a wallpaper.
Changes the background color of the audio/
information screen.
Changes the display language.
Selects the digital clock display from 12H to
24H.
Image1*1/Image2/Image3
Blue*1/Red/Amber/Gray
English*1/French/Spanish
12h*1/24h
Features
Clock Format
Description
*1:Default Setting
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
243
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 244 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Add New Device
Connect a Phone
Bluetooth
Setup
Phone
Setup
Features
Speed Dial
Ringtone
Caller ID Info
System Clear
Description
Pairs a new phone to HFL.
—
2 Phone Setup P. 266
Pairs a new phone or connects a paired phone
to HFL.
—
2 Phone Setup P. 266
Connect an Audio
Device
Disconnect All Devices
Delete Device
Pass-Key
Connects a Bluetooth® Audio device to HFL.
—
Disconnects a paired phone from HFL.
Deletes a paired phone.
Inputs and changes a code for a paired phone.
Edits, adds or deletes a speed dial entry.
—
—
—
—
2 Speed Dial P. 273
Selects the ring tone.
Fixed /Mobile Phone
Prioritizes the caller’s name or phone number Name Priority*1/Number
as the caller ID.
Priority
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
—
Phone Setup group as default.
*1
*1:Default Setting
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
244
Selectable Settings
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 245 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Models with display audio system
1Customized Features
■ How to customize
While the vehicle is at a complete stop with the ignition switch in ON (w *1, select
Settings, then select a setting item.
When you customize settings:
• Make sure that the vehicle is at a complete stop.
•
Continuously variable transmission models
Shift to (P .
•
Manual transmission models
Set the parking brake.
Audio/Information Screen
1How to customize
To customize other features, select Settings.
2 List of customizable options P. 251
HOME
Features
VOL
MENU
BACK
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
245
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 246 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Models with display audio system
■ Customization Flow
Select HOME.
Home
Home Screen Edit Order
Display
Display Settings
Select Settings.
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Background Color
Features
System
Sound/Beep
Volume
Beep Volume
Voice Recog
Voice Prompt
Volume
Phonebook Phonetic Modification
Automatic Phone Sync
Clock
Clock/Wallpaper Type
Clock Adjustment
Clock Format
Clock Display
Clock Location
Clock Reset
Others
Language
Keyboard Layout
Voice Command Tips *
Remember Last Screen
Factory Data Reset
Default
246
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Clock
Wallpaper
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 247 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Audio
Sound
Audio Source Pop-Up
[Your selected media] Cover Art*1
Display Adjustment*1
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Color
Color
Tint
Features
Display
Aspect Ratio Adjustment*1
Change Bluetooth Audio Device*1
Bluetooth Device List*1
Default
*1: May change depending on your currently selected source.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
247
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 248 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Info
Clock
Clock/Wallpaper Type
Clock Adjustment
Clock Format
Clock Display
Clock Location
Clock Reset
Features
Other
Info Screen Preference
Default
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
248
Clock
Wallpaper
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 249 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Phone
Phone
Connect Phone
Bluetooth Device List
Edit Speed Dial
Ring Tone
Automatic Phone Sync
HondaLink Assist
Features
Text/Email
Enable Text/Email
Select Account
New Message Notification
Default
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
249
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 250 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Camera
Rear Wide Camera
Fixed Guideline
Dynamic Guideline
Default
LaneWatch *
Show with Turn Signal
Display Time after Turn Signal Off
Features
Reference Line
Default
Bluetooth
Bluetooth On/Off Status
Bluetooth Device List
Edit Pairing Code
Default
250
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 251 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Models with display audio system
■ List of customizable options
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Home
System
Display
Home Screen Edit Order Changes the HOME screen icon layout.
Changes the brightness of the audio/
Brightness
information screen.
Display
Changes the contrast of the audio/
Contrast
Settings
information screen.
Changes the black level of the audio/
Black Level
information screen.
Changes the background color of the audio/
Background Color
information screen.
Volume
Changes the sound volume.
Beep Volume
Changes the beep volume.
Selectable Settings
—
—
—
—
Blue*1/Amber/Red/Violet
0-6*1-11
Off/1/2*1/3
Features
Sound/
Beep
Description
*1:Default Setting
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
251
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 252 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Voice
Recog
Voice Prompt
Volume
Phonebook Phonetic
Modification
Automatic Phone Sync
Clock
Features
Clock/
Wallpaper
Type
Description
Turns the voice prompt on and off.
Changes the volume of the voice prompt.
Wallpaper
—
Sets a phonebook data to be automatically
imported when a phone is paired to HFL.
On/Off
Changes the clock display type.
Analog/Digital*1/Small
Digital/Off
●
●
Changes the wallpaper type.
Imports an image file for a new wallpaper.
Deletes an image file for a wallpaper.
Blank/Galaxy*1/Metallic
2 Wallpaper Setup P. 207
Clock Adjustment
Clock
Clock Format
Clock Display
Clock Location
Adjusts the clock.
Clock Reset
—
2 Clock P. 94
Selects the digital clock display from 12H to
24H.
Selects whether the clock display comes on.
Changes the clock display layout.
Cancels/Resets all customized items for clock
display as default.
*1:Default Setting
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
252
On /Off
0-6*1-11
Modifies a voice command for the phonebook.
●
System
Selectable Settings
*1
12H*1/24H
On*1/Off
Upper Right*1/Upper Left/
Lower Right/Lower Left/
Off
Yes/No
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 253 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Language
Keyboard Layout
Voice Command Tips *
Others
System
Remember Last Screen
Factory Data Reset
Sound
Changes the display language.
Selects the on-screen keyboard type.
Alerts you when manual control of the system
is disabled to prevent distraction while driving.
Only voice commands are available.
Selects whether the device remembers the last
screen.
Resets all the settings to their factory default.
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 259
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
System group as default.
Adjusts the settings of the audio speaker’s
sound
2 Adjusting the Sound P. 209
Audio
Audio Source Pop-Up
Selectable Settings
English*1/French/Spanish
Alphabet/QWERTY*1
On*1/Off
On/Off*1
Yes/No
Yes/No
-6 ~ 0*1 ~ +6 (BASS and
TREBLE), RR9~0*1~FR9
(FADER), L9~0*1~R9
(BALANCE), Off/Low/Mid*1/
High (SVC)
Features
Default
Description
Selects whether the list of selectable audio
sources comes on when Audio is selected on On/Off*1
the HOME screen.
*1:Default Setting
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
253
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 254 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Description
Selectable Settings
iPod or USB mode
Audio
Features
Turns on and off the cover art display.
On*1/Off
[Your selected media] Cover Art
Brightness
2 System P. 251
Contrast
Display
HDMI® mode
Black Level
Display
Changes the color of the audio/information
Color
—
Adjustment
screen.
Color
Changes the tint of the audio/information
Tint
—
screen.
HDMI® mode
Changes the aspect ratio and zoom settings of
Normal/Full*1/Zoom
the audio/information screen.
Aspect Ratio Adjustment
Bluetooth® Audio mode
Connects, disconnects or pairs a Bluetooth®
—
Audio device to HFL.
Change Bluetooth Audio Device
Pairs a new phone to HFL, edits or deletes a
Bluetooth® Audio mode
—
paired phone.
Bluetooth Device List
2 Phone Setup P. 291
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
Audio group as default.
*1:Default Setting
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
254
Yes/No
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 255 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Clock
Info
Other
Selectable Settings
2 System P. 251
Changes the Info Screen type.
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
Info group as default.
Info Top/Info Menu/Off*1
Features
Default
Clock/
Clock
Wallpaper
Wallpaper
type
Clock Adjustment
Clock Format
Clock Display
Clock Location
Clock Reset
Info Screen Preference
Description
Yes/No
*1:Default Setting
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
255
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 256 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Connect Phone
Description
Selectable Settings
Pairs a new phone to HFL, connects or
disconnects a paired phone.
—
2 Phone Setup P. 291
Bluetooth Device List
Edit Speed Dial
Ring Tone
Features
Automatic Phone Sync
HondaLink Assist
Enable Text/Email
Text/Email
Select Account
New Message
Notification
Default
Edits, adds or deletes a speed dial entry.
—
2 Speed Dial P. 298
Selects the ring tone.
Sets a phonebook data to be automatically
imported when a phone is paired to HFL.
Turns HondaLink Assist on and off.
Turns the text/e-mail message function on and
off.
Selects a mail or text message account.
Selects whether a pop-up alert comes on the
screen when HFL receives a new text/e-mail
message.
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
Phone and Text/Email group as default.
*1:Default Setting
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
256
—
2 Phone Setup P. 291
Phone
Phone
Pairs a new phone to HFL, edits or deletes a
paired phone.
Fixed/Mobile Phone*1
On/Off
On/Off*1
On*1/Off
—
On/Off*1
Yes/No
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 257 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Description
Rear Wide
Camera
Camera
LaneWatch *
On*1/Off
On*1/Off
Yes/No
On*1/Off
0 second*1/2 seconds
Features
Selects whether the fixed guidelines come on
on the rear camera monitor.
Selects whether the dynamic guidelines come
Dynamic Guideline
on on the rear camera monitor.
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
Default
Rear Wide Camera group as default.
Selects whether the LaneWatch display comes
Show with Turn Signal on when you move the turn signal lever to the
passenger side.
Changes the length of time the LaneWatch
Display Time after Turn
display stays on after you pull the turn signal
Signal Off
lever back.
Selects whether the reference lines come on
Reference Line
the LaneWatch monitor.
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
Default
LaneWatch group as default.
Fixed Guideline
Selectable Settings
On*1/Off
Yes/No
*1:Default Setting
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
257
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 258 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Bluetooth On/Off Status
Bluetooth Device List
Description
Changes the Bluetooth® status.
Pairs a new phone to HFL, edits or deletes a
paired phone, or creates a security PIN.
On /Off
—
2 Phone Setup P. 291
Bluetooth
Edit Pairing Code
Default
Edits Pairing Code.
2 To change the pairing code setting P. 292
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
Bluetooth group as default.
*1:Default Setting
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
258
Selectable Settings
*1
Random/Fixed*1
Yes/No
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 259 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomized FeaturesuDefaulting All the Settings
Defaulting All the Settings
Models with display audio system
1Defaulting All the Settings
Reset all the menu and customized settings as the factory defaults.
1. Select HOME.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
u Repeat the procedure to select the
Others tab, then Factory Data Reset.
u The confirmation message will appear.
4. Select Yes to reset the settings.
5. Select Yes again to reset the settings.
u The confirmation message will appear.
Select OK.
When you transfer the vehicle to a third party, reset
all settings to default and delete all personal data.
The following settings will be reset:
• Audio preset settings
• Phonebook entries
• Other display and personal settings.
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
259
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 260 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Models with navigation system
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
See the navigation system manual for how to operate the Bluetooth®
HandsFreeLink®.
Models without navigation system
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) allows you to place and receive phone calls using
your vehicle’s audio system, without handling your cell phone.
Models with color audio system
To use HFL, you need a Bluetooth-compatible cell
phone. For a list of compatible phones, pairing
procedures, and special feature capabilities:
• U.S.: Visit www.handsfreelink.honda.com, or call
1-888-528 -7876.
• Canada: Visit www.handsfreelink.ca, or call 1-888528 -7876.
Voice control tips
• Aim the vents away from the ceiling and close the
Using HFL
■ HFL Buttons
Features
Volume up
Volume down
Microphone
(Phone) Button
windows, as noise coming from them may interfere
with the microphone.
• Press and release the
button when you want to
call a number using a stored voice tag. Speak
clearly and naturally after a beep.
• If the microphone picks up voices other than yours,
the command may be misinterpreted.
• To change the volume level, use the audio system's
volume knob or the remote audio controls * on the
steering wheel.
State or local laws may prohibit the operation of
handheld electronic devices while operating a
vehicle.
(Talk) Button
(Hang-up/Back) Button
(Pick-up) Button
260
Selector Knob
(Pick-up) button: Press to go directly to the Phone screen or to answer an
incoming call.
(Hang-up/Back) button: Press to end a call or to cancel a command.
(Talk) button: Press to call a number with a stored voice tag.
(Phone) button: Press to go directly to the Phone screen.
Selector knob: Rotate
to select an item on the screen, then press .
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
* Not available on all models
If you receive a call while using the audio system, the
system resumes its operation after ending the call.
Up to 20 speed dial entries can be stored. If there is
no entry in the system, Speed Dial is disabled.
2 Speed Dial P. 273
Up to 20 call histories can be stored. If there is no call
history, Call History is disabled.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 261 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uUsing HFL
■ HFL Status Display
Battery Level Status
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
The audio/information screen notifies you
when there is an incoming call.
Signal Strength
Roam Status
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your
phone is connected
to HFL.
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered
trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and any
use of such marks by Honda Motor Co., Ltd., is under
license. Other trademarks and trade names are those
of their respective owners.
HFL Limitations
An incoming call on HFL will interrupt the audio
system when it is playing. It will resume when the call
is ended.
HFL Mode
Call Name
The information that appears on the audio/
information screen varies between phone models.
Features
1HFL Status Display
You can change the system language to English,
French, or Spanish.
2 Customized Features P. 238
■ Limitations for Manual Operation
Certain manual functions are disabled or inoperable while the vehicle is in motion.
You cannot select a grayed-out option until the vehicle is stopped.
Only previously stored speed dial entries can be called using voice commands while
the vehicle is in motion.
2 Speed Dial P. 273
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
261
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 262 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
HFL Menus
The ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY (q or ON (w to use HFL.
To use HFL, you must first pair your Bluetoothcompatible cell phone to the system while the vehicle
is parked.
or
Phone
Speed Dial*1
Add New
Some functions are limited while driving. A message
appears on the screen when the vehicle is moving
and the operation is canceled.
Features
(Existing entry list)
Call History*1
Call History
Select a phone number from the call history to
store as a speed dial number.
Phonebook
Select a phone number from the phonebook to
store as a speed dial number.
Phone Number
Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial
number.
Dialed Calls
Display the last 20 outgoing calls.
Received Calls
Display the last 20 incoming calls.
Missed Calls
Display the last 20 missed calls.
Phonebook*1
Display the paired phones’s phonebook.
Dial*1
Enter a phone number to dial.
*1 : Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
262
1HFL Menus
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 263 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Redial*1
Redial the last number dialed in the phone’s history.
Phone Setup
Bluetooth Setup
Pair a phone to the system.
Connect a Phone
Connect a phone to the system.
Connect an Audio Device
Connect a Bluetooth® Audio device to the
system.
Disconnect All Devices
Disconnect a paired phone from the system.
Delete Device
Delete a previously paired phone.
Pass-key
Create a code for a paired phone.
Features
Add New Device
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
263
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 264 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Speed Dial*1
Add New
Call History
Phonebook
Select a phone number from the phonebook
to store as a speed dial number.
Phone Number
Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial
number.
Features
Existing entry list
Change Speed Dial
*1 : Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
Change a previously stored speed dial
number.
Delete Speed Dial
Delete a previously stored speed dial number.
Store Voice Tag
Create a voice tag for a speed dial number.
Change Voice Tag
Change a voice tag for a speed dial number.
Delete Voice Tag
Delete a voice tag for a speed dial number.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
264
Select a phone number from the call history
to store as a speed dial number.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 265 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Ringtone
Caller ID Info
Select the ring tone stored in HFL.
Mobile Phone
Select the ring tone stored in the connected
cell phone.
Name Priority
Prioritize the caller’s name as the caller ID.
Number Priority
Prioritize the caller’s phone number as the
caller ID.
Features
System Clear
Fixed
Clear the system of all paired phones, phonebook entries,
and security codes.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
265
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 266 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Phone Setup
1Phone Setup
■ To pair a cell phone (No phone has
Features
been paired to the system)
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
3. Make sure your phone is in search or
discoverable mode, then press .
u HFL automatically searches for a
Bluetooth® device.
4. When your phone appears on the list, select
it by pressing .
u If your phone doesn’t appear, select
Phone Not Found? and search for
Bluetooth® devices using your phone.
From your phone, select
HandsFreeLink.
5. The system gives you a pairing code on the
audio/information screen.
u Confirm if the pairing code on the screen
and your phone match.
This may vary by phone.
6. A notification appears on the screen if
pairing is successful.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
266
Your Bluetooth-compatible phone must be paired to
HFL before you can make and receive hands-free
calls.
Phone Pairing Tips:
• You cannot pair your phone while the vehicle is
moving.
• Up to six phones can be paired.
• Your phone’s battery may drain faster when it is
connected to HFL.
• If your phone is not ready for pairing or not found
by the system within three minutes, the system will
time out and returns to idle.
Once you have paired a phone, you can see it
displayed on the screen with one or two icons on the
right side.
These icons indicate the following:
: The phone can be used with HFL.
: The phone is compatible with Bluetooth® Audio.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 267 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To Change the currently paired phone
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Bluetooth Setup, then
press .
You can pair a phone in the following steps.
Phone Setup Bluetooth Setup Add New
Device confirmation message Yes
confirmation message OK Select a Phone
Pairing code.
Features
4. Rotate
to select Connect a Phone,
then press .
u The screen changes to a device list.
1Phone Setup
5. Rotate
to select a desired device name,
then press .
u HFL disconnects the connected phone
and starts searching for another paired
phone.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
267
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 268 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To change the pairing code setting
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Bluetooth Setup, then
press .
4. Rotate
.
to select Pass-Key, then press
Features
5. Input a new pairing code, then press
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
268
.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 269 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To delete a paired phone
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Bluetooth Setup, then
press .
Features
4. Rotate
to select Delete Device, then
press .
u The screen changes to a device list.
5. Rotate
to select a phone you want to
delete, then press .
6. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then press
.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
269
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 270 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Ring Tone
1Ring Tone
You can change the ring tone setting.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Ringtone, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select Fixed or Mobile
Phone, then press .
Features
■ Caller’s ID Information
1Caller’s ID Information
You can select a caller’s information to be displayed when you have an incoming
call.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Caller ID Info, then
press .
4. Rotate
to select a mode you want, then
press .
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
270
Fixed: The fixed ring tone sounds from the speakers.
Mobile Phone: The ring tone stored in the
connected cell phone sounds from the speakers.
Name Priority: A caller’s name is displayed if it is
stored in the phonebook.
Number Priority: A caller’s phone number is
displayed.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 271 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To Clear the System
Pairing codes, paired phones, all stored voice tags, all speed dial entries, all call
history data, and all imported phonebook data are erased.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select System Clear, then
press .
4. Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
Features
5. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then press
.
6. A notification appears on the screen. Press
.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
271
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 272 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
When your phone is paired, the contents of its phonebook and call history are
automatically imported to HFL.
1Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
When you select a person from the list in the cellular
phonebook, you can see up to three category icons.
The icons indicate what types of numbers are stored
for that name.
Pref
Fax
Home
Car
Mobile
Other
Work
Voice
Features
Pager
If a name has four or more numbers, ... appears
instead of category icons.
On some phones, it may not be possible to import the
category icons to HFL.
The phonebook is updated after every connection.
Call history is updated after every connection or call.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
272
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 273 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Speed Dial
1Speed Dial
Cha
Change
hange
ge Sp
Speed
eed Dial
Delete
Speed
Dial
D lete
Del
ete
t Sp
S
eed
d Di
ia
all
You can use the audio preset buttons during a call to
store a speed dial number:
1. Press and hold the desired audio preset button
during a call.
2. The contact information for the active call will be
stored for the corresponding speed dial.
When a voice tag is stored, you can press the
button and call the number using voice commands.
Features
Up to 20 speed dial numbers can be stored per phone.
To store a speed dial number:
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select Add New, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select a place to choose a
number from, then press .
From Call History:
u Select a number from the call history.
From Phonebook:
u Select a number from the connected cell
phone’s imported phonebook.
From Phone Number:
u Input the number manually.
5. When the speed dial is successfully stored,
you are asked to create a voice tag for the
number. Rotate
to select Yes or No,
then press .
6. Using the
button, follow the prompts to
say the name for the speed dial entry.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
273
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 274 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To edit a speed dial
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Change Speed Dial,
then press .
6. Select a new speed dial number, then press
.
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
274
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 275 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To add a voice tag to a stored speed
Change Speed Dial
Delete Speed Dial
Store Voice Tag
Delete
Speed
Del
ete Sp
peed
ee Di
Dial
al
■ To change a voice tag
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Change Voice Tag,
then press .
6. Using the
button, follow the prompts to
complete the voice tag.
1Speed Dial
Avoid using duplicate voice tags.
Avoid using “home” as a voice tag.
It is easier for HFL to recognize a longer name. For
example, use “John Smith” instead of “John.”
Features
Change
Cha
nge
e Sp
Speed
peed
ee Di
Dial
al
dial number
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Store Voice Tag, then
press .
6. Using the
button, follow the prompts to
complete the voice tag.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
275
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 276 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To delete a voice tag
Features
Change Speed Dial
Delete Speed Dial
Store Voice Tag
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Delete Voice Tag,
then press .
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then
press .
■ To delete a speed dial number
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Delete Speed Dial,
then press .
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then
press .
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
276
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 277 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Making a Call
1Making a Call
You can make calls by inputting any phone number, or by using the imported
phonebook, call history, speed dial entries, or redial.
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by
voice from any screen.
Press the
button and follow the prompts.
The maximum range between your phone and
vehicles is 30 feet (10 meters).
Once a call is connected, you can hear the voice of
the person you are calling through the audio
speakers.
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
277
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 278 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using the imported
Features
phonebook
When your phone is paired, the contents of its
phonebook are automatically imported to
HFL.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phonebook, then
press .
3. The phonebook is stored alphabetically.
Rotate
to select the initial, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select a name, then press .
5. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
■ To make a call using a phone number
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Dial, then press .
3. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select
, then press .
u Dialing starts automatically.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
278
1To make a call using the imported phonebook
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed
dial number using voice commands.
2 Limitations for Manual Operation P. 261
2 Speed Dial P. 273
1To make a call using a phone number
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed
dial number using voice commands.
2 Limitations for Manual Operation P. 261
2 Speed Dial P. 273
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 279 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using redial
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Redial, then press
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using redial
.
1To make a call using the call history
The call history appears only when a phone is
connected to HFL, and displays the last 20 dialed,
received, or missed calls.
Features
■ To make a call using the call history
Call history is stored by Dialed Calls,
Received Calls, and Missed Calls.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Call History, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Dialed Calls, Received
Calls, or Missed Calls, then press .
4. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
Press and hold the
button to redial the last
number dialed in your phone’s call history.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
279
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 280 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using a speed dial entry
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using a speed dial entry
On the Phone screen, the first six speed dials on the
list can be directly selected by pressing the
corresponding audio preset buttons (1-6).
Select Others to view another paired phone’s speed
dial list.
When a voice tag is stored, press the
button and
call the number using voice commands.
2 Speed Dial P. 273
Features
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by
voice from any screen. Press the
button and
follow the prompts.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
280
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 281 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Receiving a Call
HFL Mode
1Receiving a Call
When there is an incoming call, an audible
notification sounds and the Incoming Call
screen appears.
Press the
Press the
button to answer the call.
button to decline or end the call.
Caller’s Name
Call Waiting
Press the
button to put the current call on hold
to answer the incoming call.
Press the
button again to return to the current
call.
Select Ignore to ignore the incoming call if you do
not want to answer it.
Press the
button if you want to hang up the
current call.
Features
You can select the icons on the audio/information
screen instead of the
and
buttons. Rotate
to select the icon, then press
.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
281
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 282 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Options During a Call
1Options During a Call
Features
The following options are available during a call.
Swap Call: Put the current call on hold to answer the incoming call.
Mute: Mute your voice.
Transfer Call: Transfer a call from HFL to your phone.
Dial Tones: Send numbers during a call. This is useful when you call a menu-driven
phone system.
1. To view the available options, press the
button.
2. Rotate
to select the option, then press
.
u The check box is checked when Mute is
selected. Select Mute again to turn it off.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
282
Dial Tones: Available on some phones.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 283 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Models with navigation system
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
See the navigation system manual for how to operate the Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®.
Models without navigation system
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) allows you to place and receive phone calls using
your vehicle's audio system, without handling your cell phone.
Models with display audio system
Using HFL
To use HFL, you need a Bluetooth-compatible cell
phone. For a list of compatible phones, pairing
procedures, and special feature capabilities:
• U.S.: Visit www.handsfreelink.honda.com, or call
1-888-528 -7876.
• Canada: Visit www.handsfreelink.ca, or call 1-888528-7876.
To use HFL, the Bluetooth On/Off Status setting
must be On.
2 Customized Features P. 238
■ HFL Buttons
/
Voice control tips
• Press and release the
button when you want to
call a number using a stored voice tag, a
phonebook, name or a number. Speak clearly and
naturally after a beep
• If the microphone picks up voices other than yours,
the command may be misinterpreted.
• To change the volume level, use the audio system's
VOL (Volume) or use the remote audio controls on
the steering wheel.
(HOME) Icon
Microphones
Buttons
HOME
VOL
Features
(MENU) Button
Volume down
Volume up
SOURCE Button
MENU
State or local laws may prohibit the operation of
handheld electronic devices while operating a
vehicle.
BACK
(MENU) Icon
(Talk) Button
(Hang-up/Back) Button
(Pick-up) Button
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
283
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 284 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uUsing HFL
(Pick-up) button: Press to go directly to the Phone screen, or to answer an
incoming call.
(Hang-up/Back) button: Press to end a call, go back to the previous
command, or to cancel a command.
(Talk) button: Press to call a number with a stored voice tag, a phonebook,
name, or a number.
button: Press to display Speed Dial, Call History, or Redial on the Phone
screen.
/
button: Press to select an item displayed on the Phone screen.
SOURCE button: Press to call a number listed in the selected item on the Phone
screen.
Up to six speed dial entries can be displayed among a
total of 20 that can be entered. If there is no entries
in the system, Speed Dial is disabled.
2 Speed Dial P. 273
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered
trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and any
use of such marks by Honda Motor Co., Ltd., is under
license. Other trademarks and trade names are those
of their respective owners.
Features
HFL Limitations
An incoming call on HFL will interrupt the audio
system when it is playing. It will resume when the call
is ended.
To go to the Phone menu screen:
1. Select HOME.
2. Select Phone to switch the display to the Phone screen.
3. Select MENU.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
284
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 285 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uUsing HFL
■ HFL Status Display
1HFL Status Display
The audio/information screen notifies you when there is an incoming call.
Bluetooth Indicator
Comes on when your
phone is connected to HFL.
Battery Level Status
Signal Strength
The information that appears on the audio/
information screen varies between phone models.
You can change the system language to English,
French, or Spanish.
2 Customized Features P. 238
HFL Mode
Caller’s Name
Caller’s Number
Features
■ Limitations for Manual Operation
Certain manual functions are disabled or inoperable while the vehicle is in motion.
You cannot select a grayed-out option until the vehicle is stopped.
Only previously stored speed dial entries with voice tags, phone book names, or
numbers can be called using voice commands while the vehicle is in motion.
2 Speed Dial P. 298
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
285
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 286 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
HFL Menus
The ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY (q or ON (w *1 to use HFL.
1HFL Menus
To use HFL, you must first pair your Bluetoothcompatible mobile phone to the system while the
vehicle is parked.
■ Phone settings screen
1. Select HOME.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Phone Settings.
Features
Phone
Connect Phone*2
Bluetooth Device List
Some functions are limited while driving. A message
appears on the screen when the vehicle is moving
and the operation is canceled.
Add Bluetooth Device
Pair a phone to the system.
(Existing entry list)
Connect a phone to the system.
Disconnect
Disconnect a paired phone from the system.
(Existing entry list)*2
Add Bluetooth Device
Edit Device Name
Edit a previously paired
phone name.
Delete This Device
Delete a previously paired
phone.
Pair a phone to the system.
*1 : Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
*2 : Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
286
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 287 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Edit Speed Dial*1
New Entry
(Existing entry list)
Enter a phone number to
store as a speed dial number.
Import from Call History
Select a phone number from
the call history to store as a
speed dial number.
Import from Phonebook
Select a phone number from
the phonebook to store as a
speed dial number.
Edit
Edit a previously stored speed
dial number.
● Change a name.
● Change a number.
● Create or delete a voice tag.
Delete
Delete a previously stored
speed dial number.
Features
Delete All
Manual Input
Delete all of the previously stored speed dial number.
Ring Tone
Select the ring tone.
Automatic Phone Sync*1
Set phonebook data to be automatically imported when a phone is paired to HFL.
HondaLink Assist*1
Turn HondaLink Assist on and off.
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
287
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 288 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Text/Email*1
Enable Text/Email
Turn the text/e-mail message function on and off.
Select Account
Select a mail or text message account.
New Message Notification Select whether a pop-up alert comes on the screen when HFL
receives a new text/e-mail message.
Features
Default
Cancel/Reset all customized items in the Phone Settings group as default.
*1 : Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
288
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 289 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Phone menu screen
1. Press
, or select HOME, then select
Phone.
2. Press
(MENU) on the steering wheel, or
select MENU.
New Entry
Manual Input
Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial
number.
Import from Call History
Select a phone number from the call history to store
as a speed dial number.
Import from Phonebook
Select a phone number from the phonebook to store
as a speed dial number.
Features
Speed Dial*1
(Existing entry list) Dial the selected number in the speed dial list.
Phonebook*1
Display the paired phone’s phonebook.
Redial*1
Redial the last number dialed in the phone’s history.
Dial*1
Enter a phone number to dial.
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
289
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 290 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Call History*1
Text/Email*1
All
Display the last 20 outgoing, incoming and missed calls.
Dialed
Display the last 20 outgoing calls.
Received
Display the last 20 incoming calls.
Missed
Display the last 20 missed calls.
Select Account *
Features
Select a message.
Message is read aloud.
Select a mail or text message account.
Read/Stop
(previous)
See the previous message.
(next)
See the next message.
Reply
Reply to a received message using one of six fixed
phrases.
Call
Make a call to the sender.
*1 : Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
290
* Not available on all models
System reads received message aloud, or stop
message from being read.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 291 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Phone Setup
1Phone Setup
■ To pair a mobile phone (when there is
Phone Pairing Tips:
• You cannot pair your phone while the vehicle is
moving.
• Up to six phones can be paired.
• Your phone’s battery may drain faster when it is
paired to HFL.
• If your phone is not ready for pairing or not found
by the system, the system will return to the
previous screen.
Features
no phone paired to the system)
1. Select Phone.
2. Select Yes.
3. Make sure your phone is in search or
discoverable mode, then select OK.
u HFL automatically searches for a
Bluetooth device.
4. Select your phone when it appears on the
list.
u If your phone does not appear, you can
select Refresh to search again.
u If your phone still does not appear, select
Phone not found and search for
Bluetooth devices using your phone.
From your phone, select
HandsFreeLink.
5. The system gives you a pairing code on the
audio/information screen.
u Confirm if the pairing code on the screen
and your phone match.This may vary by
phone.
6. A notification appears on the screen if
pairing is successful.
Your Bluetooth-compatible phone must be paired to
HFL before you can make and receive hands-free
calls.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
291
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 292 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Changing the currently paired phone
1. Go to the Phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 286
2. Select Connect Phone.
3. Select a phone to connect.
u HFL disconnects the current phone and
starts searching for another paired
phone.
■ To change the pairing code setting
Features
1. Select HOME.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Bluetooth.
4. Select the Bluetooth tab.
5. Select Edit Pairing Code.
6. Select Fixed or Random.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
292
1Changing the currently paired phone
If no other phones are found or paired when trying to
switch to another phone, HFL will inform you that the
original phone is connected again.
1To change the pairing code setting
The default pairing code is 0000 until you change the
setting.
To create your own, select Fixed, and delete the
current code, then enter a new one.
For a randomly generated pairing code each time you
pair a phone, select Random.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 293 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To edit an already-paired phone name
1. Go to the Phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 286
2. Select the Phone tab.
3. Select Bluetooth Device List.
4. Select a paired phone you want to edit.
5. Select Edit Device Name.
6. Edit the name and select OK.
7. A notification appears if the change is
successful.
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
293
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 294 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To delete a paired phone
1. Go to the Phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 286
2. Select the Phone tab.
3. Select Bluetooth Device List.
4. Select a phone you want to delete.
5. Select Delete This Device.
6. You will receive a confirmation message on
the screen. Select Yes.
7. A notification appears if the deletion is
successful.
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
294
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 295 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To Set Up a Text/E-mail Message Options
■ To turn on or off the text/e-mail
function
1. Go to the Phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 286
2. Select the Text/Email tab, then Enable
Text/Email.
u A pop-up menu appears on the screen.
3. Select On or Off.
2 Phone settings screen P. 286
2. Select the Text/Email tab, then New
Message Notification.
u A pop-up menu appears on the screen.
3. Select On or Off.
1To turn on or off the text/e-mail notice
On: A pop-up notification comes on every time you
receive a new message.
Off: The message you receive is stored in the system
without notification.
Features
■ To turn on or off the text/e-mail notice
1. Go to the Phone settings screen.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
295
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 296 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Ring Tone
1Ring Tone
You can change the ring tone setting.
1. Go to the Phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 286
2. Select the Phone tab, then Ring Tone.
3. Select Fixed or Mobile Phone.
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
296
Fixed: The fixed ring tone sounds from the speaker.
Mobile Phone: The ring tone stored in the
connected cell phone is heard through the vehicle
speakers.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 297 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
■ When Automatic Phone Sync is set to
On:
When your phone is paired, the contents of its
phonebook and call history are automatically
imported to the system.
1Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
When you select a person from the list in the cellular
phonebook, you can see up to three category icons.
The icons indicate what types of numbers are stored
for that name.
Fax
Home
Car
Mobile
Other
■ Changing the Automatic Phone Sync
Work
Voice
setting
1. Go to the Phone settings screen.
Pager
2 Phone settings screen P. 286
2. Select the Phone tab, then Automatic
Phone Sync.
3. Select On or Off.
On some phones, it may not be possible to import the
category icons to the system.
Features
Pref
The phonebook is updated after every connection.
Call history is updated after every connection or call.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
297
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 298 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Speed Dial
1Speed Dial
Up to 20 speed dial numbers can be stored per phone.
To store a speed dial number:
1. Go to the Phone menu screen.
2 Phone menu screen P. 289
Features
2. Select Speed Dial.
u Repeat the procedure to select New
Entry.
3. Select a place to choose a number.
From Import from Call History:
u Select a number from the call history.
From Manual Input:
u Input the number manually.
From Import from Phonebook:
u Select a number from the linked cell
phone’s imported phonebook.
4. When the speed dial is successfully stored
from Import from Call History or Import
from Phonebook, you are asked to create
a voice tag for the number. Select Yes or
No.
5. Select Record to store a voice tag for the
speed dial entry.
u Using the
button, follow the prompts
to store a voice tag for the speed dial
entry.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
298
When a voice tag is stored, press the
button to
call the number using the voice tag. Say “Call” and
the voice tag name.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 299 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To add a voice tag to a stored speed
dial number
1. Go to the Phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 286
2. Select Phone tab, then Edit Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, select Edit.
4. Select Voice Tag.
u From the pop-up menu, select Record.
5. Select Record to store the voice tag.
6. Using the
button, follow the prompts to
complete the voice tag.
1Speed Dial
Avoid using duplicate voice tags.
Avoid using “home” as a voice tag.
It is easier for the system to recognize a longer name.
For example, use “John Smith” instead of “John.”
Features
■ To delete a voice tag
1. Go to the Phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 286
2. Select Phone tab, then Edit Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, select Edit.
4. Select Voice Tag.
u From the pop-up menu, select Clear.
5. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Yes.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
299
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 300 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To delete a speed dial
1. Go to the Phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 286
2. Select Phone tab, then Edit Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, select Delete.
4. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Yes.
■ Making a Call
1Making a Call
Features
You can make calls by inputting any phone
number, or by using the imported
phonebook, call history, speed dial entries, or
redial.
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry, phonebook name,
or number can be dialed by voice from most screens.
Press the
button and say “Call” and the stored
voice tag name.
The maximum range between your phone and
vehicles is 30 feet (10 meters).
Once a call is connected, you can hear the voice of
the person you are calling through the audio
speakers.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
300
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 301 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using the imported
phonebook
1. Go to the Phone menu screen.
2 Phone menu screen P. 289
2. Select Phonebook.
3. Select a name.
u You can also search by letter. Select
Search.
u Use the keyboard on the touch screen for
entering letters.
4. Select a number.
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using the imported phonebook
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed
dial number using voice commands.
2 Limitations for Manual Operation P. 285
2 Speed Dial P. 298
Features
■ To make a call using a phone number
1. Go to the Phone menu screen.
2 Phone menu screen P. 289
2. Select Dial.
3. Select a number.
u Use the keyboard on the touch screen for
entering numbers.
4. Select
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using a phone number
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed
dial number using voice commands.
2 Limitations for Manual Operation P. 285
2 Speed Dial P. 298
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
301
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 302 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using redial
1. Go to the Phone menu screen.
2 Phone menu screen P. 289
1To make a call using redial
Press and hold the
button to redial the last
number dialed in your phone’s history.
2. Select Redial.
u Dialing starts automatically.
■ To make a call using the call history
Features
Call history is stored by All, Dialed,
Received, and Missed.
1. Go to the Phone menu screen.
2 Phone menu screen P. 289
1To make a call using the call history
The call history displays the last 20 dialed, received, or
missed calls.
(Appears only when a phone is connected to the
system.)
2. Select Call History.
3. Select All, Dialed, Received, or Missed.
4. Select a number.
u Dialing starts automatically.
■ To make a call using a speed dial entry
1. Go to the Phone menu screen.
2 Phone menu screen P. 289
2. Select Speed Dial.
3. Select a number.
u Dialing starts automatically.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
302
1To make a call using a speed dial entry
When a voice tag is stored, press the
call the number using the voice tag.
2 Speed Dial P. 298
button to
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by
voice from any screen.
Press the
button and follow the prompts.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 303 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Receiving a Call
1Receiving a Call
When there is an incoming call, an audible
notification sounds and the Incoming call
screen appears.
Press the
Press the
button to answer the call.
button to decline or end the call.
Call Waiting
Press the
button to put the current call on hold
to answer the incoming call.
Press the
button again to return to the current
call.
Select Ignore to ignore the incoming call if you do
not want to answer it.
Press the
button if you want to hang up the
current call.
You can select the icons on the touch screen instead
of the
and
buttons.
1Options During a Call
The available options appear on the screen during a call.
Mute: Mute your voice.
Mute Icon
u The mute icon appears when Mute is
selected. Select Mute again to turn it off.
Transfer: Transfer a call from the system to
your phone.
Touch Tones: Send numbers during a call.
This is useful when you call a menu-driven
phone system.
Touch Tones: Available on some phones.
Features
■ Options During a Call
You can select the icons on the touch screen.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
303
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 304 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Receiving a Text/E-mail Message
1Receiving a Text/E-mail Message
HFL can display newly received text or e-mail messages as well as 20 of the most
recently received messages on a linked cell phone. Each received message can be
read aloud and replied to using a fixed common phrase.
Features
1. A pop-up appears and notifies you of a new
text or e-mail message.
2. Select Read to listen to the message.
u The text or e-mail message is displayed.
The system automatically starts reading
out the message.
3. To discontinue the message read-out, select
Stop.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
304
The system does not display any received messages
while you are driving. You can only hear them read
aloud.
With some phones, you may be able to display up to
20 most recent text and e-mail messages.
State or local laws may limit your use of the HFL text/e-mail
message feature. Only use the text/e-mail message feature
when conditions allow you to do so safely.
When you receive a text or e-mail message for the
first time since the phone is paired to HFL, you are
asked to turn the New Message Notification
setting to On.
2 To turn on or off the text/e-mail notice
P. 295
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 305 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Selecting a Mail Account
1Selecting a Mail Account
If a paired phone has text or mail message accounts, you can select one of them to
be active and receive notifications.
1. Go to the Phone settings screen.
You can also select a mail account from the folder list
screen or the message list screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 286
2. Select Text/Email tab, then Select
Account.
u A pop-up menu appears on the screen.
3. Select Text Messages or an e-mail account
you want.
Features
Select
Account
You can only receive notifications from one text
message or mail account at a time.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
305
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 306 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Displaying Messages
Message List
1Displaying Messages
■ Displaying text messages
The
1. Go to the Phone menu screen.
If you delete a message on the phone, the message is
also deleted in the system. If you send a message
from the system, the message goes to your phone’s
outbox.
2 Phone menu screen P. 289
2. Select Text/Email.
u Select account if necessary.
3. Select a message.
u The text message is displayed. The
system automatically starts reading the
message aloud.
Text Message
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
306
icon appears next to an unread message.
To see the previous or next message, select
(previous) or
(next) on the message screen.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 307 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Folder List
■ Displaying e-mails
1. Go to the Phone menu screen.
2 Phone menu screen P. 289
Message List
2. Select Text/Email.
u Select Select Account if necessary.
3. Select a folder.
4. Select a message.
u The e-mail is displayed. The system
automatically starts reading the message
aloud.
Features
E-mail
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
307
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 308 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Read or Stop reading a message
1. Go to the text or e-mail message screen.
u The system automatically starts reading
the message aloud.
2 Displaying Messages P. 306
2. Select Stop to stop reading.
Select Read again to start reading the
message from the beginning.
■ Reply to a message
Features
1. Go to the text or e-mail message screen.
u The system automatically starts reading
the message aloud.
2 Displaying Messages P. 306
2. Select Reply.
3. Select the reply message.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
4. Select Send to send the message.
u Complete appears on the screen when
the reply message was successfully sent.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
308
1Reply to a message
The available fixed reply messages are as follows:
• Talk to you later, I’m driving.
• I’m on my way.
• I’m running late.
• OK
• Yes
• No
You cannot add, edit, or delete reply messages.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 309 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Making a call to a sender
1. Go to the text message screen.
2. Select Call.
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
309
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 310 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ In Case of Emergency
1In Case of Emergency
■ Automatic collision notification
If your vehicle’s airbags deploy or if the unit
detects that the vehicle is severely impacted,
your vehicle automatically will attempt to
connect to the HondaLink operator. If
connected, information about your vehicle, its
location, and its condition will be sent to the
operator; you also can speak to the operator
when connected.
Features
IMPORTANT: For vehicles equipped with HondaLink Assist, owner activation
constitutes authorization for Honda to collect information from your vehicle needed
to provide the service, and agreement to the Terms of Use at www.hondalink.com/
TermsAndConditions. In a crash, HondaLink Assist will attempt to notify emergency
services but NEITHER HONDA NOR ITS SERVICE PROVIDERS GUARANTEE THAT
SUCH NOTIFICATION WILL OCCUR.
Honda reserves the right to terminate HondaLink Assist services at any time or for
any reason, and in the future may not be able to provide services due to changes in,
or obsolescence of, technology integral to the service or changes in governmental
regulation.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
310
Your vehicle may not be able to connect to the
operator if the battery level is low, the line is
disconnected, or you do not have adequate cellular
coverage.
You cannot use this emergency services when:
• You travel outside the HondaLink service coverage
areas.
• There is a problem with the connecting devices,
such as the microphones, speakers, or the unit
itself.
You cannot operate other phone-related functions
using the screen while talking to the operator.
Select Hang Up to terminate the connection to your
vehicle.
1Automatic collision notification
If the unit fails to connect to the operator, it
repeatedly tries until it succeeds.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 311 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To enable notification
1To enable notification
1. Go to the Phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 286
2. Select Phone tab, then HondaLink Assist.
u A pop-up menu appears on the screen.
3. Select On or Off.
Setting options:
• On: Notification is available.
• Off: Disable the feature.
Features
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
311
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 312 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
312
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 313 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Driving
This chapter discusses driving, refueling, and information on items such as accessories.
Before Driving
Driving Preparation ................................... 314
Maximum Load Limit ................................ 317
Towing a Trailer
Towing Your Vehicle ................................. 320
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines............... 323
When Driving
Models without smart entry system
Starting the Engine ................................... 325
Models with smart entry system
Starting the Engine ................................... 328
Precautions While Driving ......................... 332
Continuously Variable Transmission * ......... 333
Continuously variable transmission models
without paddle shifters
Shifting..................................................... 334
* Not available on all models
Continuously variable transmission models
with paddle shifters
Shifting .......................................................... 336
Manual transmission models
Shifting .......................................................... 340
ECON Button * ................................................ 343
Cruise Control ................................................ 344
Forward Collision Warning (FCW) * ................. 347
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) * .................... 351
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability
Control (ESC), System .................................. 354
LaneWatchTM * ................................................ 356
Real Time AWD with Intelligent Control SystemTM* .... 358
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) ......... 359
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required
Federal Explanation ...................................... 361
Braking
Brake System........................................363
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)................369
Brake Assist System ..............................370
Parking Your Vehicle
When Stopped .....................................371
Multi-View Rear Camera.......................372
Refueling
Fuel Information ...................................374
How to Refuel ......................................375
Fuel Economy
Improving Fuel Economy.......................376
Accessories and Modifications
Accessories...........................................377
Modifications .......................................377
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
313
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 314 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Before Driving
Driving Preparation
Check the following items before you start driving.
■ Exterior Checks
1Exterior Checks
• Make sure there are no obstructions on the windows, door mirrors, exterior
lights, or other parts of the vehicle.
u Remove any frost, snow, or ice.
u Remove any snow on the roof, as this can slip down and obstruct your field of
vision while driving. If frozen solid, remove ice once it has softened.
u When removing ice from around the wheels, be sure not to damage the wheel
or wheel components.
• Make sure the hood is securely closed.
u If the hood opens while driving, your front view will be blocked.
• Make sure the tires are in good condition.
u Check air pressure, check for damage and excessive wear.
Driving
2 Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 411
• Make sure there are no people or objects behind or around the vehicle.
u There are blind spots from the inside.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
314
NOTICE
When doors are frozen shut, use warm water around
the door edges to melt any ice. Do not try to force
them open, as this can damage the rubber trim
around the doors. When done, wipe dry to avoid
further freezing.
Do not pour warm water into the key cylinder.
You will be unable to insert the key if the water
freezes in the hole.
Heat from the engine and exhaust can ignite
flammable materials left under the hood, causing a
fire. If you've parked your vehicle for an extended
period, inspect and remove any debris that may have
collected, such as dried grass and leaves that have
fallen or have been carried in for use as a nest by a
small animal. Also check under the hood for leftover
flammable materials after you or someone else has
performed maintenance on your vehicle.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 315 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBefore DrivinguDriving Preparation
■ Interior Checks
1Interior Checks
• Store or secure all items on board properly.
u Carrying too much cargo, or improperly storing it, can affect your vehicle’s
handling, stability, stopping distance, and tires, and make it unsafe.
The headlight aim is set by the factory, and does not
need to be adjusted. However, if you regularly carry
heavy items in the cargo area, have the aiming
readjusted at a dealer or by a qualified technician.
2 Maximum Load Limit P. 317
2 Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside P. 105
• Adjust your seating position properly.
u Adjust the head restraint, too.
Driving
• Do not pile items higher than the seat height.
u They can block your view and may be thrown forward in the event of sudden
braking.
• Do not place anything in the front seat footwells. Make sure to secure the floor
mat.
u An object or unsecured floor mat can interfere with your brake and accelerator
pedal operation while driving.
• If you have any animals on board, do not let them move around in the vehicle.
u They may interfere with driving and a crash could occur.
• Securely close and lock all doors and the tailgate.
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 140
2 Adjusting the Head Restraints P. 142
• Adjust the mirrors and steering wheel properly for your driving.
u Adjust them while sitting in the proper driving position.
2 Adjusting the Mirrors P. 138
2 Adjusting the Steering Wheel P. 137
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
315
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 316 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBefore DrivinguDriving Preparation
• Be sure items placed on the floor behind the front seats cannot roll under the
seats.
u They can interfere with the driver’s ability to operate the pedals, the operation
of the seats, or the operation of the sensors under the seats.
• Everyone in the vehicle must fasten their seat belt.
2 Fastening a Seat Belt P. 38
• Make sure that the indicators in the instrument panel come on when you start the
vehicle, and go off soon after.
u Always have a dealer check the vehicle if a problem is indicated.
2 Indicators P. 72
Driving
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
316
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 317 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBefore DrivinguMaximum Load Limit
Maximum Load Limit
The maximum load for your vehicle is 850 lbs (385 kg).
See Tire and Loading Information label attached to the driver’s doorjamb.
1Maximum Load Limit
3 WARNING
Overloading or improper loading
can affect handling and stability
and cause a crash in which you
can be hurt or killed.
Label Example
Follow all load limits and other
loading guidelines in this manual.
This figure includes the total weight of all occupants, cargo, and
accessories, and the tongue load if you are towing a trailer.
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit -
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR):
The maximum allowable weight of the vehicle axle.
2 Specifications P. 466
Driving
(1) Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and
cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs.” on your
vehicle’s placard.
(2) Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers
that will be riding in your vehicle.
(3) Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers
from XXX kg or XXX lbs.
(4) The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and
luggage load capacity. For example, if the “XXX” amount
equals 1,400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb. passengers in
your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load
capacity is 650 lbs.
(1,400 - 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs.)
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR):
The maximum allowable weight of the vehicle, all
occupants, all accessories, all cargo, and the tongue
load.
2 Specifications P. 466
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
317
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 318 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBefore DrivinguMaximum Load Limit
(5) Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being
loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the
available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in step 4.
(6) If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will
be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to
determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage
load capacity of your vehicle.
In addition, the total weight of the vehicle, all occupants,
accessories, cargo, and trailer tongue load must not exceed the
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight
Rating (GAWR). Both are on a label on the driver’s doorjamb.
Load Limits Example
Driving
Example1
Max Load
850 lbs
(385 kg)
Passenger Weight
150 lbs x 2 = 300 lbs
(68 kg x 2 = 136 kg)
Cargo Weight
550 lbs
(249 kg)
Max Load
850 lbs
(385 kg)
Passenger Weight
150 lbs x 5 = 750 lbs
(68 kg x 5 = 340 kg)
Cargo Weight
100 lbs
(45 kg)
Example2
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
318
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 319 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Towing a Trailer
Your vehicle is not designed to tow a trailer. Attempting to do so can void your
warranties.
Driving
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
319
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 320 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Your Vehicle
Towing Your Vehicle
1Towing Your Vehicle
Continuously variable transmission models
Your vehicle is not designed to be towed behind a motorhome. If your vehicle needs
to be towed in an emergency, refer to the emergency towing information.
Manual transmission models
Do not exceed 65 mph (100 km/h).
2 Emergency Towing P. 461
Consult your towing parts sales or rental agency if
any other items are recommended or required for
your towing situation.
Manual transmission models
Your vehicle can be towed behind a motorhome.
Manual transmission models
■ When Your Vehicle is Towed Behind a Motorhome
Driving
Perform the following procedure before towing your vehicle.
1. Shift to (N .
2. Release the parking brake.
3. Turn the ignition switch to ACCESSORY (q *1.
u Make sure the steering wheel does not lock.
4. Turn off all the electric devices. Do not use any accessory power sockets.
u This can prevent the battery from running down.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
320
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 321 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Your Vehicle
■ Extended towing
If you tow more than eight hours in one day, you should repeat the “before towing
your vehicle procedure” at least every eight hours.
You also need to perform the following procedure to prevent the battery from
running down.
Interior Fuse Box
1Towing Your Vehicle
Make sure to reinstall the fuses before you start
driving your vehicle.
Models without smart entry system
1. Remove the 20 A accessory power socket
and 7.5 A ACC fuses. These fuses are
located in the interior fuse box.
2 Interior Fuse Boxes P. 458
2. Remove the 10 A Back up fuse. This fuse is
located in the engine compartment fuse
box.
2 Engine Compartment Fuse Box P. 456
Engine Compartment Fuse Box
Driving
20 A Accessory
Power Socket Fuse
7.5 A ACC fuse
3. Store the fuses in a safe place so you do not
lose them.
u Make sure to reinstall the fuses before
you start driving your vehicle.
4. Shift to (N .
5. Turn the ignition switch to ACCESSORY
(q .
u Make sure the steering wheel does not
lock.
10 A Back Up Fuse
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
321
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 322 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Your Vehicle
Interior Fuse Box
Models with smart entry system
1. Remove the 20 A accessory power socket and 7.5 A ACC fuses. These fuses are located in the
interior fuse box.
2 Interior Fuse Boxes P. 458
2. Remove the 10 A Back up fuse. This fuse is located in the engine compartment fuse box.
2 Engine Compartment Fuse Box P. 456
20 A Accessory
Power Socket Fuse
7.5 A ACC fuse
Driving
Engine Compartment Fuse Box
3. Store the fuses in a safe place so you do not lose them.
u Make sure to reinstall the fuses before you start driving your vehicle.
4. Push the ENGINE START/STOP button without depressing the clutch pedal.
u The indicator on the ENGINE START/STOP button blinks.
5. Touch the center of the ENGINE START/STOP button with the H logo on the smart entry remote
while the indicator is blinking.
u The indicator stop blinking, then stays on.
6. Shift to (N .
7. Push the ENGINE START/STOP button once without depressing the clutch pedal.
u Make sure the steering wheel does not lock.
10 A Back Up Fuse
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
322
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 323 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
General Information
Your vehicle has been designed primarily for use on pavement, however, its higher
ground clearance allows you to occasionally travel on unpaved roads. It is not
designed for trail-blazing, or other challenging off-road activities.
If you decide to drive on unpaved roads, you will find that it requires somewhat
different driving skills and that your vehicle will handle somewhat differently than it
does on pavement. Pay attention to the precautions and tips in this section, and get
acquainted with your vehicle before leaving the pavement.
Important Safety Precautions
To avoid loss of control or rollover, be sure to follow all precautions and
recommendations:
• Be sure to store cargo properly and do not exceed your cargo load limits.
2 Maximum Load Limit P. 317
3 WARNING
Improperly operating this vehicle on or off
pavement can cause a crash or rollover in
which you and your passengers can be
seriously injured or killed.
• Follow all instructions and guidelines in
this owner’s manual.
• Keep your speed low, and don’t drive
faster than conditions permit.
Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result
in a crash or a rollover.
2 Important Handling Information P. 32
2 Precautions While Driving P. 332
Driving
• Whenever you drive, make sure you and your passengers always wear seat belts.
• Keep your speed low, and never go faster than the conditions allow.
• It’s up to you to continually assess the situation and drive within the limits.
1Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
323
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 324 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOff-Highway Driving GuidelinesuAvoiding Trouble
Avoiding Trouble
Driving
• Check Out Your Vehicle before you leave the pavement and make sure that all
scheduled maintenance has been completed. Pay special attention to the
condition of the tires, and check the tire pressures.
• Remember the route you choose presents limits (too steep or bumpy), you have
limits (driving skill and comfort), and your vehicle has limits (traction, stability, and
power). Failing to recognize these limits will likely put you and your passengers in
a hazardous situation.
• Accelerating and Braking should be done slowly and gradually. Trying to start
or stop too fast can cause a loss of traction and you could lose control.
• Avoiding Obstacles and Debris in the road reduces the likelihood of a rollover
or damage to your suspension or other components.
• Driving on Slopes increases your risk of a rollover, particularly if you attempt to
drive across a slope that is too steep. Going straight up or down a slope is usually
the safest. If you can’t clearly see all conditions or obstacles on a slope, walk it
before you drive it. If there is any doubt whether you can safely pass, don’t try it.
Find another route. If you get stuck when climbing, do not try to turn around.
Back down slowly following the same route you took up the hill.
• Crossing a Stream - Avoid driving through deep water. If you encounter water
in your route (a small stream or large puddle, for example), evaluate it carefully
before going ahead. Make sure it is shallow, flowing slowly, and has firm ground
underneath. If you are not sure of the depth or the ground, turn around and find
another route. Driving through deep water can also damage your vehicle. The
water can get into the transmission and differential, diluting the lubricant and
causing an eventual failure. It can also wash the grease out of the wheel bearings.
• If You Get Stuck, carefully go in the direction that you think will get you
unstuck. Do not spin the tires as this will only make things worse and could
damage the transmission. If you are unable to free yourself, your vehicle will need
to be towed. Front and rear tow hooks are provided for this purpose.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
324
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 325 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
When Driving
Models without smart entry system
Starting the Engine
1Starting the Engine
1. Make sure the parking brake is applied.
u The electric parking brake indicator
comes on for 15 seconds when you pull
up to electric parking brake switch.
Electric Parking Brake Switch
Brake Pedal
Manual transmission models
2. Check that the shift lever is in (N . Then
depress the brake pedal with your right
foot, and the clutch pedal with your left
foot.
u The clutch pedal must be fully depressed
to start the engine.
The engine is harder to start in cold weather and in
thinner air found at altitudes above 8,000 feet (2,400
meters).
When starting the engine in cold weather, turn off all
electrical accessories such as the lights, heating and
cooling system */climate control system *, and rear
defogger in order to reduce battery drain.
If you live in a region where winter is extremely cold,
an engine block heater will improve starting and
warming of the engine. If temperatures consistently
below -22°F (-30°C) are expected, the coolant
mixture should be changed to a higher concentration
to prevent freezing. Consult a dealer for details.
Driving
Clutch Pedal
Continuously variable transmission models
2. Check that the shift lever is in (P , then
depress the brake pedal.
u Although it is possible to start the vehicle
in (N , it is safer to start it in (P .
Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal when
starting the engine.
If the exhaust system sounds abnormal or you can
smell exhaust gas inside the vehicle, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer. There may be a problem with
the engine or exhaust system.
Brake Pedal
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
325
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 326 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
3. Turn the ignition switch to START (e
without depressing the accelerator pedal.
1Starting the Engine
Do not hold the key in START (e for more than 15
seconds.
• If the engine does not start right away, wait for at
least 10 seconds before trying again.
• If the engine starts, but then immediately stops,
wait at least 10 seconds before repeating step 3
while gently depressing the accelerator pedal.
Release the accelerator pedal once the engine
starts.
The immobilizer system protects your vehicle from
theft. If an improperly coded device is used, the
engine’s fuel system is disabled.
2 Immobilizer System P. 116
Driving
■ Starting to Drive
1Starting to Drive
Continuously variable transmission models
1. Keeping your right foot on the brake pedal, put the shift lever in (D . Select (R
when reversing.
2. With the parking brake applied, release the brake pedal and gently depress the
accelerator pedal.
u Make sure the electric parking brake indicator goes off.
2 Parking Brake P. 363
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
326
You can also release the parking brake by pressing
the electric parking brake switch while depressing the
brake pedal.
When facing downhill, you can start your vehicle
more smoothly by manually releasing it with the
electric parking brake switch than by releasing it with
the accelerator pedal.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 327 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
■ Hill start assist system
Hill start assist keeps the brake engaged briefly to help prevent the vehicle from
rolling on inclines as you move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator.
Manual transmission models
Depress the clutch pedal, and shift to one of the forward gears when facing uphill,
or (R when facing downhill, then release the brake pedal.
1Hill start assist system
Hill start assist may not prevent the vehicle from
rolling downhill on a very steep or slippery slope, and
does not operate on small inclines.
Hill start assist is not a replacement for the parking
brake.
Continuously variable transmission models
Move the shift lever to (D , (S , or (L when facing uphill, or (R when facing
downhill, then release the brake pedal.
Driving
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
327
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 328 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
Models with smart entry system
Starting the Engine
1Starting the Engine
1. Make sure the parking brake is applied.
u The electric parking brake indicator
comes on for 15 seconds when you pull
up to electric parking brake switch.
Electric Parking Brake Switch
Brake Pedal
Continuously variable transmission models
2. Check that the shift lever is in (P , then
depress the brake pedal.
u Although it is possible to start the vehicle
in (N , it is safer to start it in (P .
Driving
Clutch Pedal
Manual transmission models
2. Check that the shift lever is in (N . Then
depress the brake pedal with your right
foot, and the clutch pedal with your left
foot.
u The clutch pedal must be fully depressed
to start the engine.
Brake Pedal
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
328
Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal when
starting the engine.
The engine is harder to start in cold weather and in
thinner air found at altitudes above 8,000 feet (2,400
meters).
When starting the engine in cold weather, turn off all
electrical accessories such as the lights, climate
control system, and rear defogger in order to reduce
battery drain.
If you live in a region where winter is extremely cold,
an engine block heater will improve starting and
warming of the engine. If temperatures consistently
below -22°F (-30°C) are expected, the coolant
mixture should be changed to a higher concentration
to prevent freezing. Consult a dealer for details.
If the exhaust system sounds abnormal or you can
smell exhaust gas inside the vehicle, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer. There may be a problem with
the engine or exhaust system.
The immobilizer system protects your vehicle from
theft.If an improperly coded device is used, the
engine’s fuel system is disabled.
2 Immobilizer System P. 116
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 329 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
3. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button
without depressing the accelerator pedal.
ENGINE
START
STOP
1Starting the Engine
Bring the smart entry remote close to the ENGINE
START/STOP button if the battery in the smart entry
remote is weak.
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
P. 444
The engine may not start if the smart entry remote is
subjected to strong radio waves.
Do not hold the ENGINE START/STOP button to
start the engine.
If the engine does not start, wait at least 10 seconds
before trying again.
Driving
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
329
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 330 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
■ Stopping the Engine
You can turn the engine off when the vehicle is completely stopped.
Continuously variable transmission models
1. Shift to (P .
2. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button.
Manual transmission models
• If the shift lever is in (N , press the ENGINE START/STOP button.
• If the shift lever is in any gear other than (N , depress the clutch pedal, then press
the ENGINE START/STOP button.
■ Starting to Drive
1Starting to Drive
Continuously variable transmission models
Driving
1. Keeping your right foot on the brake pedal, put the shift lever in (D . Select (R
when reversing.
2. With the parking brake applied, release the brake pedal and gently depress the
accelerator pedal.
u Make sure the electric parking brake indicator goes off.
2 Parking Brake P. 363
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
330
You can also release the parking brake by pressing
the electric parking brake switch while depressing the
brake pedal.
When facing downhill, you can start your vehicle
more smoothly by manually releasing it with the
electric parking brake switch than by releasing it with
the accelerator pedal.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 331 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
■ Hill start assist system
Hill start assist keeps the brake engaged briefly to help prevent the vehicle from
rolling on inclines as you move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator.
Manual transmission models
Depress the clutch pedal, and shift to one of the forward gears when facing uphill,
or (R when facing downhill, then release the brake pedal.
1Hill start assist system
Hill start assist may not prevent the vehicle from
rolling downhill on a very steep or slippery slope, and
does not operate on small inclines.
Hill start assist is not a replacement for the parking
brake.
Continuously variable transmission models
Move the shift lever to (D or (S when facing uphill, or (R when facing downhill,
then release the brake pedal.
Driving
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
331
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 332 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguPrecautions While Driving
Precautions While Driving
■ Driving Guidelines for Your Utility Vehicle
1Precautions While Driving
Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehicles.
To prevent rollovers or loss of control:
• Take corners at slower speeds than you would with a passenger vehicle.
• Avoid sharp turns and abrupt maneuvers whenever possible.
• Do not modify your vehicle in any way that you would raise the center of gravity.
• Never carry more than 165 lbs (75 kg) of cargo on the roof rack (Honda
accessory).
■ In Rain
Avoid driving in deep water and on flooded roads. This can damage the engine or
driveline, or cause electrical component failure.
NOTICE
Do not operate the shift lever while pressing the
accelerator pedal. You could damage the transmission.
NOTICE
If you repeatedly turn the steering wheel at an
extremely low speed, or hold the steering wheel on
the full left or right position for a while, the electric
power steering (EPS) system heats up. The system
goes into a protective mode, and limits its
performance. The steering wheel becomes harder
and harder to operate. Once the system cools down,
the EPS system is restored. Repeated operation under
these conditions can eventually damage the system.
Driving
If the ignition switch is turned to ACCESSORY (q or
LOCK (0 *1 while driving, the engine will shut down
and all steering and brake power assist functions will
stop, making it difficult to control the vehicle.
Do not put the shift lever in (N , as you will lose
engine braking (and acceleration) performance.
During the first 600 miles (1,000 km) of operation,
avoid sudden acceleration or full throttle operation so
as to not damage the engine or powertrain.
Avoid hard braking for the first 200 miles (300 km).
You should also follow this when the brake pads are
replaced.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE
START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
332
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 333 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguContinuously Variable Transmission *
■ Other Precautions
1Driving Guidelines for Your Utility Vehicle
If there is a strong impact with something under the vehicle, stop in a safe location.
Check the underside of the vehicle for damage or any fluid leaks.
Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result
in a crash or a rollover.
2 Important Handling Information P. 32
2 Precautions While Driving P. 332
Continuously Variable Transmission *
■ Creeping
The engine runs at a higher idle speed and creeping increases.
Keep the brake pedal firmly depressed when stopped.
■ Kickdown
* Not available on all models
Driving
Quickly depressing the accelerator pedal while driving uphill may cause the
transmission to drop to a lower gear, unexpectedly increasing vehicle speed. Depress
the accelerator pedal carefully, especially on slippery roads and curves.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
333
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 334 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
Continuously variable transmission models without paddle shifters
Shifting
1Shifting
Change the shift position in accordance with your driving needs.
■ Shift lever positions
Park
Used when parking or starting the
engine
Reverse
Used when reversing
Neutral
Used when idling
Driving
Drive
Used for normal driving
Release Button
Drive (S)
Used:
● For better acceleration
● To increase engine braking
● When going up or down hills
Low
Used to further increase engine
braking
● Used when going up or down hills
●
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
334
You cannot turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 and
remove the key unless the shift lever is in (P .
The vehicle may move forward very slightly even in
(N while the engine is cold.
Depress the brake pedal firmly and, when necessary,
apply the parking brake.
When shifting positions in extremely low
temperatures (-22°F/-30°C), there may be a short
delay before the shift position is displayed. Always
confirm you are in the correct shift position before
driving.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 335 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Shift Lever Operation
1Shift Lever Operation
NOTICE
Tachometer’s red zone
When you change the shift lever from (D to (R and
vice versa, come to a complete stop and keep the
brake pedal depressed.
Operating the shift lever before the vehicle has come
to a complete standstill can damage the transmission.
Use the shift lever position indicator to check the
lever position before pulling away.
Shift Lever Position Indicator
Shift without pressing the shift lever
release button.
Press the shift lever release button
and shift.
The fuel supply may be cut off if you drive at engine
speeds in or over the tachometer red zone (engine
speed limit). If this happens, you may experience a
slight jolt.
Driving
Depress the brake pedal and press
the shift lever release button to shift.
If the transmission indicator blinks when driving, in
any shift position, there is a problem with the
transmission.
Avoid sudden acceleration and have the transmission
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
It may not be possible to operate the shift lever if the
brake pedal is applied while the shift lever release
button is held down.
Depress the brake pedal first.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
335
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 336 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
Continuously variable transmission models with paddle shifters
Shifting
1Shifting
Change the shift position in accordance with your driving needs.
■ Shift lever positions
Park
Used when parking or starting the
engine
Reverse
Used when reversing
Neutral
Used when idling
Driving
Drive
Used:
● For normal driving
● When temporarily driving in the
7-speed manual shift mode
Release Button
Drive (S)
Used for:
● For better acceleration
● To increase engine braking
● When going up or down hills
● When driving in the 7-speed manual
shift mode
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
336
You cannot change the power mode from ON to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) unless the shift lever is in (P .
The vehicle may move forward very slightly even in
(N while the engine is cold.
Depress the brake pedal firmly and, when necessary,
apply the parking brake.
When shifting positions in extremely low
temperatures (-22°F/-30°C), there may be a short
delay before the shift position is displayed. Always
confirm you are in the correct shift position before
driving.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 337 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Shift Lever Operation
1Shift Lever Operation
NOTICE
When you change the shift lever from (D to (R and
vice versa, come to a complete stop and keep the
brake pedal depressed.
Operating the shift lever before the vehicle has come
to a complete standstill can damage the transmission.
Tachometer’s red zone
Use the shift lever position indicator to check the
lever position before pulling away.
M (7-Speed Manual Shift Mode)
Indicator/Shift Indicator
Shift Lever Position Indicator
Shift without pressing the shift lever
release button.
Press the shift lever release button
and shift.
The fuel supply may be cut off if you drive at engine
speeds in or over the tachometer red zone (engine
speed limit). If this happens, you may experience a
slight jolt.
Driving
Depress the brake pedal and press
the shift lever release button to shift.
If the transmission indicator blinks when driving, in
any shift position, there is a problem with the
transmission.
Avoid sudden acceleration and have the transmission
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
It may not be possible to operate the shift lever if the
brake pedal is applied while the shift lever release
button is held down.
Depress the brake pedal first.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
337
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 338 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ 7-Speed Manual Shift Mode
17-Speed Manual Shift Mode
Use the paddle shifters to change between 1st and 7th speeds without removing
your hands from the steering wheel. The transmission switches to the 7-speed
manual shift mode when you pull a paddle shifter while driving. This mode is useful
when engine braking is needed.
■ When the shift lever is in (D :
The shift mode goes into the 7-speed manual shift mode temporarily, and the
number is displayed in the shift indicator.
The 7-speed manual shift mode is canceled automatically if you drive at constant
speed or accelerate, and the number in the shift indicator goes off.
You can cancel this mode by pulling the
paddle shifter for a few seconds.
The 7-speed manual shift mode is especially useful when reducing the vehicle speed
temporarily before making a turn.
Driving
■ When the shift lever is in (S :
The shift mode goes into the 7-speed manual shift mode. The M indicator and the
speed number are displayed in the shift indicator. As the vehicle speed slows down,
the transmission automatically shifts down accordingly. When the vehicle comes to
a stop, it automatically shifts down into 1st.
If the vehicle speed increases and the engine speed reaches near the tachometer’s
red zone, the transmission automatically shifts up.
You can only pull away in 1st speed.
When canceling the 7-speed manual shift mode, move the shift lever from (S to
(D . When the 7-speed manual shift mode is canceled, the M indicator and shift
indicator go off.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
338
To improve fuel economy, the transmission may shift
up to a higher speed than the seventh under certain
circumstances. In this case, the number in the shift
indicator remains as 7.
In the 7-speed manual shift mode, the transmission
shifts up or down by operating either paddle shifter
under the following conditions:
Shift Up: The engine speed reaches the lowest
threshold of the higher speed position.
Shift Down: The engine speed reaches the highest
threshold of the lower speed position.
When the engine speed reaches near the
tachometer’s red zone, the transmission shifts up
automatically.
When the engine speed reaches the lowest threshold
of the selected speed position, the transmission shifts
down automatically.
Operating the paddle shifters on slippery surfaces
may cause the tires to lock up. In this case, the 7speed manual shift mode is canceled and goes back
to the normal D driving mode.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 339 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ 7-Speed Manual Shift Mode Operation
Paddle Shifter
(Shift down)
17-Speed Manual Shift Mode Operation
Paddle Shifter
(Shift up)
Each paddle shift operation makes a single speed
change.
To change continuously, release the paddle shifter
before pulling it again for the next speed.
Recommended Shift Points
Use this table as a guideline for efficient fuel
economy and effective emission control.
Downshifting when pulling
the
paddle shifter
(Changes to lower speed
number)
Upshifting when pulling
the
paddle shifter
(Changes to higher speed
number)
Normal Acceleration
15 mph (24 km/h)
25 mph (40 km/h)
40 mph (64 km/h)
47 mph (76 km/h)
52 mph (84 km/h)
57 mph (92 km/h)
The shift indicator blinks when you cannot shift up or
down. It indicates that your vehicle speed is not in its
allowable shifting range.
Slightly accelerate to shift up and decelerate to shift
down while the indicator is blinking.
Driving
Shift Up
1 to 2
2 to 3
3 to 4
4 to 5
5 to 6
6 to 7
The shift indicator may also blink when you cannot
shift down while driving in low speed. This prevents
the transmission from being damaged.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
339
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 340 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
Manual transmission models
Shifting
1Shifting
■ Shift Lever Operation
NOTICE
Fully depress the clutch pedal to operate the shift lever and change gears, then
slowly release the pedal.
Depress the clutch pedal, and pause for a few seconds before shifting into (R , or
shift into one of the forward gears for a moment. This stops the gears so they do not
“grind.”
Driving
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
340
Do not shift to (R before the vehicle comes to a
complete stop.
Shifting to (R before stopping can damage the
transmission.
NOTICE
Before downshifting, make sure the engine will not
go into the tachometer’s red zone. Should this occur,
it can severely damage your engine.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 341 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
When you are not shifting, do not rest your
foot on the clutch pedal. This can cause your
clutch to wear out faster.
1Shifting
Recommended Shift Points
Driving in the highest gear that allows the engine to
run and accelerate smoothly helps to optimize fuel
economy and effective emissions control. The
following shift points are recommended:
Shift Up
1st to 2nd
2nd to 3rd
3rd to 4th
4th to 5th
5th to 6th
Normal Acceleration
16 mph (25 km/h)
26 mph (42 km/h)
35 mph (56 km/h)
41 mph (66 km/h)
43 mph (69 km/h)
Driving
If you exceed the maximum speed for the gear you
are in, the engine speed will enter into the
tachometer’s red zone. When this happens, you may
experience a slight jolt.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
341
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 342 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Reverse Lockout
The manual transmission has a lockout mechanism that stops you from accidentally
shifting into (R from a forward gear while the vehicle is moving above a certain
speed.
If you cannot shift to (R when the vehicle is stopped, do the following:
1. Depress the clutch pedal, move the shift
lever all the way to the left, and shift to (R .
2. If you still cannot shift into (R , apply the
parking brake, and turn the ignition switch
to ACCESSORY (q or LOCK (0 *1.
3. Depress the clutch pedal and shift into (R .
4. Keep depressing the clutch pedal and start
the engine.
Driving
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if you
have to go through this procedure repeatedly.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
342
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 343 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguECON Button *
ECON Button *
The ECON button turns the ECON mode on
and off. The ECON mode helps you improve
your fuel economy by adjusting the
performance of the engine, transmission,
heating and cooling system */climate control
system *, and cruise control.
1ECON Button *
Models with climate control system
While in ECON mode, the climate control system has
greater temperature fluctuations.
Driving
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
343
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 344 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control
Cruise Control
Maintains a constant vehicle speed without having to keep your foot on the
accelerator. Use cruise control on freeways or open roads where you can travel at a
constant speed with little acceleration or deceleration.
Desired speed in a range above
roughly 25 mph (40 km/h) ~
3 WARNING
Improper use of the cruise control can lead
to a crash.
When to use
■ Vehicle speed for cruise control:
1Cruise Control
Always keep sufficient distance
between you and the vehicle in
front of you.
Use the cruise control only when traveling
on open highways in good weather.
Continuously variable transmission models
■ Shift positions for cruise control:
It may not be possible to maintain a constant speed
when driving uphill or downhill.
In (D or (S
How to use
CRUISE MAIN is on in
the instrument panel.
Driving
Cruise control is ready to
use.
When not using cruise control:
Turn off cruise control by pressing the CRUISE
button.
Models with ECON button
While in ECON mode, it may take relatively more time
to accelerate to maintain the set speed.
■ Press the CRUISE
button on the
steering wheel.
Manual transmission models
When the engine speed slows down, try to
downshift.
You can maintain the set speed if you change gear
within five seconds.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
344
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 345 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control
■ To Set the Vehicle Speed
-/SET Button
On
On
Press and release
On when cruise control begins
Driving
Take your foot off the pedal and press the -/SET button when you reach the desired
speed.
The moment you release the -/SET button, the set speed is fixed, and cruise control
begins. The CRUISE CONTROL indicator comes on.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
345
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 346 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control
■ To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
1To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
Increase or decrease the vehicle speed using the RES/+ or -/SET buttons on the
steering wheel.
You can set the vehicle speed using the -/SET button
on the steering wheel when adjusting the speed with
the accelerator and brake pedals.
To increase speed
To decrease speed
Driving
• Each time you press the button, the vehicle speed is increased or decreased by
about 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
• If you keep the button pressed, the vehicle speed increases or decreases until you
release it. This speed is then set.
■ To Cancel
CRUISE Button
To cancel cruise control, do any of the following:
• Press the CANCEL button.
• Press the CRUISE button.
• Depress the brake pedal.
Manual transmission models
CANCEL
Button
• Depress the clutch pedal for five seconds or
more.
The CRUISE CONTROL Inindicator
goes off.
f
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
346
1To Cancel
Resuming the prior set speed:
After cruise control has been canceled, you can still
resume the prior set speed by pressing the RES/+
button while driving at a speed of at least 25 mph (40
km/h) or more.
You cannot set or resume in the following situations:
• When vehicle speed is less than 25 mph (40 km/h)
• When the CRUISE button is turned off
At vehicle speeds of 22 mph (35 km/h) or less, cruise
control is canceled automatically.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 347 ページ
2015年7月6日
月曜日
午後12時29分
uuWhen DrivinguForward Collision Warning (FCW) *
Canadian models
Forward Collision Warning (FCW) *
1Forward Collision Warning (FCW) *
Alerts you when it determines there is a possibility of your vehicle colliding with the
vehicle detected in front of yours.
If the system determines a collision is possible, it gives both visual and audible alerts.
u Take appropriate action to prevent a collision (apply the brakes, change lanes,
etc.).
■ How the system works
The system may give warnings of potential collisions when your vehicle speed is
above 10 mph (15 km/h).
Important Safety Reminder
FCW cannot detect all objects ahead and may not
detect a given object; accuracy of the system will vary
based on weather, speed and other factors. FCW
does not include a braking function. It is always your
responsibility to safely operate the vehicle and avoid
collisions.
You can change the Forward Collision Warning
Distance setting or turn the system on and off.
2 To change vehicle distance and to turn the
system on and off P. 349
You can set Long, Normal or Short for when warnings start:
The camera is shared with Lane Departure Warning
(LDW).
2 LDW Camera P. 352
LONG
NORMAL
Driving
SHORT
Your Vehicle
* Not available on all models
Vehicle Ahead
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
347
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 348 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguForward Collision Warning (FCW) *
1Forward Collision Warning (FCW) *
The camera is located behind
the rearview mirror.
Beep
The beeper sounds and
the FCW indicator
blinks until a possible
collision is avoided.
Driving
348
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Never apply a film or attach any objects to the
windshield that could obstruct the FCW camera’s
field of vision.
Scratches, nicks, and other damage to the windshield
within the FCW camera’s field of vision can cause the
system to operate abnormally. If this occurs, we
recommend that you replace the windshield with a
genuine Honda replacement windshield. Making
even minor repairs within the camera’s field of vision
or installing an aftermarket replacement windshield
may also cause the system to operate abnormally.
After replacing the windshield, have a dealer
recalibrate the camera. Proper calibration of the FCW
camera is necessary for the system to operate
properly.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 349 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguForward Collision Warning (FCW) *
■ To change vehicle distance and to turn the system on and off
Press the
(FCW) button to change FCW
range.
Each time you press the button, the warning
distance (the distance behind a vehicle
detected ahead of you) setting cycles through
FCW LONG, FCW NORMAL, and FCW
SHORT warning distance.
2 Information Display Warning and
Information Messages P. 85
To turn the system on and off, press and hold
the button until you hear a beep.
Once the conditions that caused FCW to shut off improve or are addressed (e.g.,
cleaning), the system comes back on.
1Automatic shutoff
To help reduce the likelihood that high interior
temperatures will cause the camera system to shut
off, when parking, find a shady area or face the front
of the vehicle away from the sun. If you use a
reflective sun shade, do not allow it to cover the
camera housing. Covering the camera can
concentrate heat on the camera.
Driving
■ Automatic shutoff
FCW may automatically shut itself off and the FCW indicator comes and stays on
when:
• The temperature inside the system is high.
• The windshield is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
If the CAMERA HOT message appears:
• Use the climate control system to cool down the
interior and, if necessary, the defroster mode when
windows are fogged.
• Start driving the vehicle to lower the windshield
temperature, which cools down the area around
the FCW system.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
349
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 350 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguForward Collision Warning (FCW) *
■ FCW Limitations
FCW may not activate or may not detect a vehicle in front of your vehicle, and may activate even when you are aware of a vehicle ahead
of you, or when there is no vehicle ahead under the following conditions.
Condition
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
Driving
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
The distance between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead of you is too short.
A vehicle cuts in front of you at a slow speed, and it brakes suddenly.
A vehicle suddenly crosses in front of you.
When either your vehicle or the vehicle ahead of you accelerates rapidly.
The vehicle ahead of you is a motorcycle, a small vehicle, or a unique vehicle such as a tractor.
When you drive off-road or on a mountain road, or curved and winding road for an extended period that makes it difficult for the camera to properly
detect a vehicle in front of you.
When there are pedestrians or animals in front of your vehicle.
When you drive in bad weather (rain, fog, etc.).
A heavy load in the rear or modifications to the suspension tilts your vehicle.
An abnormal tire condition is detected (wrong tire size, flat tire, etc.).
When the windshield is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
When the temperature inside the system is high.
A sudden change between light and dark such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
You drive into the sunlight (e.g. at dawn or dusk).
When the windshield is dirty or cloudy.
When streetlights are perceived as the taillight of a vehicle in front of yours.
When driving at night, the vehicle ahead of you is running with either taillight bulb burned out.
When you drive in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
350
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 351 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguLane Departure Warning (LDW) *
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) *
Alerts you when the system determines it is possible of your vehicle unintentionally
crossing over detected left or right side lane markings.
■ How the System Works
If your vehicle is getting too close to detected
left or right side lane markings without a turn
signal activated, LDW will give audible and
visual alerts.
The beeper sounds and the LDW indicator
blinks, letting you know that you need to take
appropriate action.
1Lane Departure Warning (LDW) *
Important Safety Reminder
Like all assistance systems, LDW has limitations.
Over-reliance on LDW may result in a collision. It is
always your responsibility to keep the vehicle within
your driving lane.
LDW only alerts you when lane drift is detected
without a turn signal in use. LDW may not detect all
lane markings or lane departures; accuracy will vary
based on weather, speed and lane marker condition.
It is always your responsibility to safely operate the
vehicle and avoid collisions.
Driving
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
351
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 352 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguLane Departure Warning (LDW) *
■ How the System Activates
1How the System Activates
The system begins to search for lane markings when all the following conditions are
met:
• The vehicle is traveling between at 45-90 mph (72-145 km/h).
• The vehicle is on a straight or slightly curved road.
• The turn signals are off.
• The brake pedal is not pressed.
■ LDW Camera
The camera is located behind the rearview
mirror.
LDW Camera
Driving
■ LDW On and Off
Indicator
LDW Button
352
Press the LDW button to turn the system on
and off.
u The indicator in the button comes on
when the system is on.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
LDW may automatically shut off and the LDW
indicator comes and stays on.
2 Indicators P. 84
1LDW Camera
Never apply a film or attach any objects to the
windshield that could obstruct the LDW camera’s
field of vision.
Scratches, nicks, and other damage to the windshield
within the LDW camera’s field of vision can cause the
system to operate abnormally. If this occurs, we
recommend that you replace the windshield with a
genuine Honda replacement windshield. Making
even minor repairs within the camera’s field of vision
or installing an aftermarket replacement windshield
may also cause the system to operate abnormally.
After replacing the windshield, have a dealer
recalibrate the camera. Proper calibration of the LDW
camera is necessary for the system to operate
properly.
To help reduce the likelihood that high interior
temperatures will cause the camera system to shut
off, when parking, find a shady area or face the front
of the vehicle away from the sun. Also, do not use a
reflective sunshade that can concentrate heat on the
camera.
If the CAMERA HOT message appears:
• Use the climate control system to cool down the
interior and, if necessary, the defroster mode when
windows are fogged.
• Start driving the vehicle to lower the windshield
temperature, which cools down the area around
the LDW system.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 353 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguLane Departure Warning (LDW) *
■ LDW Limitations
LDW may not activate or may not recognize lanes, and may activate even when
keeping in the middle of a lane under the following conditions.
Condition
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
Driving
●
When you drive in bad weather (rain, fog, etc.).
A heavy load in the rear or modifications to the suspension tilts your vehicle.
An abnormal tire condition is detected (wrong tire size, flat tire, etc.).
When the windshield is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
When the temperature inside the system is high.
A sudden change between light and dark such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
You drive into the sunlight (e.g. at dawn or dusk).
When the windshield is dirty or cloudy.
When you drive in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
When you drive on a wet road surface following another vehicle.
u The camera may perceive the tire tracks in the water as lane lines.
When there is snow or wheel tracks on the side of the road.
When the road has many repaired areas or an erased lane line.
When the vehicle is running over painted signs or crosswalk markings.
When you drive in a lane with worn-out lane markups.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
353
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 354 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguVehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic
Stability Control (ESC), System
Helps to stabilize the vehicle during cornering if the vehicle turns more or less than
what was intended. It also assists in maintaining traction on slippery surfaces. It does
so by regulating engine output and selectively applying the brakes.
■ VSA® Operation
VSA® System
Indicator
When VSA® activates, you may notice that the
engine does not respond to the accelerator.
You may also notice some noise from the
hydraulic system. You will also see the
indicator blink.
VSA® may not function properly if tire type and size
are mixed. Make sure to use the same size and type
of tire, and the air pressures as specified.
When the VSA® indicator comes on and stays on
while driving, there may be a problem with the
system. While this may not interfere with normal
driving, have your vehicle checked by a dealer
immediately.
Driving
VSA® cannot enhance stability in all driving situations
and does not control the entire braking system. You
still need to drive and corner at speeds appropriate
for the conditions and always leave a sufficient
margin of safety.
The main function of the VSA® system is generally
known as Electronic Stability Control (ESC). The
system also includes a traction control function.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
354
1Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control
(ESC), System
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 355 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguVehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System
■ VSA® OFF Button
VSA® OFF Indicator
This button is on the driver side control panel.
To partially turn the VSA features on and off,
press and hold it until you hear a beep.
The traction control stops fully functioning,
allows the wheels to spin more freely at low
speed. The VSA® OFF indicator will also come
on.
To turn it on again, press the
button until you hear a beep.
(VSA® OFF)
With the
button pressed, your vehicle will have
normal braking and cornering ability, but VSA®
traction and stability enhancement becomes less
effective.
In certain unusual conditions when your vehicle gets
stuck in shallow mud or fresh snow, it may be easier
to free it with the VSA® temporarily switched off.
When the
button is pressed, the traction control
function becomes less effective. This allows for the
wheels to spin more freely at low speed. You should
only attempt to free your vehicle with the VSA® off if
you are not able to free it when the VSA® is on.
Immediately after freeing your vehicle, be sure to
switch VSA® on again. We do not recommend driving
your vehicle with the VSA® system switched off.
Driving
VSA® is turned on every time you start the
engine, even if you turned it off the last time
you drove the vehicle.
1Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control
(ESC), System
You may hear a motor sound coming from the
engine compartment while system checks are being
performed immediately after starting the engine or
while driving. This is normal.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
355
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 356 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguLaneWatchTM *
LaneWatchTM *
Is an assistance system that allows you to check the passenger side rear areas
displayed on the audio/information screen when the turn signal is activated to the
passenger’s side. A camera in the passenger side door mirror monitors these areas
and allows you to check for vehicles, in addition to your visual check and use of the
passenger door mirror. You can also keep the system on for your convenience while
driving.
The system activates when you:
Move the turn
signal lever to the
passenger side.
The passenger side view
display appears on the
audio/information
screen.
Press the
LaneWatch
button.
Driving
Press the LaneWatch
button again.
Audio/Information Screen
* Not available on all models
Failure to visually confirm that it is safe to
change lanes before doing so may result in
a crash and serious injury or death.
Do not rely only on LaneWatch while
driving.
Always look in your mirrors, to either side
of your vehicle, and behind you for other
vehicles before changing lanes.
The LaneWatch function can be affected by weather,
lighting (including headlights and low sun angle),
ambient darkness, camera condition, and loading.
Camera
356
3 WARNING
Important Safety Reminder
Like all assistance systems, LaneWatch has
limitations. Over reliance on LaneWatch may result in
a collision.
The system deactivates when you:
Pull the turn signal
lever back.
1LaneWatchTM *
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
The LaneWatch may not provide the intended display
of traffic to the side and rear under the following
conditions:
• Your vehicle’s suspension has been altered,
changing the height of the vehicle.
• Your tires are over or under inflated.
• Your tires or wheels are of varied size or
construction.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 357 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguLaneWatchTM *
■ Customizing the LaneWatch settings
1LaneWatchTM *
You can customize the following items using the audio/information screen.
• Show with Turn Signal: Selects whether LaneWatch monitor comes on when
you operate the turn signal light lever.
• Display Time after Turn Signal Off: Changes the length of time the
LaneWatch display stays on after you pull the turn signal lever back.
• Reference Line: Selects whether the reference lines appear on the LaneWatch
monitor.
• Next Maneuver Pop up *: Selects whether a turn direction screen of the
navigation system interrupts the LaneWatch display.
• Display: Adjusts display settings.
2 Customized Features P. 238
■ Reference Lines
LaneWatch display does not come on when the shift
lever is in (R .
For proper LaneWatch operation:
• The camera is located in the passenger side door
mirror. Always keep this area clean. If the camera lens
is covered with dirt or moisture, use a soft, moist cloth
to keep the lens clean and free of debris.
• Do not cover the camera lens with labels or stickers
of any kind.
• Do not touch the camera lens.
1Reference Lines
The area around the reference line 1 (red) is very close to
your vehicle. As always, make sure to visually confirm
the safety of a lane change before changing lanes.
Driving
Three lines that appear on the screen can give
an idea of how far the vehicles or objects on
the screen are from your vehicle, respectively.
If an object is near line 1 (in red), it indicates
that it is close to your vehicle whereas an
object near line 3 farther away.
The LaneWatch camera view is restricted. Its unique
lens makes objects on the screen look slightly
different from what they are.
The distance between your vehicle and lines 1, 2 and
3 on the screen vary depending on road conditions
and vehicle loading. For example, the reference lines
on the screen may seem to appear closer than the
actual distances when the rear of your vehicle is more
heavily loaded.
Consult a dealer if:
• The passenger side door mirror, or area around it is
severely impacted, resulting in changing the
camera angle.
• The LaneWatch display does not come on at all.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
357
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 358 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguReal Time AWD with Intelligent Control SystemTM *
Real Time AWD with Intelligent Control SystemTM*
Your vehicle is equipped with the AWD system. When the system senses a loss of
front wheel traction, it automatically transfers some power to the rear wheels. This
allows you to utilize all available traction and may increase mobility.
You still need to exercise the same care when accelerating, steering, and braking
that you would in a two wheel drive vehicle.
If you excessively spin all four wheels and overheat the AWD system, only the front
wheels receive power. Stop until the system cools down.
Driving
358
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
1Real Time AWD with Intelligent Control SystemTM *
NOTICE
Do not continuously spin the front tires of your
vehicle. Continuously spinning the front tires can
cause transmission or rear differential damage.
The AWD system may not function properly if tire
type and size are mixed. Make sure to use the same
size and type of tire, and the air pressures as
specified.
2 Tire and Wheel Replacement P. 417
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 359 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
U.S. models only
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
1Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Instead of directly measuring the pressure in each tire, the TPMS on this vehicle
monitors and compares the rolling radius and rotational characteristics of each
wheel and tire while you are driving to determine if one or more tires are
significantly under-inflated. This will cause the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator to
come on.
The system does not monitor the tires when driving
at low speed.
■ TPMS Calibration
Tire pressure checked and inflated in:
• Warm weather can become under-inflated in
colder weather.
• Cold weather can become over-inflated in warmer
weather.
The low tire pressure/TPMS indicator will not come
on as a result of over inflation.
The TPMS may not function properly if tire type and
size are mixed. Make sure to use the same size and
type of tire.
2 Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 411
You must start TPMS calibration every time you:
• Adjust the pressure in one or more tires.
• Rotate the tires.
• Replace one or more tires.
2 Checking Tires P. 411
Driving
Before calibrating the TPMS:
• Set the cold tire pressure in all four tires.
Conditions such as low ambient temperature and
altitude change directly affect tire pressure and can
trigger the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator to come on.
The low tire pressure/TPMS indicator may come on
with a delay or may not come on at all when:
• You rapidly accelerate, decelerate, or turn the
steering wheel.
• You drive on snowy or slippery roads.
• Snow chains are used.
Make sure:
• The vehicle is at a complete stop.
• Manual transmission models
The shift lever is in (N .
• Continuously variable transmission models
The shift lever is in (P .
• All models
The ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
The low tire pressure/TPMS indicator may come on
under the following conditions:
• A compact spare tire is used.
• There is a heavier and uneven load on the tires than
the condition at calibration.
• Snow chains are used.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
359
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 360 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator
Press and hold the TPMS button until the low
tire pressure/TPMS indicator blinks twice,
indicating the calibration process has begun.
• If the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator does
not blink, confirm the above conditions
then press and hold the TPMS button again.
• The calibration process finishes
automatically.
1TPMS Calibration
• TPMS cannot be calibrated if a compact spare tire is
installed.
• The calibration process requires approximately 30
minutes of cumulative driving at speeds between
30-60 mph (48-97 km/h).
• During this period, if the ignition is turned on*1 and
the vehicle is not moved within 45 seconds, you
may notice the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator
comes on briefly. This is normal and indicates that
the calibration process is not yet complete.
TPMS Button
If the snow chains are installed, remove them before
calibrating the TPMS.
Driving
If the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator comes on even
when the properly inflated specified regular tires are
installed, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
We recommend that the tires be replaced with the
same brand, model, and size as the originals. Ask a
dealer for details.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
360
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 361 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required Federal Explanation
U.S. models
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required
Federal Explanation
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked
monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure
recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard
or tire inflation pressure label.
(If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated
on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should
determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with
a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low
tire pressure telltale
Driving
when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you
should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate
them to the proper pressure.
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to
overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s
handling and stopping ability.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
361
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 362 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required Federal Explanation
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire
maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain
correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the
level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction
indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly.
The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire
pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the
telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain
continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.
Driving
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may
not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended.
TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including
the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the
vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or
more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the
replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to
continue to function properly.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
362
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 363 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Braking
Brake System
■ Parking Brake
1Parking Brake
Use the parking brake to keep the vehicle stationary when parked. You can
manually apply and release, or automatically release it.
■ Manual operations
Use the electric parking brake switch to apply or release the brake. Manually
releasing the parking brake using the switch helps your vehicle start slowly and
smoothly when facing down hill on steep hills.
■ To apply manually
Pull the electric parking brake switch up gently
and securely.
u The electric parking brake indicator
comes on.
■ To release manually
1. Depress the brake pedal.
2. Press the electric parking brake switch.
u The electric parking brake indicator goes
off.
The brake pedal may slightly move due to the electric
parking brake system operation when you apply or
release the parking brake. This is normal.
You cannot apply or release the parking brake if the
battery goes dead.
2 Jump Starting P. 446
If you pull up the electric parking brake switch while
driving, the parking brake is applied.
In the following situations, the parking brake
automatically operates.
• When the vehicle stops with the automatic brake
hold system activated for more than 10 minutes.
Driving
Electric Parking
Brake Switch
You may hear the electric parking brake system
operating from the rear wheel area when you apply
or release the parking brake, or turn the ignition
switch to LOCK (0 *1. This is normal.
Electric Parking
Brake Switch
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
363
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 364 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBrakinguBrake System
■ To release automatically
1Parking Brake
Use the accelerator pedal to release the brake when you are starting the vehicle
facing uphill, or in a traffic jam.
Continuously variable transmission models
Depressing the accelerator pedal releases the parking brake.
Manual transmission models
Depressing the accelerator pedal while releasing the clutch pedal releases the
parking brake.
Continuously variable transmission models
Gently depress the accelerator pedal.
u The electric parking brake indicator goes
off.
The parking brake cannot be released automatically
while the following indicators are on:
• Malfunction indicator lamp
• Transmission indicator
The parking brake may not be released automatically
while the following indicators are on:
• Electric parking brake system indicator
• VSA® system indicator
• ABS indicator
• Supplemental restraint system indicator
Driving
Accelerator Pedal
Clutch Pedal
Manual transmission models
Gently depress the accelerator pedal and
release the clutch pedal.
u The electric parking brake indicator goes
off.
Accelerator Pedal
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
364
If the parking brake cannot be released
automatically, release it manually.
Manual transmission models
The clutch pedal is fully depressed before gently
depress the accelerator pedal and release the clutch
pedal.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 365 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBrakinguBrake System
You can release the parking brake automatically when:
• You are wearing the driver’s seat belt.
• The engine is running.
Continuously variable transmission models
• The transmission is not in (P or (N .
Manual transmission models
• The transmission is not in (N .
■ Foot Brake
1Foot Brake
Your vehicle is equipped with disc brakes at all four wheels. A vacuum power assist
helps to reduce the effort needed on the brake pedal. The brake assist system
increases the stopping force when you depress the brake pedal hard in an
emergency situation. The anti-lock brake system (ABS) helps you retain steering
control when braking very hard.
If you hear a continuous metallic friction sound when
applying the brakes, the brake pads need to be
replaced. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Driving
2 Brake Assist System P. 370
2 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) P. 369
Check the brakes after driving through deep water,
or if there is a buildup of road surface water. If
necessary, dry the brakes by lightly depressing the
pedal several times.
Constantly using the brake pedal while going down a
long hill builds up heat, which reduces the brake
effectiveness. Apply engine braking by taking your
foot off the accelerator pedal and downshifting to a
lower gear/speed position. With manual transmission
use a lower gear for greater engine braking.
Do not rest your foot on the brake pedal while
driving, as it will lightly apply the brakes and cause
them to lose effectiveness over time and reduce pad
life. It will also confuse drivers behind you.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
365
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 366 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBrakinguBrake System
■ Automatic Brake Hold
1Automatic Brake Hold
3 WARNING
Continuously variable transmission models
Keeps the brake applied after releasing the brake pedal until the accelerator pedal is
pressed. You can use this system while the vehicle is temporarily stopped, such as
when you stop at a traffic light.
■ Turning on the system
■ Activating the system
On
■ Canceling the system
On
On
On
Goes
Off
U.S.
Automatic Brake
Hold Button
Driving
Fasten your seat belt
properly, then start the
engine. Press the
automatic brake hold
button.
● The automatic brake
hold system indicator
comes on. The system
is turned on.
Brake Pedal
On
Canada
Depress the brake pedal
to come to a complete
stop. The shift lever must
be in other than (P or (R .
● The automatic brake
hold indicator comes
on. Braking is kept for
up to 10 minutes.
● Release the brake pedal
after the automatic
brake hold indicator
comes on.
Accelerator Pedal
Depress the accelerator
pedal while the shift
lever is in other than (P
or (N . The system is
canceled and the vehicle
starts to move.
● The automatic brake
hold indicator goes
off. The system
releases the brake
automatically.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
366
Activating the automatic brake hold system
on steep hills or slippery roads may still
allow the vehicle to move if you remove
your foot from the brake pedal.
If a vehicle unexpectedly moves, it may
cause a crash resulting in serious injury or
death.
Never activate the automatic brake hold
system or rely on it to keep a vehicle from
moving when stopped on a steep hill or
slippery roads.
3 WARNING
Using the automatic brake hold system to
park the vehicle may result in the vehicle
unexpectedly moving.
If a vehicle moves unexpectedly, it may
cause a crash, resulting in serious injury or
death.
Never leave the vehicle when braking is
temporarily kept by automatic brake hold
and always park the vehicle by putting the
transmission in (P and applying the parking
brake.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 367 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBrakinguBrake System
Manual transmission models
Keeps the brake applied after releasing the brake pedal until you change a gear to a
position other than (N and:
• Release the clutch pedal on a level road or when facing downhill.
• Release the clutch pedal and depress the accelerator pedal when facing uphill.
You can use this system while the vehicle is temporarily stopped, such as when you
stop at a traffic light.
■ Turning on the system
■ Activating the system
On
On
■ Canceling the system
Clutch Pedal
On
On
Goes
Off
U.S.
Automatic Brake
Hold Button
On
Canada
Depress the brake pedal
to come to a complete
stop.
● The automatic brake
hold indicator comes
on. Braking is kept for
up to 10 minutes.
● Release the brake pedal
after the automatic
brake hold indicator
comes on.
Accelerator Pedal
Shift into one of the
gears other than (N and:
● Release the clutch
pedal on a level road
or when facing
downhill.
● Release the clutch
pedal and depress the
accelerator pedal
when facing uphill.
The system is canceled
and the vehicle starts to
move.
● The automatic brake
hold indicator goes off.
The system releases the
brake automatically.
Driving
Fasten your seat belt
properly, then start the
engine. Press the
automatic brake hold
button.
● The automatic brake
hold system indicator
comes on. The system
is turned on.
Brake Pedal
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
367
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 368 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBrakinguBrake System
■ The system automatically cancels when:
1Automatic Brake Hold
• You engage the parking brake.
Continuously variable transmission models
• You depress the brake pedal and move the shift lever to (P or (R .
Under the following conditions, the system automatically cancels, and the parking
brake is applied:
• Braking is kept for more than 10 minutes.
• The driver’s seat belt is unfastened.
• The engine is turned off.
• There is a problem with automatic brake hold system.
While the system is activated, you can turn off the
engine or park the vehicle through the same
procedure as you normally do.
2 When Stopped P. 371
Whether the system is on, or the system is activated,
the automatic brake hold turns off once the engine is
off.
Manual transmission models
The system turns off if the engine stalls while
automatic brake hold is active or the system is on.
Manual transmission models
• The engine stalls.
Driving
■ Turning off the automatic brake hold system
Goes
Off
Automatic Brake
Hold Button
1Turning on the system
While the system is on, press the automatic
brake hold button again.
u The automatic brake hold system
indicator goes off.
If you want to turn off automatic brake hold
while the system is in operation, press the
automatic brake hold button with the brake
pedal depressed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
368
Make sure to turn off the automatic brake hold
system before using an automated car wash.
You may hear an operating noise if the vehicle moves
while the automatic brake hold system is in
operation. The system generates sound while holding
the vehicle and it moves.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 369 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBrakinguAnti-lock Brake System (ABS)
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
■ ABS
1Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
Helps prevent the wheels from locking up, and helps you retain steering control by
pumping the brakes rapidly, much faster than you.
The electronic brake distribution (EBD) system, which is part of the ABS, also
balances the front-to-rear braking distribution according to vehicle loading.
You should never pump the brake pedal. Let the ABS work for you by always
keeping firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. This is sometimes referred to as
“stomp and steer.”
When the vehicle speed goes under 6 mph (10 km/h), the ABS stops.
When the ABS indicator comes on while driving,
there may be a problem with the system.
While normal braking is not affected, there is a
possibility of the ABS not operating. Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer immediately.
The ABS does not reduce the time or distance it takes
to stop the vehicle. It only helps with steering control
during hard braking.
In the following cases, your vehicle may need more
stopping distance than a vehicle without the ABS:
• When driving on rough road surfaces, including
when driving on uneven surfaces, such as gravel or
snow.
• When tire chains are installed.
Driving
■ ABS operation
The brake pedal may pulsate slightly when the ABS is working. Keep holding the
pedal firmly down. On dry pavement, you will need to press on the brake pedal very
hard before the ABS activates. However, you may feel the ABS activate immediately
if you are trying to stop on snow or ice.
NOTICE
The ABS may not function correctly if you use an
incorrect tire type and size.
You may hear a motor sound coming from the
engine compartment while system checks are being
performed immediately after starting the engine or
while driving. This is normal.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
369
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 370 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBrakinguBrake Assist System
Brake Assist System
■ Brake Assist System
Designed to assist the driver by generating greater braking force when you depress
the brake pedal hard during emergency braking.
■ Brake assist system operation
Press the brake pedal firmly for more powerful braking.
When brake assist operates, the pedal may wiggle slightly and an operating noise
may be heard. This is normal. Keep holding the brake pedal firmly down.
Driving
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
370
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 371 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Parking Your Vehicle
When Stopped
1. Depress the brake pedal firmly.
2. With the brake pedal depressed, pull up the electric parking brake switch slowly,
but fully.
Continuously variable transmission models
1Parking Your Vehicle
Do not park your vehicle near flammable objects,
such as dry grass, oil, or timber.
Heat from the exhaust can cause a fire.
3. Move the shift lever from (D to (P .
1When Stopped
Manual transmission models
3. Move the shift lever to (R .
4. Turn off the engine.
u The electric parking brake indicator goes off in about 15 seconds.
Always confirm the electric parking brake is set, in particular if you are parked on an
incline.
NOTICE
Continuously variable transmission models
The following can damage the transmission:
• Depressing the accelerator and brake pedals
simultaneously.
• Holding the vehicle in place when facing uphill by
depressing the accelerator pedal.
• Moving the shift lever into (P before the vehicle
stops completely.
Driving
Raise the wiper arms when snow is expected.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
371
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 372 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Multi-View Rear Camera
Models with navigation system
1About Your Multi-View Rear Camera
See the Navigation System Manual.
The rear camera view is restricted. You cannot see
the corner ends of the bumper or what is underneath
the bumper. Its unique lens also makes objects
appear closer or farther than they actually are.
Models without navigation system
About Your Multi-View Rear Camera
The audio/information screen can display your vehicle’s rear view.
The display automatically changes to a rear view when the shift lever is moved to (R .
■ Multi-View Rear Camera Display Area
Guidelines
Wide View Mode
If the camera lens is covered with dirt or moisture,
use a soft, moist cloth to keep the lens clean and free
of debris.
Driving
Models with display audio system
Normal View Mode
Bumper
Camera
Tailgate Open Range
Approx. 39 inches (1 m)
Top Down View Mode
Approx. 79 inches (2 m)
Approx. 118 inches (3 m)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
372
Visually confirm that it is safe to drive before backing
up. Certain conditions (such as weather, lighting, and
high temperatures) may also restrict the rear view. Do
not rely on the rearview display which does not give
you all information about conditions at the back of
your vehicle.
You can change the Fixed Guideline and Dynamic
Guideline settings.
2 Customized Features P. 245
Fixed Guideline
On: Guidelines appear when you shift into (R .
Off: Guidelines do not appear.
Dynamic Guidelines
On: Guidelines move according to the steering wheel
direction.
Off: Guidelines do not move.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 373 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMulti-View Rear CamerauAbout Your Multi-View Rear Camera
You can view three different camera angles on the rearview display.
Models with color audio system
Press the LIST/SELECT (selector) knob to switch the angle.
Models with display audio system
Touch the appropriate icon to switch the angle.
: Wide view
: Normal view
: Top down view
All models
If the last used viewing mode is Wide or Normal, the same mode is selected the next
time you shift into (R . If Top View is last used before you turned off the engine,
Wide mode is selected next time you turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1 and shift
to (R .
Driving
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
373
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 374 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Refueling
Fuel Information
■ Fuel recommendation
1Fuel Information
Unleaded gasoline, pump octane number 87 or higher
NOTICE
Use of lower octane gasoline can cause a persistent, heavy metallic knocking noise
that can lead to engine damage.
■ Top tier detergent gasoline
Because the level of detergency and additives in gasoline vary in the market, Honda
endorses the use of “TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline” where available to help
maintain the performance and reliability of your vehicle. TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline meets a new gasoline standard jointly established by leading automotive
manufacturers to meet the needs of today’s advanced engines.
Driving
Qualifying gasoline retailers will, in most cases, identify their gasoline as having met
“TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline” standards at the retail location. This fuel is
guaranteed to contain the proper level of detergent additives and be free of metallic
additives. The proper level of detergent additives, and absence of harmful metallic
additives in gasoline, help avoid build-up of deposits in your engine and emission
control system.
For further important fuel-related information for your vehicle, or on information on
gasoline that does not contain MMT, visit www.hondacars.com. In Canada, visit
www.honda.ca for additional information on gasoline. For more information on top
tier gasoline, visit www.toptiergas.com.
■ Fuel tank capacity: 13.2 US gal (50 liters)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
374
We recommend quality gasoline containing
detergent additives that help prevent fuel system and
engine deposits. In addition, in order to maintain
good performance, fuel economy, and emissions
control, we strongly recommend the use of gasoline
that does NOT contain harmful manganese-based
fuel additives such as MMT, if such gasoline is
available.
Use of gasoline with these additives may adversely
affect performance, and cause the malfunction
indicator lamp on your instrument panel to come on.
If this happens, contact a dealer for service.
Some gasoline today is blended with oxygenates such
as ethanol. Your vehicle is designed to operate on
oxygenated gasoline containing up to 15% ethanol
by volume. Do not use gasoline containing methanol.
If you notice any undesirable operating symptoms, try
another service station or switch to another brand of
gasoline.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 375 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuRefuelinguHow to Refuel
How to Refuel
1. Stop your vehicle with the service station
pump on the left side of the vehicle in the
rear.
2. Turn off the engine.
3. Pull on the fuel fill door release handle
under the lower left corner of the
dashboard.
u The fuel fill door opens.
Fuel Fill Door
Release Handle
Pull
4. Remove the fuel fill cap slowly. If you hear a
release of air, wait until this stops, then turn
the knob slowly to open the fuel fill cap.
1How to Refuel
3 WARNING
Gasoline is highly flammable and explosive.
You can be burned or seriously injured
when handling fuel.
• Stop the engine, and keep heat, sparks,
and flame away.
• Handle fuel only outdoors.
• Wipe up spills immediately.
The filler nozzle automatically stops to leave space in
the fuel tank so that fuel does not overflow as a result
of changes in air temperature.
Cap
Holder
5. Place the fuel fill cap in the holder.
6. Insert the filler nozzle fully.
u When the tank is full, the fuel nozzle will
click off automatically. This leaves space
in the fuel tank in case the fuel expands
with a change in the temperature.
7. After filling, replace the fuel fill cap,
tightening it until you hear it click at least
once.
u Shut the fuel fill door by hand.
If the filler nozzle keeps turning off when the tank is
not full, there may be a problem with the pump’s fuel
vapor recovery system. Try filling at another pump. If
this does not fix the problem, consult a dealer.
Driving
Cap
Do not continue to add fuel after the nozzle has
automatically stopped. Additional fuel can exceed
the full tank capacity.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
375
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 376 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Fuel Economy
Improving Fuel Economy
Fuel economy depends on several conditions, including driving conditions, your
driving habits, the condition of your vehicle, and loading. Depending on these and
other conditions, you may or may not achieve the rated fuel economy of this vehicle.
■ Maintenance and Fuel Economy
You can optimize your fuel economy with proper maintenance of your vehicle.
Always maintain your vehicle in accordance with the messages displayed on the
information display.
• Use the recommended viscosity engine oil, displaying the API Certification Seal.
• Maintain the specified tire pressure.
• Do not load the vehicle with excess cargo.
• Keep your vehicle clean. A buildup of snow or mud on your vehicle’s underside
adds weight and increases wind resistance.
Driving
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
376
1Improving Fuel Economy
Direct calculation is the recommended method to
determine actual fuel consumed while driving.
Miles driven
Gallons of
fuel
Miles per
Gallon
100
Liter
Kilometers
L per 100 km
In Canada, posted fuel economy numbers are
established following a simulated test. For more
information on how this test is performed, please visit
http://oee.nrcan.gc.ca/
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 377 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Accessories and Modifications
Accessories
When installing accessories, check the following:
• Do not install accessories on the windshield. They can obstruct your view and
delay your reaction to driving conditions.
• Do not install accessories over areas marked SRS AIRBAG, on the sides or backs
of the front seats, on front or side pillars, or near the side windows.
Accessories installed in these areas may interfere with proper operation of the
vehicle’s airbags or may be propelled into you or another occupant if the airbags
deploy.
• Be sure electronic accessories do not overload electrical circuits or interfere with
proper operation of your vehicle.
2 Fuses P. 456
• Before installing any electronic accessory, have the installer contact a dealer for
assistance. If possible, have a dealer inspect the final installation.
Do not modify your vehicle or use non-Honda components that can affect its
handling, stability, and reliability.
3 WARNING
Improper accessories or modifications can
affect your vehicle’s handling, stability, and
performance, and cause a crash in which
you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding accessories and
modifications.
Honda Genuine accessories are recommended to
ensure proper operation on your vehicle.
Driving
Modifications
1Accessories and Modifications
Overall vehicle performance can be affected. Always make sure all equipment is
properly installed and maintained, and that it meets federal, state, province,
territory, and local regulations.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
377
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 378 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
378
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 379 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Maintenance
This chapter discusses basic maintenance.
Before Performing Maintenance
Inspection and Maintenance ............ 380
Safety When Performing Maintenance .... 381
Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance
Service ........................................... 382
Maintenance MinderTM ..................... 383
Maintenance Under the Hood
Engine Coolant ................................ 394
Transmission Fluid............................ 396
Brake Fluid....................................... 397
Refilling Window Washer Fluid......... 398
Replacing Light Bulbs ....................... 399
Maintenance Items Under the Hood..... 387
Checking and Maintaining Tires
Checking Tires ................................. 411
Tire and Loading Information Label .. 412
Tire Labeling .................................... 412
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)...... 414
Wear Indicators................................ 416
Opening the Hood ........................... 388
Recommended Engine Oil ................ 389
Oil Check ......................................... 390
Adding Engine Oil ............................ 391
Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter..... 392
* Not available on all models
Checking and Maintaining Wiper
Blades .......................................... 407
Tire Service Life................................ 416
Tire and Wheel Replacement ........... 417
Tire Rotation.................................... 418
Winter Tires ..................................... 419
Battery............................................... 420
Remote Transmitter Care
Replacing the Button Battery ........... 422
Heating and Cooling System */Climate
Control System * Maintenance....... 424
Cleaning
Interior Care .................................... 425
Exterior Care.................................... 427
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
379
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 380 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Before Performing Maintenance
Inspection and Maintenance
For your safety, perform all listed inspections and maintenance to keep your vehicle
in good condition. If you become aware of any abnormality (noise, smell, insufficient
brake fluid, oil residue on the ground, etc.), have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
(Note, however, that service at a dealer is not mandatory to keep your warranties in
effect.) Refer to the separate maintenance booklet for detailed maintenance and
inspection information.
■ Types of Inspection and Maintenance
■ Daily inspections
Perform inspections before long distance trips, when washing the vehicle, or when
refueling.
■ Periodic inspections
• Check the brake fluid level monthly.
2 Brake Fluid P. 397
• Check the tire pressure monthly. Examine the tread for wear and foreign objects.
2 Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 411
Maintenance
• Check the operation of the exterior lights monthly.
U.S. models
Maintenance, replacement, or repair of
emissions control devices and systems may be
done by any automotive repair establishment or
individuals using parts that are “certified” to
EPA standards.
According to state and federal regulations, failure to
perform maintenance on the maintenance main
items marked with # will not void your emissions
warranties. However, all maintenance services should
be performed in accordance with the intervals
indicated by the information display.
2 Maintenance Service Items P. 385
If you want to perform complex maintenance tasks
that require more skills and tools, you can purchase a
subscription to the Service Express website at
www.techinfo.honda.com.
2 Authorized Manuals P. 475
2 Replacing Light Bulbs P. 399
• Check the condition of the wiper blades at least every six months.
2 Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades P. 407
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
380
1Inspection and Maintenance
If you want to perform maintenance yourself, make
sure that you have the necessary tools and skills first.
After performing maintenance, update the records in
the separate maintenance booklet.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 381 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBefore Performing MaintenanceuSafety When Performing Maintenance
Safety When Performing Maintenance
Some of the most important safety precautions are given here.
However, we cannot warn you of every conceivable hazard that can arise in
performing maintenance. Only you can decide whether or not you should perform
a given task.
■ Maintenance Safety
• To reduce the possibility of fire or explosion, keep cigarettes, sparks, and flames
away from the battery and all fuel related parts.
• Never leave rags, towels, or other flammable objects under the hood.
u Heat from the engine and exhaust can ignite them causing a fire.
• To clean parts, use a commercially available degreaser or parts cleaner, not
gasoline.
• Wear eye protection and protective clothing when working with the battery or
compressed air.
• Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide, which is poisonous and can kill you.
u Only operate the engine if there is sufficient ventilation.
1Safety When Performing Maintenance
3 WARNING
Improperly maintaining this vehicle or
failing to correct a problem before driving
can cause a crash in which you can be
seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the inspection and
maintenance recommendations according
to the schedules in this owner’s manual.
3 WARNING
Failure to properly follow maintenance
instructions and precautions can cause you
to be seriously hurt or killed.
• The vehicle must be in a stationary condition.
u Make sure your vehicle is parked on level ground, the parking brake is set, and
the engine is off.
• Be aware that hot parts can burn you.
u Make sure to let the engine and exhaust system cool thoroughly before
touching vehicle parts.
• Be aware that moving parts can injure you.
u Do not start the engine unless instructed, and keep your hands and limbs away
from moving parts.
Maintenance
Always follow the procedures and
precautions in this owner’s manual.
■ Vehicle Safety
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
381
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 382 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBefore Performing MaintenanceuParts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
The use of Honda genuine parts and fluids is recommended when maintaining and
servicing your vehicle. Honda genuine parts are manufactured according to the
same high quality standards used in Honda vehicles.
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
382
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 383 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Maintenance MinderTM
If the engine oil life is less than 15%, you will see the Maintenance Minder messages
appear on the information display every time you turn the ignition switch to ON
(w *1. The messages notify you when to change the engine oil, or when to bring your
vehicle to a dealer for indicated maintenance services.
To Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Displaying the Engine Oil Life
1Displaying the Engine Oil Life
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Press the
(select/reset) knob repeatedly
until the engine oil life appears on the
information display.
The Maintenance Minder indicator (
) stays
on in the instrument panel after the engine oil
life becomes 0%. Have the indicated
maintenance done by a dealer immediately.
Based on the engine operating conditions, the
remaining engine oil life is calculated and displayed
as a percentage.
Calculated Engine Oil
Life (%)
100 to 91
90 to 81
80 to 71
70 to 61
60 to 51
50 to 41
40 to 31
30 to 21
20 to 16
15 to 11
10 to 6
5 to 1
0
Maintenance
Displayed Engine Oil
Life (%)
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
15
10
5
0
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
383
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 384 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Maintenance Minder Messages on the Information Display
To switch the display, press the
Oil Life Display
(select/reset) knob.
Explanation
Information
The engine oil life indicator starts
to appear along with other due
soon maintenance item codes
when the remaining oil life
becomes 15 percent.
The engine oil is approaching the
end of its service life.
The remaining engine oil life has
passed its service life, and a
negative distance appears after
driving over 10 miles (U.S. models)
or 10 km (Canadian models). The
negative distance on the display
blinks.
The engine oil life has passed.
The maintenance items must be
inspected and serviced
immediately.
Maintenance Minder Indicator
Starts to come on when the
remaining engine oil life becomes
15 percent.
It goes off when the display is
The SERVICE message also starts The engine oil has almost reached switched.
to appear along with the engine oil the end of its service life, and the
life indicator and the maintenance maintenance items should be
inspected and serviced as soon as
item codes.
possible.
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
384
Stays on as a reminder even when
the display is switched.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 385 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Maintenance Service Items
Maintenance
Minder Indicator
1Maintenance Service Items
• Independent of the Maintenance Minder
information, replace the brake fluid every 3 years.
Maintenance Minder Message
• Inspect idle speed every 160,000 miles (256,000
km).
Main Item
• Adjust the valves during services A, B, 1, 2, or 3 if
they are noisy.
Sub Items
CODE
A
B
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
*1: If a message SERVICE does not appear more than 12 months after the display is reset, change the
engine oil every year.
# : See information on maintenance and emissions warranty.
CODE
1
2
●
●
●
●
3
4
●
●
●
5
6
●
●
Maintenance Sub Items
Rotate tires
Replace air cleaner element*2
Replace dust and pollen filter*3
Inspect drive belt
Replace transmission fluid*4
Replace spark plugs
Inspect valve clearance
Replace engine coolant
Replace rear differential fluid *
Maintenance
●
Maintenance Main Items
Replace engine oil*1
Replace engine oil*1 and oil filter
Inspect front and rear brakes
Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and boots
Inspect suspension components
Inspect driveshaft boots
Inspect brake hoses and lines (Including ABS/VSA)
Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids
Inspect exhaust system#
Inspect fuel lines and connections#
*2: If you drive in dusty conditions, replace the air cleaner element every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
*3: If you drive primarily in urban areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air from industry and
from diesel-powered vehicles, replace the dust and pollen filter every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
Continuously variable transmission models only
*4: Driving in mountainous areas at very low vehicle speeds results in higher transmission temperatures.
This requires transmission fluid changes more frequently than recommended by the Maintenance
Minder. If you regularly drive your vehicle under these conditions, have the transmission fluid changed
every 25,000 miles (40,000 km).
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
385
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 386 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Resetting the Display
1Resetting the Display
Reset the engine oil life display if you have performed the maintenance service.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Display the engine oil life by repeatedly
pressing the
(select/reset) knob.
3. Press and hold the
knob for ten seconds
or more.
u The engine oil life indicator and the
maintenance item codes blink.
4. Press the
knob for five seconds or more.
u The displayed maintenance items
disappear, and the engine oil life display
returns to 100%.
Maintenance
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
386
NOTICE
Failure to reset the engine oil life after a maintenance
service results in the system showing incorrect
maintenance intervals, which can lead to serious
mechanical problems.
The dealer will reset the engine oil life display after
completing the required maintenance service. If
someone other than a dealer performs maintenance
service, reset the engine oil life display yourself.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 387 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Maintenance Under the Hood
Maintenance Items Under the Hood
Engine Oil Fill Cap
Brake Fluid
(Black Cap)
Engine Oil Dipstick
(Orange)
Battery
Washer Fluid
(Blue Cap)
Maintenance
Radiator Cap
Engine Coolant Reserve Tank
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
387
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 388 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduOpening the Hood
Opening the Hood
Hood Release Handle
1. Park the vehicle on a level surface, and set
the parking brake.
2. Pull the hood release handle under the
lower left corner of the dashboard.
u The hood will pop up slightly.
1Opening the Hood
NOTICE
Do not open the hood when the wiper arms are
raised.
The hood will strike the wipers, and may damage
either the hood or the wipers.
When closing the hood, check that the hood is
securely latched.
3. Pull up the hood latch lever in the center of
the hood to release the lock mechanism,
and open the hood.
Lever
Maintenance
Grip
Support Rod
Clamp
4. Remove the support rod from the clamp
using the grip. Mount the support rod in
the hood.
When closing, remove the support rod, and
stow it in the clamp, then gently lower the
hood. Remove your hand at a height of
approximately 12 inches (30 cm) and let the
hood close.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
388
If the hood latch lever moves stiffly, or if you can
open the hood without lifting the lever, the latch
mechanism should be cleaned and lubricated.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 389 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduRecommended Engine Oil
Recommended Engine Oil
• Genuine Honda Motor Oil
• Premium-grade 0W-20 detergent oil with an API Certification Seal on the
container.
Oil is a major contributor to your engine’s
performance and longevity. If you drive the
vehicle with insufficient or deteriorated oil,
the engine may fail or be damaged.
1Recommended Engine Oil
Engine Oil Additives
Your vehicle does not require oil additives. In fact,
they may adversely affect the engine performance
and durability.
This seal indicates the oil is energy conserving
and that it meets the American Petroleum
Institute’s latest requirements.
0W-20
Use a Genuine Honda Motor Oil or another
commercial engine oil of suitable viscosity for
the ambient temperature as shown.
Maintenance
Ambient Temperature
■ Synthetic oil
You may also use synthetic motor oil if it is labeled with the API Certification Seal
and is the specified viscosity grade.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
389
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 390 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduOil Check
Oil Check
We recommend that you check the engine oil level every time you refuel.
Park the vehicle on level ground.
Wait approximately three minutes after turning the engine off before you check the
oil.
1. Remove the dipstick (orange).
2. Wipe the dipstick with a clean cloth or
paper towel.
3. Insert the dipstick back all the way into its
hole.
4. Remove the dipstick again, and check the
level. It should be between the upper and
lower marks. Add oil if necessary.
Maintenance
Upper Mark
Lower Mark
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
390
1Oil Check
If the oil level is near or below the lower mark, slowly
add oil being careful not to overfill.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 391 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduAdding Engine Oil
Adding Engine Oil
1. Unscrew and remove the engine oil fill cap.
2. Add oil slowly.
3. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap, and tighten
it securely.
4. Wait for three minutes and recheck the
engine oil dipstick.
1Adding Engine Oil
If any oil spills, wipe it away immediately. Spilled oil
may damage the engine compartment components.
NOTICE
Do not fill the engine oil above the upper mark.
Overfilling the engine oil can result in leaks and
engine damage.
Engine Oil Fill Cap
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
391
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 392 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduChanging the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
You must change the engine oil and oil filter regularly in order to maintain the
engine’s lubrication. The engine may be damaged if they are not changed regularly.
Change the oil and filter in accordance with the Maintenance Minder message on
the information display.
1. Run the engine until it reaches normal
operating temperature, and then turn the
Under
engine off.
Cover
2. Open the hood and remove the engine oil
fill cap.
2WD models
3. Remove the bolts and clips on the
undercarriage and remove the under
cover.
Bolt
Maintenance
Clip
Washer
All models
4. Remove the drain bolt and washer from
the bottom of the engine, and drain the
oil into a suitable container.
Drain Bolt
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
392
1Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
NOTICE
You may damage the environment if you do not
dispose of the oil in a suitable way. If you are
changing the oil by yourself, appropriately dispose of
the used oil. Put the oil in a sealed container and take
it to a recycling center. Do not throw the oil away
into a garbage can or onto the ground.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 393 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduChanging the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
Oil Filter
1Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
You will need a special wrench to replace the oil
filter. You can buy this wrench from a dealer.
When installing the new oil filter, follow the
instructions supplied with the oil filter.
Reinstall the engine oil fill cap. Start the engine. The
low oil pressure indicator should go off within five
seconds. If it does not, turn off the engine, and check
your work.
Maintenance
5. Remove the oil filter and dispose of the
remaining oil.
6. Check that the filter gasket is not stuck to
the engine contact surface.
u If it is stuck, you must detach it.
7. Wipe away dirt and dust adhering to the
contact surface of the engine block, and
install a new oil filter.
u Apply a light coat of new engine oil to
the oil filter gasket.
8. Put a new washer on the drain bolt, then
reinstall the drain bolt.
u Tightening torque:
30 lbf∙ft (40 N∙m, 4.0 kgf∙m)
9. Pour the recommended engine oil into the
engine.
u Engine oil change capacity (including
filter):
3.9 US qt (3.7 L)
10. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap securely and
start the engine.
11. Run the engine for a few minutes, and
then check that there is no leak from the
drain bolt or oil filter.
12. Stop the engine, wait for three minutes,
and then check the oil level on the
dipstick.
u If necessary, add more engine oil.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
393
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 394 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduEngine Coolant
Engine Coolant
Specified coolant: Honda Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2
This coolant is premixed with 50% antifreeze and 50% water. Do not add any
straight antifreeze or water.
We recommend you check the engine coolant level every time you refuel. Check the
reserve tank first. If it is completely empty, also check the coolant level in the
radiator. Add the engine coolant accordingly.
■ Reserve Tank
1. Check the amount of coolant in the reserve
tank.
MAX
NOTICE
If Honda antifreeze/coolant is not available, you may
use another major brand non-silicate coolant as a
temporary replacement. Check that it is a high quality
coolant recommended for aluminum engines.
Continued use of any non-Honda coolant can result
in corrosion, causing the cooling system to
malfunction or fail. Have the cooling system flushed
and refilled with Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as
possible.
Do not add rust inhibitors or other additives to your
vehicle’s coolant system. They may not be compatible
with the coolant or with the engine components.
If temperatures consistently below -22°F (-30°C) are
expected, the coolant mixture should be changed to
a higher concentration. Consult a dealer for more
information.
MIN
Maintenance
Reserve Tank
2. If the coolant level is below the MIN mark,
add the specified coolant until it reaches
the MAX mark.
3. Inspect the cooling system for leaks.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
394
1Engine Coolant
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 395 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduEngine Coolant
■ Radiator
Radiator Cap
1Radiator
1. Make sure the engine and radiator are
cool.
2. Turn the radiator cap counterclockwise and
relieve any pressure in the cooling system.
Do not push the cap down when turning.
3. Push down and turn the radiator cap
counterclockwise to remove it.
4. The coolant level should be up to the base
of the filler neck. Add coolant if it is low.
5. Put the radiator cap back on, and tighten it
fully.
6. Pour coolant into the reserve tank until it
reaches the MAX mark. Put the cap back
on the reserve tank.
3 WARNING
Removing the radiator cap while the
engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray
out, seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine and radiator cool
down before removing the radiator cap.
NOTICE
Pour the fluid slowly and carefully so you do not spill
any. Clean up any spills immediately; they can
damage components in the engine compartment.
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
395
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 396 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduTransmission Fluid
Transmission Fluid
Continuously variable transmission models
■ Continuously Variable Transmission Fluid
1Continuously Variable Transmission Fluid
NOTICE
Specified fluid: Honda HCF-2 Transmission Fluid
Do not mix HCF-2 with other transmission fluids
Using a transmission fluid other than HCF-2 may
adversely affect the operation and durability of your
vehicle's transmission, and damage the transmission.
Any damage caused by using a transmission fluid that
is not equivalent to HCF-2 is not covered by Honda's
new vehicle warranty.
Have a dealer check the fluid level and replace if necessary.
Manual transmission models
■ Manual Transmission Fluid
1Manual Transmission Fluid
Specified fluid: Honda Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF)
Have a dealer check the fluid level and replace if necessary.
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
396
If Honda MTF is not available, you may use the API
certificated SAE 0W-20 or 5W-20 viscosity motor oil
as a temporary measure.
Replace with MTF as soon as possible. Motor oil does
not contain the proper additives for the transmission
and continued use can cause decreased shifting
performance and lead to transmission damage.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 397 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduBrake Fluid
Brake Fluid
1Brake Fluid
Specified fluid: Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3
NOTICE
■ Checking the Brake Fluid
The fluid level should be between the MIN
and MAX marks on the side of the reservoir.
Manual transmission models
MAX
MIN
The brake fluid reservoir is also used for your
vehicle’s clutch fluid. As long as you keep the
brake fluid level as instructed above, there is
no need for checking the clutch fluid level.
Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is not compatible with your
vehicle’s braking system and can cause extensive
damage.
If the specified brake fluid is not available, you should
use only DOT 3 or DOT 4 fluid from a sealed
container as a temporary replacement.
Using any non-Honda brake fluid can cause corrosion
and decrease the longevity of the system. Have the
brake system flushed and refilled with Honda Heavy
Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3 as soon as possible.
If the brake fluid level is at or below the MIN mark,
have a dealer inspect for leaks or worn brake pads as
soon as possible.
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
397
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 398 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduRefilling Window Washer Fluid
Refilling Window Washer Fluid
Models without washer level sensor
Window Washer Reservoir
Check the amount of window washer fluid by
looking at the reservoir.
If the level is low, fill the washer reservoir.
Canadian models
If the washer fluid is low, the washer level
indicator comes on.
Pour the washer fluid carefully. Do not overflow the reservoir.
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
398
1Refilling Window Washer Fluid
NOTICE
Do not use engine antifreeze or a vinegar/water
solution in the window washer reservoir.
Antifreeze can damage your vehicle’s paint. A
vinegar/water solution can damage the window
washer pump.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 399 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Replacing Light Bulbs
Headlight Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
1Headlight Bulbs
High/Low beam headlight: 60/55 W (HB2 for halogen bulb type)
■ High/Low Beam Headlight
Rubber Weather Seal
1. Remove the coupler.
2. Remove the rubber weather seal.
Hold-Down Wire
3. Remove the hold-down wire, then remove
the bulb.
4. Insert a new bulb.
5. Reinstall the hold-down wire. Hook the end
of the wire on the knob in the slot.
6. Reinstall the rubber weather seal.
7. Insert the coupler into the connector of the
bulb.
Maintenance
Slot
The headlight aim is set by the factory, and does not
need to be adjusted. However, if you regularly carry
heavy items in the cargo area, have the aiming
readjusted at a dealer or by a qualified technician.
When replacing a halogen bulb, handle it by its base,
and protect the glass from contact with your skin or
hard objects. If you touch the glass, clean it with
denatured alcohol and a clean cloth.
Coupler
Bulb
NOTICE
Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit.
Oil, perspiration, or a scratch on the glass can cause
the bulb to overheat and shatter.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
399
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 400 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuFront Turn Signal/Parking Light Bulbs
Front Turn Signal/Parking Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Front Turn Signal/Parking Light: 28/8 W (Amber)
1. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
2. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.
Bulb
Socket
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
400
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 401 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuFront Side Marker Light Bulbs
Front Side Marker Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Front Side Marker Light: 5 W
Bulb
1. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
2. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.
Socket
Fog Light Bulbs *
1Fog Light Bulbs *
NOTICE
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Fog Light: 35 W (H8 for halogen bulb type)
When replacing a halogen bulb, handle it by its
plastic case, and protect the glass from contact with
your skin or hard objects. If you touch the glass, clean
it with denatured alcohol and a clean cloth.
Maintenance
1. Remove the clip using a flat-tip screwdriver,
and push up the inner fender.
Inner Fender
Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit. Oil, perspiration,
or a scratch on the glass can cause the bulb to
overheat and shatter.
Clip
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
401
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 402 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuSide Turn Signal/Emergency Indicator Light Bulbs *
Driver side
Bulb
Tab
Coupler
2. Push the tab to remove the coupler.
3. Rotate the old bulb to the left on driver side
and to the right on passenger side to
remove.
4. Insert a new bulb into the fog light
assembly and turn it to the right on driver
side and to the left on passenger side.
5. Insert the coupler into the connector of the
bulb.
1Fog Light Bulbs *
Insert a flat-tip screwdriver, lift and remove the center
pin to remove the clip.
Passenger side
Bulb
Insert the clip with the center pin raised, and push
until it is flat.
Tab
Coupler
Maintenance
402
Side Turn Signal/Emergency Indicator Light Bulbs *
Door mirrors have the side turn lights. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and
replace the light assembly.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Push until the pin
is flat.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 403 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuRear Turn Signal Light Bulbs
Rear Turn Signal Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Rear Turn Signal Light: 21 W (Amber)
1. Use a Phillips-head screwdriver to remove
the bolts.
2. Pull the light assembly out of the rear pillar.
Bolt
Bulb
3. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
4. Remove the old bulb.
5. Insert a new bulb.
6. Slide the light assembly onto the guide on
the body.
Maintenance
Socket
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
403
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 404 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuBack-Up Light Bulbs
Back-Up Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Back-Up Light: 16 W
1. Remove the cover by prying on the edge
using a flat-tip screwdriver.
u Wrap the flat-tip screwdriver with a cloth
to prevent scratches.
Cover
2. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
3. Remove the old bulb.
4. Insert a new bulb.
Bulb
Maintenance
Socket
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
404
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 405 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuBrake/Tail/Rear Side Marker Light Bulbs
Brake/Tail/Rear Side Marker Light Bulbs
Brake/tail/rear side marker light bulbs are the LED type. Have an authorized Honda
dealer inspect and replace the light assembly.
High-Mount Brake Light Bulb
High-mount brake light bulb is a LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect
and replace the light assembly.
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
405
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 406 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuRear License Plate Light Bulbs
Rear License Plate Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Rear License Plate Light: 5 W
1. Push the lens on the left and pull out the
lens and the socket attached to it.
Lens
Bulb
2. Remove the license plate light assembly by
squeezing the tabs on both sides of the
socket.
3. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
406
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 407 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades
Checking Wiper Blades
If the wiper blade rubber has deteriorated, it will leave streaks and the hard surfaces
of the blade may scratch the window glass.
Changing the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
1Changing the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
1. Lift the driver side wiper arm first, then the
passenger side.
NOTICE
Avoid dropping the wiper arm; it may damage the
windshield.
2. Press and hold the tab, then slide the blade
from the wiper arm.
Maintenance
Lock Tab
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
407
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 408 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
3. Slide the wiper blade out from its holder by
pulling the tabbed end out.
Blade
Blade
Tab
4. Slide the new wiper blade onto the holder
from the bottom end.
u The tab on the blade should fit in the
indent of the top of the wiper holder.
5. Slide the wiper blade onto the wiper arm
securely.
6. Lower the passenger side wiper arm first,
then the driver side.
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
408
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 409 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
Changing the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
1. Raise the wiper arm off.
2. Pivot up the bottom end of the wiper blade
until it comes off from the wiper arm.
Wiper Arm
1Changing the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
NOTICE
Avoid dropping the wiper arm; it may damage the
rear window.
3. Slide the wiper blade out from the end with
the indent.
Blade
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
409
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 410 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
Retainers
Holder
4. Remove the retainers from the rubber blade
that has been removed, and mount to a
new rubber blade.
5. Slide the wiper blade onto the holder.
u Make sure it is engaged correctly, then
install the wiper blade assembly onto the
wiper arm.
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
410
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 411 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Checking and Maintaining Tires
Checking Tires
To safely operate your vehicle, your tires must be of the proper type and size, in
good condition with adequate tread, and properly inflated.
■ Inflation guidelines
Properly inflated tires provide the best combination of handling, tread life, and comfort.
Refer to the driver’s doorjamb label or specification’s page for the specified pressure.
Underinflated tires wear unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and
are more likely to fail from overheating.
Overinflated tires make your vehicle ride harshly, are more prone to road hazards,
and wear unevenly.
Every day before you drive, look at each of the tires. If one looks lower than the
others, check the pressure with a tire gauge.
■ Inspection guidelines
Every time you check inflation, also examine the tires and valve stems.
Look for:
• Bumps or bulges on the side or in the tread. Replace the tire if you find any cuts,
splits, or cracks in the side of the tire. Replace it if you see fabric or cord.
• Remove any foreign objects and inspect for air leaks.
• Uneven tread wear. Have a dealer check the wheel alignment.
• Excessive tread wear.
2 Wear Indicators P. 416
3 WARNING
Using tires that are excessively worn or
improperly inflated can cause a crash in
which you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding tire inflation and
maintenance.
Measure the air pressure when tires are cold. This
means the vehicle has been parked for at least three
hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km). If
necessary, add or release air until the specified
pressure is reached.
If checked when hot, tire pressure can be as much as
4–6 psi (30–40 kPa, 0.3–0.4 kgf/cm2) higher than if
checked when cold.
Have a dealer check the tires if you feel a consistent
vibration while driving. New tires and any that have
been removed and reinstalled should be properly
balanced.
Maintenance
At least once a month or before long trips, use a gauge to measure the pressure in
all tires, including the spare. Even tires in good condition can lose 1 to 2 psi (10 to
20 kPa, 0.1 to 0.2 kgf/cm2) per month.
1Checking Tires
U.S. models
Whenever tire pressure is adjusted, you must
calibrate the TPMS.
2 TPMS Calibration P. 359
• Cracks or other damage around valve stem.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
411
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 412 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire and Loading Information Label
Tire and Loading Information Label
The label attached to the driver’s doorjamb provides necessary tire and loading
information.
Label
Example
Tire Labeling
Example
The tire and loading information label attached to the
driver’s doorjamb contains:
a The number of people your vehicle can carry.
b The total weight your vehicle can carry. Do not
exceed this weight.
c The original tire sizes for front, rear, and spare.
d The proper cold tire pressure for front, rear, and
spare.
1Tire Sizes
Tire Size
Tire
Identification
Number (TIN)
The tires that came on your vehicle have a
number of markings. Those you should be
aware of are described below.
Maintenance
Maximum
Tire Load
Maximum
Tire Pressure
Tire Size
■ Tire Sizes
Whenever tires are replaced, they should be replaced with tires of the same size.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
412
1Tire and Loading Information Label
Following is an example of tire size with an
explanation of what each component means.
215/55R17 94V
215: Tire width in millimeters.
55: Aspect ratio (the tire’s section height as a
percentage of its width).
R: Tire construction code (R indicates radial).
17: Rim diameter in inches.
94: Load index (a numerical code associated with the
maximum load the tire can carry).
V: Speed symbol (an alphabetical code indicating the
maximum speed rating).
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 413 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire Labeling
■ Tire Identification Number (TIN)
1Tire Identification Number (TIN)
The tire identification number (TIN) is a group of numbers and letters that look like
the example in the side column. TIN is located on the sidewall of the tire.
■ Glossary of Tire Terminology
Year
Week
Maintenance
Cold Tire Pressure – The tire air pressure when the vehicle has been parked for at
least three hours or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km).
Load Rating – Means the maximum load that a tire is rated to carry for a given
inflation pressure.
Maximum Inflation Pressure – The maximum tire air pressure that the tire can
hold.
Maximum Load Rating – Means the load rating for a tire at the maximum
permissible inflation pressure for that tire.
Recommended Inflation Pressure – The cold tire inflation pressure recommended
by the manufacturer.
Treadwear Indicators (TWI) – Means the projections within the principal grooves
designed to give a visual indication of the degrees of wear of the tread.
DOT B97R FW6X 2209
DOT: This indicates that the tire meets all
requirements of the U.S. Department of
Transportation.
B97R: Manufacturer’s identification mark.
FW6X: Tire type code.
22 09: Date of manufacture.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
413
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 414 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuDOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
The tires on your vehicle meet all U.S. Federal Safety
Requirements. All tires are also graded for treadwear, traction,
and temperature performance according to Department of
Transportation (DOT) standards. The following explains these
gradings.
■ Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall
between tread shoulder and maximum section width.
Maintenance
■ Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear
rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a
specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150
would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on the
government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance
of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however,
and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in
driving habits, service practices and differences in road
characteristics and climate.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
414
1Uniform Tire Quality Grading
For example:
Treadwear 200
Traction AA
Temperature A
All passenger car tires must conform
to Federal Safety Requirements in
addition to these grades.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 415 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuDOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
■ Traction
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C.
Those grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement
as measured under controlled conditions on specified
government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked
C may have poor traction performance.
1Traction
■ Temperature
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C,
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its
ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions
on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high
temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and
reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire
failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which
all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle
Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels
of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum
required by law.
1Temperature
Warning: The traction grade
assigned to this tire is based on
straight-ahead braking traction tests,
and does not include acceleration,
cornering, hydroplaning, or peak
traction characteristics.
Warning: The temperature grade for
this tire is established for a tire that is
properly inflated and not
overloaded. Excessive speed,
underinflation, or excessive loading,
either separately or in combination,
can cause heat buildup and possible
tire failure.
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
415
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 416 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuWear Indicators
Wear Indicators
Example of a Wear
Indicator mark
The groove where the wear indicator is
located is 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) shallower than
elsewhere on the tire. If the tread has worn so
that the indicator is exposed, replace the tire.
Worn out tires have poor traction on wet
roads.
Tire Service Life
The life of your tires is dependent on many factors, including driving habits, road
conditions, vehicle loading, inflation pressure, maintenance history, speed, and
environmental conditions (even when the tires are not in use).
Maintenance
In addition to regular inspections and inflation pressure maintenance, it is
recommended that you have annual inspections performed once the tires reach five
years old. All tires, including the spare, should be removed from service after 10
years from the date of manufacture, regardless of their condition or state of wear.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
416
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 417 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire and Wheel Replacement
Tire and Wheel Replacement
Replace your tires with radials of the same size, load range, speed rating, and
maximum cold tire pressure rating (as shown on the tire’s sidewall). Using tires of a
different size or construction can cause the ABS, vehicle stability assist (VSA®)
system, hill start assist, and the AWD * system to work incorrectly.
It is best to replace all four tires at the same time. If that isn’t possible, replace the
front or rear tires in pairs.
Make sure that the wheel’s specifications match those of the original wheels.
1Tire and Wheel Replacement
3 WARNING
Installing improper tires on your vehicle can
affect handling and stability. This can cause
a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or
killed.
Always use the size and type of tires
recommended in this owner’s manual.
Maintenance
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
417
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 418 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire Rotation
Tire Rotation
Rotating tires according to the Maintenance Minder message on the information
display helps to distribute wear more evenly and increase tire life.
■ Tires without rotation marks
Rotate the tires as shown here.
Front
1Tire Rotation
Tires with directional tread patterns should only be
rotated front to back (not from one side to the other).
Directional tires should be mounted with the rotation
indication mark facing forward, as shown below.
Front
Direction Mark
■ Tires with rotation marks
Rotate the tires as shown here.
Maintenance
Front
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
418
U.S. models
Whenever tires are rotated, you must calibrate the
TPMS.
2 TPMS Calibration P. 359
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 419 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuChecking and Maintaining Tires uWinter Tires
Winter Tires
If driving on snowy or frozen roads, mount all season marked M+S tires, snow tires,
or tire chains; reduce speed; and maintain sufficient distance between vehicles when
driving.
Be particularly careful when operating the steering wheel or brakes to prevent
skidding.
1Winter Tires
3 WARNING
Using the wrong chains, or not properly
installing chains, can damage the brake
lines and cause a crash in which you can be
seriously injured or killed.
Use tire chains, snow tires, or all season tires when necessary or according to the law.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding the selection and use of
tire chains.
When mounting, refer to the following points.
For winter tires:
• Select the size and load ranges that are the same as the original tires.
• Mount the tires to all four wheels.
For tire chains:
• Install them on the front tires only.
• Because your vehicle has limited tire clearance, we strongly recommend using the
chains listed below:
• Follow the chain manufacturer’s instruction when installing. Mount them as
tightly as you can.
• Check that the chains do not touch the brake lines or suspension.
• Drive slowly.
When tire chains are mounted, follow the chain
manufacturer’s instructions regarding vehicle
operational limits.
If your vehicle is equipped with summer tires, be
aware that these tires are not designed for winter
driving conditions. For more information, contact a
dealer.
Maintenance
Cable-type: SCC Radial Chain SC1034
NOTICE
Traction devices that are the wrong size or improperly
installed can damage your vehicle’s brake lines,
suspension, body, and wheels. Stop driving if they are
hitting any part of the vehicle.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
419
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 420 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Battery
Checking the Battery
The battery condition is being monitored by the sensor on the negative terminal. If
there is a problem with the sensor, the warning message on the information display
will let you know. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
3 WARNING
The battery gives off explosive hydrogen
gas during normal operation.
Check the battery terminals for corrosion monthly.
A spark or flame can cause the battery to
explode with enough force to kill or
seriously hurt you.
If your vehicle’s battery is disconnected or goes dead:
• The audio system is disabled.
2 Audio System Theft Protection P. 179
• The clock resets.
When conducting any battery
maintenance, wear protective clothing and
a face shield, or have a skilled technician do
it.
2 Clock P. 94
• The navigation system * is disabled.
2 Refer to the navigation system manual
WARNING: Battery post, terminals,
and related accessories contain lead
and lead compounds.
Wash your hands after handling.
Maintenance
420
1Battery
When replacing the battery, the replacement must be
of the same specifications.
Consult a dealer for more information.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 421 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuBatteryuCharging the Battery
Charging the Battery
Disconnect both battery cables to prevent damaging your vehicle’s electrical system.
Always disconnect the negative (–) cable first, and reconnect it last.
1Battery
When you find corrosion, clean the battery terminals
by applying a baking powder and water solution.
Clean the terminals with a damp towel. Cloth/towel
dry the battery. Coat the terminals with grease to
help prevent future corrosion.
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
421
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 422 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Remote Transmitter Care
Replacing the Button Battery
If the indicator does not come on when the button is pressed, replace the battery.
NOTICE
■ Keys with Remote Transmitter *
Screw
Battery type: CR1620
1. Unscrew the cover with a small Phillipshead screwdriver.
2. Open the remote transmitter.
u Wrap the small flat-tip screwdriver with a
cloth to prevent scratching the
transmitter.
Battery
3. Remove the button battery with the small
flat-tip screwdriver.
4. Make sure to replace the battery with the
correct polarity.
Maintenance
422
* Not available on all models
1Replacing the Button Battery
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
An improperly disposed of battery can damage the
environment. Always confirm local regulations for
battery disposal.
Replacement batteries are commercially available or
at a dealer.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 423 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuRemote Transmitter CareuReplacing the Button Battery
■ Smart Entry Remote *
Battery type: CR2032
1. Remove the built-in key.
Battery
Maintenance
* Not available on all models
2. Remove the upper half of the cover by
carefully prying on the edge with a coin.
u Remove carefully to avoid losing the
buttons.
u Wrap a coin with a cloth to prevent
scratching the smart entry remote.
3. Make sure to replace the battery with the
correct polarity.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
423
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 424 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Heating and Cooling System */Climate Control System * Maintenance
Dust and Pollen Filter
The heating and cooling system */climate control system * is equipped with a dust
and pollen filter that collects pollen, dust, and other debris in the air. The
Maintenance MinderTM messages will let you know when to replace the filter.
We recommend that you replace the dust and pollen filter sooner when using your
vehicle in areas with high concentrations of dust.
Maintenance
424
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
1Dust and Pollen Filter
If the airflow from the heating and cooling system */
climate control system * deteriorates noticeably, and
the windows fog up easily, the filter may need to be
replaced. Please contact a dealer for replacement.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 425 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Cleaning
Interior Care
Use a damp cloth with a mixture of mild detergent and warm water to remove dirt.
Use a clean cloth to remove detergent residue.
■ Cleaning Seat Belts
Use a soft brush with a mixture of mild soap and warm water to clean the seat belts.
Let the belts air dry. Wipe the loop of the seat belt anchors using a clean cloth.
Loop
1Interior Care
Do not spill liquids inside the vehicle.
Electrical devices and systems may malfunction if
liquids are splashed on them.
Do not use silicone based sprays on electrical devices
such as audio devices and switches.
Doing so may cause the items to malfunction or a fire
inside the vehicle.
If a silicone based spray is inadvertently used on
electrical devices, consult a dealer.
Depending on their composition, chemicals and
liquid aromatics may cause discoloration, wrinkles,
and cracking to resin-based parts and textiles.
Do not use alkali solvents or organic solvents such as
benzene or gasoline.
■ Cleaning the Window
1Cleaning the Window
Wires are mounted to the inside of the rear window.
Wipe along the same direction as the wires with a
soft cloth so as not to damage them.
Wipe using a glass cleaner.
Maintenance
After using chemicals, make sure to gently wipe them
off using a dry cloth.
Do not place used cloths on top of resin based parts
or textiles for long periods of time without washing.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
425
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 426 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCleaninguInterior Care
■ Floor Mats
1Floor Mats
Unlock
Lock
The driver’s floor mat hooks over the floor
anchors, which keep the mat from sliding
forward. To remove a mat for cleaning, turn
the anchor knobs to the unlock position.
When reinstalling the mat after cleaning, turn
the knobs to the lock position.
Do not put additional floor mats on top of
the anchored mat.
■ Maintaining Genuine Leather *
Vacuum dirt and dust from the leather frequently. Pay close attention to the pleats
and seams. Clean the leather with a soft cloth dampened with a 90% water and
10% neutral soap solution. Then buff it with a clean, dry cloth. Remove any dust or
dirt on leather surfaces immediately.
Maintenance
426
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
If you use any floor mats that were not originally
provided with your vehicle, make sure they are
designed for your specific vehicle, fit correctly, and
are securely anchored by the floor anchors.
Position the rear seat floor mats properly. If they are
not properly positioned, the floor mats can interfere
with the front seat functions.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 427 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCleaninguExterior Care
Exterior Care
Dust off the vehicle body after you drive.
Regularly inspect your vehicle for scratches on painted surfaces. A scratch on a
painted surface can result in body rust. If you find a scratch, promptly repair it.
■ Washing the Vehicle
1Washing the Vehicle
Wash the vehicle regularly. Wash more frequently when driving in the following
conditions:
• If driving on roads with road salt.
• If driving in coastal areas.
• If tar, soot, bird droppings, insects, or tree sap are stuck to painted surfaces.
Do not spray water into the air intake vents.
It can cause a malfunction.
■ Using an Automated Car Wash
Fold in the door mirrors.
Make sure to follow the instructions indicated on the automated car wash.
Air Intake Vents
■ Using High Pressure Cleaners
Maintenance
• Keep sufficient distance between the cleaning nozzle and the vehicle body.
• Take particular care around the windows. Standing too close may cause water to
enter the vehicle interior.
• Do not spray high pressure water directly into the engine compartment. Instead,
use low pressure water and a mild detergent.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
427
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 428 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCleaninguExterior Care
■ Applying Wax
1Applying Wax
A good coat of automotive body wax helps protect your vehicle’s paint from the
elements. Wax will wear off over time and expose your vehicle’s paint to the
elements, so reapply as necessary.
■ Maintaining the Bumpers and Other Resin Coated Parts
If you get gasoline, oil, engine coolant, or battery fluid on resin coated parts, they
may be stained or the coating may peel. Promptly wipe it away using a soft cloth and
clean water.
■ Cleaning the Window
Wipe using a glass cleaner.
■ Maintaining Aluminum Wheels
Maintenance
Aluminum is susceptible to deterioration caused by salt and other road
contaminants. Use a sponge and mild detergent to wipe away promptly.
Be careful not to use harsh chemicals (including some commercial wheel cleaners) or
a stiff brush. They can damage the clear coat of the aluminum alloy wheels that
helps keep the aluminum from corroding and tarnishing.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
428
NOTICE
Chemical solvents and strong cleaners can damage
the paint, metal, and plastic on your vehicle. Wipe up
spills immediately.
1Maintaining the Bumpers and Other Resin Coated Parts
Ask a dealer about the correct coating material when
you want to repair the painted surface of the parts
made of resin.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 429 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCleaninguExterior Care
■ Fogged Exterior Light Lenses
The inside lenses of exterior lights (headlights, brake lights etc.) may fog temporarily
if you have driven in the rain, or after the vehicle has been run through a car wash.
Dew condensation also may build up inside the lenses when there is a significant
enough difference between the ambient and inside lens temperatures (similar to
vehicle windows fogging up in rainy conditions). These conditions are natural
processes, not structural design problems in the exterior lights.
Lens design characteristics may result in moisture developing on the light lens frame
surfaces. This also is not a malfunction.
However, if you see large amounts water accumulation, or large water drops
building up inside the lenses, have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
Maintenance
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
429
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 430 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
430
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 431 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Handling the Unexpected
This chapter explains how to handle unexpected troubles.
Tools
Types of Tools .................................. 432
If a Tire Goes Flat
Changing a Flat Tire ......................... 434
Engine Does Not Start
Checking the Engine ........................ 443
If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak....444
Emergency Engine Stop ................... 445
Jump Starting.................................... 446
Shift Lever Does Not Move .............. 448
Overheating
How to Handle Overheating............. 449
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking
If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes
On................................................ 451
If the Charging System Indicator Comes
On ................................................. 451
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes
On or Blinks..................................... 452
If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes
On......................................................453
If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System
Indicator Comes On ....................... 453
If the Electric Parking Brake System
Indicator Comes On ....................... 454
If the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator
Comes On or Blinks ....................... 455
Fuses
Fuse Locations ................................. 456
Inspecting and Changing Fuses........ 460
Emergency Towing........................... 461
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate.....462
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
431
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 432 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Tools
Types of Tools
1Types of Tools
2WD models
The tools are stored in the cargo area.
Jack
Tool Case
Handling the Unexpected
Wheel Nut Wrench/
Jack Handle
Detachable Towing Hook
Jack
Jack Handle Bar
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
432
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 433 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuToolsuTypes of Tools
AWD models
Storage Bag
Tool Case
Jack
Detachable Towing Hook
Jack
Handling the Unexpected
Wheel Nut Wrench/
Jack Handle
Jack Handle Bar
Storage Bag
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
433
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 434 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
If a Tire Goes Flat
Changing a Flat Tire
If a tire goes flat while driving, grasp the steering wheel firmly, and brake gradually
to reduce speed. Then, stop in a safe place. Replace the flat tire with a compact
spare tire. Go to a dealer as soon as possible to have the full-size tire repaired or
replaced.
1. Park the vehicle on firm, level, and non-slippery surface and apply the parking
brake.
Continuously variable transmission models
Periodically check the tire pressure of the compact
spare. It should be set to the specified pressure.
Specified Pressure: 60 psi (420 kPa, 4.2 kgf/cm2)
When driving with the compact spare tire, keep the
vehicle speed under 50 mph (80 km/h). Replace with
a full-size tire as soon as possible.
The compact spare tire and wheel in your vehicle are
specifically for this model. Do not use them with
another vehicle. Do not use another type of compact
spare tire or wheel with your vehicle.
2. Move the shift lever to (P .
Handling the Unexpected
Manual transmission models
2. Move the shift lever to (R .
All models
3. Turn on the hazard warning lights and turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
434
1Changing a Flat Tire
Do not mount tire chains on a compact spare tire.
If a chain-mounted front tire goes flat, remove one of
the full-size rear tires and replace it with the compact
spare tire. Remove the flat front tire and replace it
with the full-size tire that was removed from the rear.
Mount the tire chains on the front tire.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 435 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
■ Getting Ready to Replace the Flat Tire
1. Open the cargo area floor lid.
Floor Lid
2WD models
Spare Tire
Jack
Take the wheel nut wrench, jack handle bar
and jack out of the tool case.
AWD models
Take the wheel nut wrench and jack handle
bar out of the tool case.
Tool Case
AWD models
Spare Tire
All models
Handling the Unexpected
2. Take the tool case out of the cargo area.
2WD models
3. Unscrew the wing bolt, and remove the
spacer cone. Then, remove the spare tire.
Tool Case
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
435
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 436 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
AWD models
4. Turn the jack's end bracket anti-clockwise
to loosen it, then remove the jack.
Jack
All models
Handling the Unexpected
5. Place a wheel block or rock in front and rear
of the wheel diagonal to the flat tire.
The tire to be replaced.
Wheel
Blocks
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
436
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 437 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
6. Place the compact spare tire (wheel side up)
under the vehicle body, near the tire that
needs to be replaced.
Handling the Unexpected
7. Loosen each wheel nut about one turn
using the wheel nut wrench.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
437
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 438 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
■ How to Set Up the Jack
1How to Set Up the Jack
1. Place the jack under the jacking point
closest to the tire to be changed.
3 WARNING
The vehicle can easily roll off the jack,
seriously injuring anyone underneath.
Follow the directions for changing a tire
exactly, and never get under the vehicle
when it is supported only by the jack.
Handling the Unexpected
2. Turn the end bracket as shown in the image
until the top of the jack contacts the jacking
point.
u Make sure that the jacking point tab is
resting in the jack notch.
3. Raise the vehicle, using the jack handle bar
and the jack handle, until the tire is off the
ground.
Jack
Handle
Bar
Wheel Nut
Wrench as Jack Handle
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
438
Do not use the jack with people or luggage in the
vehicle.
Use the jack provided in your vehicle.
Other jacks may not support the weight (“load”) or
may not fit the jacking point.
The following instructions must be followed to use
the jack safely:
• Do not use while the engine is running.
• Use only where the ground is firm and level.
• Use only at the jacking points.
• Do not get in the vehicle while using the jack.
• Do not put anything on top of or underneath the
jack.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 439 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
■ Replacing the Flat Tire
1Replacing the Flat Tire
1. Remove the wheel nuts and flat tire.
Do not over tighten the wheel nuts by applying extra
torque using your foot or a pipe.
Wheel
Nut
Handling the Unexpected
2. Wipe the mounting surfaces of the wheel
with a clean cloth.
3. Mount the compact spare tire.
4. Screw the wheel nuts until they touch the
lips around the mounting holes, then stop
rotating.
5. Lower the vehicle and remove the jack.
Tighten the wheel nuts in the order
indicated in the image. Go around,
tightening the nuts, two to three times in
this order.
Wheel nut torque:
80 lbf∙ft (108 N∙m, 11 kgf∙m)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
439
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 440 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
2WD models
■ Storing the Flat Tire
Wing Bolt
Spacer
Cone
For full-size
tire
Handling the Unexpected
For compact
spare tire
1Storing the Flat Tire
1. Remove the center cap.
2. Place the flat tire face down in the spare tire
well.
3. Remove the spacer cone from the wing
bolt, flip it over, and insert it back on the
bolt. Secure the flat tire with the wing bolt.
4. Securely store the wheel nut wrench, jack
handle bar and jack back in the tool case.
Store the case in the cargo area under the
cargo floor lid.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
440
3 WARNING
Loose items can fly around the interior in a
crash and can seriously injure the
occupants.
Store the wheel, jack, and tools securely
before driving.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 441 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
AWD models
■ Storing the Flat Tire
1Storing the Flat Tire
1. Put the flat tire in the storage bag provided
with your vehicle.
u The storage bag is in the tool case.
2. Knot the top of the storage bag.
3. Store the jack in its holder. Turn the jack’s
end bracket to lock it in place.
4. Securely put the wheel nut wrench and jack
handle bar back in the tool case.
Belt
Rear Anchor
Loose items can fly around the interior in a
crash and can seriously injure the
occupants.
Store the wheel, jack, and tools securely
before driving.
Handling the Unexpected
5. Bore through the bag, and pass the holding
belt through the hole of the bag and the
wheel of the flat tire as shown.
3 WARNING
6. Place the flat tire in the cargo area, and
thread the belt through the rear anchor as
shown.
7. Pass the belt through the ring, and tighten
the belt to secure the flat tire in place.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
441
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 442 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
U.S. models
■ TPMS and the Spare Tire
If you replace a flat tire with the spare tire, the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator
comes on while you are driving. After driving for a few miles (kilometers), the
indicator will start blinking for a short time and then stay on, but this is normal.
Calibrate the TPMS when you replace the tire with a specified regular tire.
2 TPMS Calibration P. 359
Handling the Unexpected
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
442
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 443 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Engine Does Not Start
Checking the Engine
If the engine does not start, check the starter.
1Checking the Engine
If you must start the vehicle immediately, use an
assisting vehicle to jump start it.
2 Jump Starting P. 446
Checklist
Check the brightness of the interior lights.
Turn on the interior lights and check the brightness.
● If the interior lights are dim or do not come on at all
2 Battery P. 420
If the interior lights come on normally 2 Fuses P. 456
Review the engine start procedure.
Follow its instructions, and try to start the engine again. 2 Starting the Engine P. 325, P. 328
Check the immobilizer system indicator.
When the immobilizer system indicator is blinking, the engine cannot be started.
●
2 Immobilizer System P. 116
Check the fuel level.
There should be enough fuel in the tank. 2 Fuel Gauge P. 91
Check the fuse.
Check all fuses, or have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Handling the Unexpected
Starter condition
Starter doesn’t turn or turns
over slowly.
The battery may be dead. Check
each of the items on the right and
respond accordingly.
The starter turns over normally
but the engine doesn’t start.
There may be a problem with the
fuse. Check each of the items on
the right and respond accordingly.
2 Inspecting and Changing Fuses P. 460
If the problem continues:
2 Emergency Towing P. 461
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
443
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 444 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuEngine Does Not StartuIf the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
Models with smart entry system
If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
If the beeper sounds, the indicator on the ENGINE START/STOP button flashes,
and the engine won’t start.
Start the engine as follows.
Handling the Unexpected
1. Touch the center of the ENGINE START/
STOP button with the H logo on the smart
entry remote while the indicator on the
ENGINE START/STOP button is flashing.
The buttons on the smart entry remote
should be facing you.
u The indicator flashes for about 30
seconds.
ENGINE
START
STOP
2. Depress the brake pedal (continuously
variable transmission) or clutch pedal
(manual transmission) and press the
ENGINE START/STOP button within 10
seconds after the beeper sounds and the
indicator stays on.
u If you don’t depress the pedal, the mode
will change to ACCESSORY.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
444
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 445 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuEngine Does Not StartuEmergency Engine Stop
Models with smart entry system
Emergency Engine Stop
1Emergency Engine Stop
The ENGINE START/STOP button may be used to stop the engine due to an
emergency situation even while driving. If you must stop the engine, do either of the
following operations:
• Press and hold the ENGINE START/STOP button for about two seconds.
• Firmly press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice.
Continuously variable transmission models
The power mode is in ACCESSORY when the engine is stopped.
To change the mode to VEHICLE OFF, move the shift lever to (P after the vehicle
comes to a complete stop.
Canadian continuously variable transmission models
Then press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice without depressing the brake
pedal.
Handling the Unexpected
The steering wheel will not lock. However, because turning off the engine disables
the power assist the engine provides to the steering and braking systems, it will
require significantly more physical effort and time to steer and slow the vehicle. Use
both feet on the brake pedal to slow down the vehicle and stop immediately in a
safe place. With manual transmission models you can also downshift the
transmission to utilize engine braking.
Do not press the button while driving unless it is
absolutely necessary for the engine to be switched
off.
Manual transmission models
The power mode changes to VEHICLE OFF.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
445
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 446 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Jump Starting
■ Jump Starting Procedure
1Jump Starting
Turn off the power to electric devices, such as audio and lights. Turn off the engine,
then open the hood.
1. Connect the first jumper cable to your
vehicle’s battery + terminal.
u Remove the cover from the under-hood
fuse box.
2 Engine Compartment Fuse Box P. 456
Handling the Unexpected
Booster
Battery
2. Connect the other end of the first jumper
cable to the booster battery + terminal.
u Use a 12-volt booster battery only.
u Connect when using the automotive
battery charger to boost your 12-volt
battery, select a lower charging voltage
than 15-volt. Check the charger manual
for the proper setting.
3. Connect the second jumper cable to the
booster battery - terminal.
4. Connect the other end of the second
jumper cable to the stud bolt as shown. Do
not connect this jumper cable to any other
part.
5. If your vehicle is connected to another
vehicle, start the assisting vehicle’s engine
and increase its rpm slightly.
6. Attempt to start your vehicle’s engine. If it
turns over slowly, check that the jumper
cables have good metal-to-metal contact.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
446
3 WARNING
A battery can explode if you do not follow
the correct procedure, seriously injuring
anyone nearby.
Keep all sparks, open flames, and smoking
materials away from the battery.
Securely attach the jumper cables clips so that they
do not come off when the engine vibrates. Also be
careful not to tangle the jumper cables or allow the
cable ends to touch each other while attaching or
detaching the jumper cables.
Battery performance degrades in cold conditions and
may prevent the engine from starting.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 447 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuJump Startingu
■ What to Do After the Engine Starts
Once your vehicle’s engine has started, remove the jumper cables in the following
order.
1. Disconnect the jumper cable from your vehicle’s stud bolt.
2. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the booster battery terminal.
3. Disconnect the jumper cable from your vehicle’s battery + terminal.
4. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the booster battery +
terminal.
Handling the Unexpected
Have your vehicle inspected by a nearby service station or a dealer.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
447
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 448 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Shift Lever Does Not Move
Continuously variable transmission models
Follow the procedure below if you cannot move the shift lever out of the (P
position.
■ Releasing the Lock
1. Set the parking brake.
Models without smart entry system
2. Remove the key from the ignition switch.
Slot
Cover
Models with smart entry system
Handling the Unexpected
2. Remove the built-in key from the smart
entry remote.
All models
Shift Lock
Release Slot
3. Wrap a cloth around the tip of a small flattip screwdriver. Put it into the shift lock
release slot as shown in the image, and
remove the cover.
4. Insert the key into the shift lock release slot.
5. While pushing the key down, press the shift
lever release button and place the shift lever
into (N .
u The lock is now released. Have the shift
lever checked by a dealer as soon as
possible.
Release Button
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
448
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 449 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Overheating
How to Handle Overheating
Overheating symptoms are as follows:
• The high temperature indicator (red) comes on or the engine suddenly loses
power.
• Steam or spray comes out of the engine compartment.
3 WARNING
Steam and spray from an overheated
engine can seriously scald you.
Do not open the hood if steam is coming
out.
NOTICE
Continuing to drive with the high temperature
indicator on may damage the engine.
Handling the Unexpected
■ First thing to do
1. Immediately park the vehicle in a safe place.
2. Turn off all accessories and turn on the hazard warning lights.
u No steam or spray present: Keep the engine running and open the hood.
u Steam or spray is present: Turn off the engine and wait until it subsides.
Then open the hood.
1How to Handle Overheating
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
449
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 450 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuOverheatinguHow to Handle Overheating
■ Next thing to do
MAX
MIN
Reserve Tank
1How to Handle Overheating
Handling the Unexpected
1. Check that the cooling fan is operating and
stop the engine once the high temperature
indicator goes off.
u If the cooling fan is not operating,
immediately stop the engine.
2. Once the engine has cooled down, inspect
the coolant level and check the cooling
system components for leaks.
u If the coolant level in the reserve tank is
low, add coolant until it reaches the
MAX mark.
u If there is no coolant in the reserve tank,
check that the radiator is cool. Cover the
radiator cap with a heavy cloth and open
the cap. If necessary, add coolant up to
the base of the filler neck, and put the
cap back on.
■ Last thing to do
Once the engine has cooled sufficiently, restart it and check the high temperature
indicator.
If the high temperature indicator is off, resume driving. If it stays on, contact a dealer
for repairs.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
450
3 WARNING
Removing the radiator cap while the
engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray
out, seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine and radiator cool
down before removing the radiator cap.
If the coolant is leaking, contact a dealer for repairs.
Use water as an emergency/temporary measure only.
Have a dealer flush the system with proper antifreeze
as soon as possible.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 451 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking
If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
1If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On
Comes on when the engine oil pressure is low.
■ What to do as soon as the indicator comes on
1. Immediately park the vehicle on level ground in a safe place.
2. If necessary, turn the hazard warning lights on.
■ What to do after parking the vehicle
1. Stop the engine and let it sit for about three minutes.
2. Open the hood and check the oil level.
u Add oil as necessary.
NOTICE
Running the engine with low oil pressure can cause
serious mechanical damage almost immediately.
2 Oil Check P. 390
If the Charging System Indicator Comes On
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
Comes on when the battery is not being charged.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Turn off the heating and cooling system */climate control system *, rear
defogger, and other electrical systems, and immediately contact a dealer
for repairs.
* Not available on all models
1If the Charging System Indicator Comes On
If you need to stop temporarily, do not turn off the
engine. Restarting the engine may rapidly discharge
the battery.
Handling the Unexpected
3. Start the engine and check the low oil pressure indicator.
u The indicator goes off: Start driving again.
u The indicator does not go off within 10 seconds: Stop the engine
and contact a dealer for repairs immediately.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
451
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 452 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or
Blinks
Handling the Unexpected
■ Reasons for the indicator lamp to come on or blink
• Comes on when there is a problem with the engine emissions control
system, or the fuel fill cap is missing, or loose.
• Blinks when engine misfiring is detected.
■ What to do when the indicator lamp comes on
Avoid high speeds and immediately get your vehicle inspected at a
dealer.
■ What to do when the indicator lamp blinks
Park the vehicle in a safe place with no flammable items and wait at least
ten minutes or more with the engine stopped until it cools.
■ Check Fuel Cap Message
■ The message appears on when:
An evaporative system leak is detected. This may be caused by the fuel fill cap being
loose or not being installed.
■ What to do when the message appears:
1. Stop the engine.
2. Check if the fuel fill cap is fully installed.
u If not, loosen the cap, and then retighten it until it clicks at least once.
3. Drive for several days of normal driving.
u The message should go off.
■ When the malfunction indicator lamp comes on
The malfunction indicator lamp comes on if the system continues to detect a leak of
gasoline vapor. If this happens, follow the procedures described earlier to check the
fuel fill cap.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
452
1If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks
NOTICE
If you drive with the malfunction indicator lamp on,
the emissions control system and the engine could be
damaged.
If the malfunction indicator lamp blinks again when
restarting the engine, drive to the nearest dealer at
31 mph (50 km/h) or less. Have your vehicle
inspected.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 453 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
U.S.
Canada
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
1If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
• The brake fluid is low.
• There is a malfunction in the brake system.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on while driving
Press the brake pedal lightly to check pedal pressure.
• If normal, check the brake fluid level the next time you stop.
• If abnormal, take immediate action. If necessary, downshift the
transmission to slow the vehicle using engine braking.
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
• Comes on when there is a problem with the EPS system.
• If you depress the accelerator pedal repeatedly to increase the engine
speed while the engine is idling, the indicator comes on, and
sometimes the steering wheel becomes harder to operate.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Stop the vehicle in a safe place and restart the engine.
If the indicator comes on and stays on, immediately have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer.
If the brake system indicator and ABS indicator come
on simultaneously, the electronic brake distribution
system is not working. This can result in vehicle
instability under sudden braking.
Have your vehicle inspected by a dealer immediately.
Handling the Unexpected
If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System Indicator
Comes On
Have your vehicle repaired immediately.
It is dangerous to drive with low brake fluid. If there
is no resistance from the brake pedal, stop
immediately in a safe place. If necessary downshift
the gears.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
453
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 454 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Electric Parking Brake System Indicator Comes On
If the Electric Parking Brake System Indicator Comes
On
Handling the Unexpected
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
Comes on when there is a problem with the electric parking brake
system.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Avoid using the parking brake and immediately get your vehicle
inspected at a dealer.
■ What to do when the electric parking brake indicator comes on
or blinks at the same time.
• Release the parking brake. If you cannot release it, immediately stop
the vehicle in a safe place and call a dealer.
• If only the electric parking brake indicator goes off, immediately get
your vehicle inspected at a dealer.
• If the electric parking brake indicator remains on or blinks even after
releasing the parking brake, immediately stop the vehicle in a safe
place and call a dealer.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
454
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 455 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator Comes On or Blinks
U.S. models
If the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator Comes On or
Blinks
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on or blink
NOTICE
Driving on an extremely underinflated tire can cause
it to overheat. An overheated tire can fail. Always
inflate your tires to the prescribed level.
Handling the Unexpected
A tire pressure is significantly low, or the TPMS has not been calibrated.
If there is a problem with the TPMS or the compact spare tire is installed,
the indicator blinks for about one minute, and then stays on.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Drive carefully and avoid abrupt cornering and hard braking.
Stop your vehicle in a safe place. Check the tire pressure and adjust the
pressure to the specified level. The specified tire pressure is on a label on
the driver side doorjamb.
u Calibrate the TPMS after the tire pressure is adjusted.
■ What to do when the indicator blinks, then remains on
Have the tire inspected by a dealer as soon as possible. If the compact
spare tire causes the indicator to blink, change the tire to a full-size tire.
The indicator goes off after driving for a few miles (kilometers).
u Calibrate the TPMS after a full-size tire is reinstalled.
1If the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator Comes On or Blinks
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
455
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 456 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Fuses
Fuse Locations
If any electrical devices are not working,
turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1 and
check to see if any applicable fuse is blown.
■ Engine Compartment Fuse Box
■ Fuse box A
Handling the Unexpected
Located near the brake fluid reservoir. Push
the tabs to open the box.
Fuse locations are shown on the fuse box
cover. Locate the fuse in question by the
fuse number and box cover number.
Tab
456
* Not available on all models
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Circuit Protected
Headlight Low Beam Main
CDC *
Hazard
DBW
Wiper *
Stop
IGP
IG Coil
EOP *
INJ *
VST2 *
Main Fan
Starter SW *
MG Clutch
Battery Sensor
Small Light
AFP Main *
Horn
Fog Light *
SBW *
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Amps
20 A
(30 A)
10 A
15 A
(30 A)
10 A
15 A
15 A
(10 A)
(20 A)
(30 A)
30 A
(30 A)
7.5 A
(7.5 A)
10 A
(10 A)
10 A
(10 A)
(10 A)
Circuit Protected
21
Back Up Main
22
Audio
23
Sub Fan
24
VST1 *
25
STRLD *
26
IGP CAM *
27
–
28
–
29
Back Up *
30
IGP LAF
31
IGPS
32 Right Headlight Low Beam
33 Left Headlight Low Beam
Amps
10 A
(10 A)
(30 A)
(30 A)
(7.5 A)
(7.5 A)
–
–
(30 A)
(7.5 A)
(7.5 A)
10 A
10 A
*1:Models with the smart entry system have
an ENGINE START/STOP button
instead of an ignition switch.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 457 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Fuse box B
Pull up the cover on the + terminal, then
remove it while pulling out the tab as
shown.
Replacement of engine compartment fuses
should be done by a dealer.
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
a
b
c
d
Circuit Protected
Battery Main
RB Main 1
RB Main 2
CAP Main
Amps
100 A
70 A
80 A
70 A
Tab
Handling the Unexpected
a
b c
d
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
457
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 458 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Interior Fuse Boxes
■ Fuse box A
Fuse Label
Handling the Unexpected
458
Located behind the instrument panel.
Fuse locations are shown on the label under
the steering column.
Locate the fuse in question by the fuse
number and label number.
* Not available on all models
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Circuit Protected
Amps
Door Lock
20 A
–
–
Smart *
(10 A)
Driver Side Door Unlock
10 A
Passenger Side Door Unlock
10 A
Driver Door Unlock
10 A
Driver Door Lock
10 A
Driver’s Power Window
20 A
Passenger’s Power Window 20 A
Rear Left Power Window
20 A
Rear Right Power Window
20 A
Driver Side Door Lock
10 A
Passenger Side Door Lock
10 A
–
–
Right Headlight High Beam 10 A
STS *
(7.5 A)
Sunshade *
(20 A)
Moonroof *
(20 A)
Front Seat Heater *
(20 A)
–
–
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
Circuit Protected
MP Camera *
Washer
Rear Wiper *
A/C
Daytime Running Lights
Starter Cut *
ABS/VSA
SRS
Left Headlight High Beam
ACG
IG Relay
Fuel Pump
SRS
Meter
Mission SOL
Front ACC Socket
ACC
ACC *
Option
Rear Wiper
−
−
Amps
(10 A)
15 A
(10 A)
7.5 A
7.5 A
(7.5 A)
7.5 A
10 A
10 A
10 A
10 A
15 A
(7.5 A)
7.5 A
7.5 A
20 A
(7.5 A)
(7.5 A)
10 A
10 A
−
−
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 459 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Fuse box B
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
Circuit Protected
EPS
IG Main
1
Fuse Label
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12*1
12*2
13
14
15*1
15*2
Circuit Protected
–
–
ABS/VSA FSR
Deicer *
RR ACC SOCKET *
–
Interior Light
ACC Socket (Console)
−
−
ACC Key Lock
Heated Door Mirror *
A/C Blower SW *
–
Wiper
Amps
–
–
30 A
(10 A)
(20 A)
–
7.5 A
(20 A)
−
−
(7.5 A)
(10 A)
(7.5 A)
–
30 A
*1:Models with smart entry system
*2:Models without smart entry system
Cover
Handling the Unexpected
2
Fuse Box Main 2
ABS/VSA Motor
Fuse Box Main 1
Fuse Box Main 3
Rear Defogger
EPB L
IG Main2*1
–*2
HTR
EPB R
E-DPS
Amps
70 A
30 A*1
50 A*2
50 A
40 A
30 A
40 A
30 A
30 A
30 A
30 A
40 A
30 A
30 A
Remove the cover by putting the flat-tip
screwdriver into the side slot as shown.
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
459
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 460 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuFusesuInspecting and Changing Fuses
Inspecting and Changing Fuses
1. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1. Turn
headlights and all accessories off.
2. Check the fuses on the battery in the
engine compartment.
u If the fuse is blown, have it replaced by a
dealer.
Blown
Fuse Box on the Battery
Handling the Unexpected
3. Remove the fuse box cover.
4. Inspect the small fuses in the engine
compartment and the vehicle interior.
u If there is a burned out fuse, remove it
with the fuse puller and replace it with a
new one.
Fuse Puller
5. Check the large fuse in the vehicle interior.
u If the fuse is blown, use a Phillips-head
screwdriver to remove the screw and
replace it with a new one.
Combined Fuse
Blown Fuse
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
460
1Inspecting and Changing Fuses
NOTICE
Replacing a fuse with one that has a higher rating
greatly increases the chances of damaging the
electrical system.
Replace fuse with a new one of the same specified
amperage.
Confirm the specified amperage using the charts on
Fuse Locations.
There is a fuse puller on the back of the engine
compartment fuse box cover.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 461 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Emergency Towing
Call a professional towing service if you need to tow your vehicle.
1Emergency Towing
NOTICE
All models
Trying to lift or tow your vehicle by the bumpers will
cause serious damage. The bumpers are not designed
to support the vehicle’s weight.
■ Flat bed equipment
The operator loads your vehicle on the back of a truck.
This is the best way to transport your vehicle.
NOTICE
2WD models
Never tow your vehicle with just a rope or chain.
It is very dangerous since ropes or chains may shift
from side to side or break.
2WD models
Make sure the parking brake is released. If you
cannot release the parking brake, your vehicle must
be transported by the flat bed equipment.
2 Parking Brake P. 363
Handling the Unexpected
■ Wheel lift equipment
The tow truck uses two pivoting arms that go under the front tires and lift them off
the ground. The rear tires remain on the ground. This is an acceptable way to
tow your vehicle.
Improper towing such as towing behind a
motorhome or other motor vehicle can damage the
transmission.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
461
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 462 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate
■ What to Do When Unable to Open the Tailgate
If you cannot open the tailgate, use the following procedure.
1. Wrap a cloth around the flat-tip
screwdriver. Put it into the cover as shown
in the image, and open it.
Handling the Unexpected
Cover
2. Wrap a cloth around the flat-tip
screwdriver. Put it into the lid as shown in
the image, and open the lid.
Lid
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
462
1When You Cannot Open the Tailgate
After taking these steps, contact a dealer to have
your vehicle checked.
When you open the tailgate from inside, make sure
there is enough space around the tailgate, and it
does not hit anyone or any object.
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 463 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWhen You Cannot Open the Tailgateu
3. To open the tailgate, push the tailgate
while sliding the lever to the right.
Lever
Handling the Unexpected
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
463
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 464 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
464
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 465 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Information
This chapter includes your vehicle’s specifications, locations of identification numbers, and other
information required by regulation.
Specifications .................................... 466
Identification Numbers
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN),
Engine Number and Transmission
Number ......................................... 468
Devices that Emit Radio Waves ....... 469
Reporting Safety Defects ................. 470
Emissions Testing
Testing of Readiness Codes.............. 471
Warranty Coverages ........................ 473
Authorized Manuals......................... 475
Customer Service Information......... 476
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
465
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 466 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Specifications
■ Vehicle Specifications
■ Engine Specifications
Model
No. of Passengers:
Front
Rear
Total
Weights:
Gross Vehicle
Weight Rating
Gross Axle Weight
Rating (Front)
Gross Axle Weight
Rating (Rear)
Air Conditioning:
Refrigerant Type
Charge Quantity
Lubricant Type
Displacement
HR-V
Spark Plugs
2
3
5
109.8 cu-in (1,799 cm3)
NGK
DILZKR7B11GS
DENSO
DXU22HCR-D11S
■ Fuel
*1
4,001 lbs (1,815 kg)
4,166 lbs (1,890 kg)*2
2,127 lbs (965 kg)*1
2,178 lbs (988 kg)*2
1,873 lbs (850 kg)*1
1,988 lbs (902 kg)*2
Fuel:
Type
Fuel Tank Capacity
Unleaded gasoline, Pump octane number
of 87 or higher
13.2 US gal (50 ℓ)
■ Washer Fluid
Tank Capacity
U.S.: 2.6 US qt (2.5 ℓ)
Canada: 4.8 US qt (4.5 ℓ)
HFC-134a (R-134a)
14.3 - 16.0 oz (405 - 455 g)
ND-OIL8
*1: 2WD
*2: AWD
Information
466
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
■ Light Bulbs
Headlights (High/Low Beam)
Fog Lights *
Side Marker Lights
Front Turn Signal/Parking Lights
Brake/Tail/Side Marker Lights
Back-Up Lights
Rear Turn Signal Lights
High-Mount Brake Light
Side Turn Signal Lights *
Rear License Plate Lights
Interior Lights
Vanity Mirror Light *
Map Lights
Ceiling Light
Cargo Area Light
60/55W (HB2)
35W (H8)
5W
28/8W (Amber)
LED
16W
21W (Amber)
LED
LED
5W
1.8W
8W
8W
5W
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 467 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuSpecificationsu
■ Brake Fluid
Specified
■ Engine Oil
Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3
■ Continuously Variable Transmission
Fluid *
Specified
Capacity
Honda HCF-2 Transmission Fluid
3.7 US qt (3.5 ℓ)*1
Change
4.2 US qt (4.0 ℓ)*2
*1: 2WD
*2: AWD
Recommended
Capacity
■ Engine Coolant
Specified
Ratio
■ Manual Transmission Fluid *
Specified
Capacity
Honda Manual Transmission Fluid
Change
2.0 US qt (1.9 ℓ)
■ Rear Differential Fluid *
Specified
Capacity
Honda Dual Pump Fluid II
Change
1.318 US qt (1.247 ℓ)
■ Tire
·Genuine Honda Motor Oil 0W-20
·API Premium-grade 0W-20 detergent oil
Change
3.7 US qt (3.5 ℓ)
Change
including
3.9 US qt (3.7 ℓ)
filter
Capacity
Size
Front
Pressure
psi (kPa[kgf/cm2]) Rear
Size
Compact
Pressure
Spare
psi (kPa[kgf/cm2])
Regular
Wheel Size
Compact Spare
Regular
215/55R17 94V
32 (220 [2.2])
30 (210 [2.1])
T135/90D16 102M
60 (420 [4.2])
17 x 7 1/2J
16 x 4T
Honda Long-Life Antifreeze/Coolant Type2
50/50 with distilled water
1.39 US gal (5.25 ℓ)*1
(change including the remaining
0.13 US gal (0.5 ℓ) in the reserve tank)
1.38 US gal (5.24 ℓ)*2
(change including the remaining
0.13 US gal (0.5 ℓ) in the reserve tank)
*1: Continuously variable transmission models
*2: Manual transmission models
Information
* Not available on all models
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
467
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 468 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Identification Numbers
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), Engine Number
and Transmission Number
Your vehicle has a 17-digit vehicle identification number (VIN) used to register your
vehicle for warranty purposes, and for licensing and insuring your vehicle.
The locations of your vehicle's VIN, engine number and transmission number are
shown as follows.
Engine Number
1Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), Engine Number and
Transmission Number
The interior vehicle identification number (VIN) is
located under the cover.
Vehicle Identification Number
Cover
Information
Manual Transmission Number/
Continuously Variable Transmission
Number
Certification Label/
Vehicle Identification
Number
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
468
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 469 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Devices that Emit Radio Waves
The following products and systems on your vehicle emit radio waves when in
operation.
Audio System
Bluetooth® Audio
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Immobilizer System
Smart Entry System
Remote Transmitter
Each of the above complies with the appropriate requirements or the required
standards of FCC (Federal Communications Commission) and Industry Canada
Standard, described below:
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
Information
As required by the FCC:
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is
subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not
cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation.
This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-Gen/210/310.
Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference
that may cause undesired operation of the device.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
469
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 470 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Reporting Safety Defects
In the U.S.
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to
notifying American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists
in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved
in individual problems between you, your dealer, or American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-4249153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE.,
Washington, DC 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://
www.safercar.gov.
In Canada
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform Honda Canada Inc. and you may also inform Transport Canada.
Information
If Transport Canada receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety
defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may lead to a recall and remedy campaign. However, Transport Canada
cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Honda Canada Inc.
To contact Transport Canada’s Defect Investigations and Recalls Division, you may call 1-800-333-0510. For
more information on reporting safety defects or about motor vehicle safety, go to http://www.tc.gc.ca/
roadsafety.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
470
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 471 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Emissions Testing
Testing of Readiness Codes
Your vehicle has “Readiness Codes,” as part of the onboard self diagnostic system.
Some states use these codes as a test to see if your vehicle’s emissions components
are working properly.
The codes may not be read properly if testing is performed just after the battery has
gone dead or been disconnected.
To check if they are set, turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, without starting the
engine. The malfunction indicator lamp will come on for several seconds. If it then
goes off, the readiness codes are set. If it blinks five times, the readiness codes are
not set.
1Testing of Readiness Codes
The readiness codes are erased when the battery is
disconnected, and set again only after several days of
driving under a variety of conditions.
If a testing facility determines that the readiness
codes are not set, you may be requested to return at
a later date to complete the test.
If the testing facility determines the readiness codes
are still not set, see a dealer.
If you are required to have your vehicle tested before the readiness codes are ready,
prepare the vehicle for retesting by doing the following:
Information
1. Fill the gas tank to approximately 3/4 full.
2. Park the vehicle and leave the engine off for 6 hours or more.
3. Make sure the ambient temperature is between 40°F and 95°F (4°C and 35°C).
4. Start the engine without touching the accelerator pedal, and let it idle for 20
seconds.
5. Keep the vehicle in (P (continuously variable transmission) or (N (manual
transmission). Increase the engine speed to 2,000 rpm, and hold it there for about
three minutes.
6. Let the engine idle with your foot off the accelerator for 20 seconds.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
471
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 472 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuEmissions TestinguTesting of Readiness Codes
7. Select a nearby, lightly traveled major highway where you can maintain a speed
of 50 to 60 mph (80 to 97 km/h) for at least 20 minutes. Drive on the highway in
(D (continuously variable) or 5th (manual). Do not use cruise control. When
traffic allows, drive for 90 seconds without moving the accelerator pedal. (Vehicle
speed may vary slightly; this is okay.) If you cannot do this for a continuous 90
seconds because of traffic conditions, drive for at least 30 seconds, then repeat it
two more times (for a total of 90 seconds).
8. Drive in city/suburban traffic for at least 10 minutes. When traffic conditions
allow, let the vehicle coast for several seconds without using the accelerator pedal
or the brake pedal.
9. Park the vehicle and leave the engine off for 30 minutes.
Information
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
472
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 473 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Warranty Coverages
■ U.S. Owners
Your new vehicle is covered by these warranties:
New Vehicle Limited Warranty – covers your new vehicle, except for the
emissions control systems and accessories, against defects in materials and
workmanship.
Emissions Control Systems Defects Warranty and Emissions Performance
Warranty – these two warranties cover your vehicle’s emissions control systems.
Time, mileage, and coverage are conditional. Please read your warranty booklet for
exact information.
Seat Belt Limited Warranty – a seat belt that fails to function properly is covered
by a limited warranty. Please read your warranty booklet for details.
Rust Perforation Limited Warranty – all exterior body panels are covered for
rust-through from the inside for the specified time period with no mileage limit.
Information
Accessory Limited Warranty – Honda accessories are covered under this
warranty. Time and mileage limits depend on the type of accessory and other
factors. Please read your warranty booklet for details.
Replacement Parts Limited Warranty – covers all Honda replacement parts
against defects in materials and workmanship.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Continued
473
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 474 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuWarranty Coveragesu
Replacement Battery Limited Warranty – provides prorated coverage for a
replacement battery purchased from a dealer.
Replacement Muffler Lifetime Limited Warranty – provides coverage for as
long as the purchaser of the muffler owns the vehicle.
Restrictions and exclusions apply to all these warranties. Please read the Honda
warranty information booklet that came with your vehicle for precise information on
warranty coverages. Your vehicle’s original tires are covered by their manufacturer.
Tire warranty information is in a separate booklet.
■ Canadian Owners
Please refer to the warranty manual that came with your vehicle.
Information
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
474
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 475 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Authorized Manuals
■ Service Express
For electronic copies of service publications, you can purchase a subscription to
Service Express. Visit www.techinfo.honda.com for pricing and options.
■ For U.S. Owners:
Manuals be purchased from Helm Incorporated. You can order a manual by phone
at (800) 782-4356 (credit card orders only), or online at www.helminc.com.
■ For Canadian Owners:
Please contact a dealer to order any manuals that you may require.
Information
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
475
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 476 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Customer Service Information
Honda dealership personnel are trained professionals.
1Customer Service Information
They should be able to answer all your questions. If you encounter a problem that
your dealership does not solve to your satisfaction, please discuss it with the
dealership’s service manager or general manager. If you are dissatisfied with the
decision made by the dealership’s management, contact Honda Customer Services.
U.S. Owners:
American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
Honda Automobile Customer Services
Mail Stop 500-2N-7A
1919 Torrance Blvd.
Torrance, CA 90501-2746
Tel: (800) 999-1009
Canadian Owners:
Honda Canada Inc.
Customer Relations
180 Honda Boulevard
Markham, ON
L6C 0H9
Tel: 1-888-9-HONDA-9
Fax: 1-877-939-0909
E-mail:
[email protected]
Information
In Puerto Rico and the U.S. Virgin
Islands:
Bella International
P.O. Box 190816
San Juan, PR 00919-0816
Tel: (787) 620-7546
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
476
When you call or write, please give us the following
information:
• Vehicle Identification Number
2 Vehicle Identification Number (VIN),
Engine Number and Transmission
Number P. 468
• Date of purchase
• Odometer reading of your vehicle
• Your name, address, and telephone number
• A detailed description of the problem
• Name of the dealer who sold the vehicle to you
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 477 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
uuCustomer Service Informationu
■ Disclaimer of Pandora® *
Requirements to access Pandora®
• Latest version of the Pandora application
installed on your mobile device. (Visit the
Apple iTunes store or Google Play
Marketplace to download the latest
version.)
• Registered Pandora account (you can
create a free account at
www.pandora.com
or on your
smartphone)
• Connection to the internet via WiFi or
cellular data network.
• Android devices must be connected to
the vehicle via Bluetooth, iPhone devices
may be connected via Bluetooth or USB.
Information
* Not available on all models
Limitations
• Access to Pandora requires an active
internet connection
• Ability to access Pandora through this
system is subject to change without
notice
• Certain functionality of Pandora service is
not available when accessing the service
through this system including, but not
limited to, creating new stations, deleting
stations, emailing current stations,
buying songs, viewing additional text
information, logging in to Pandora, and
adjusting Cell Network Audio Quality.
Pandora internet radio is a music service
not affiliated with HONDA. More
information is available at http://
www.pandora.com
. Pandora, the
Pandora logo, and the Pandora trade
dress are trademarks or registered
trademarks of Pandora Media, Inc., used
with permission.
• Mobile access requires a smartphone
with an active data plan. Standard data
rates may apply.
• Pandora is only available in the United
States.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
477
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 478 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
Index
Index
Numbers
7-Speed Manual Shift Mode .................... 338
A
Index
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System)................... 369
Accessories and Modifications ................. 377
Accessory Power Sockets .......................... 156
Additives
Coolant ................................................... 394
Engine Oil................................................ 389
Washer.................................................... 398
Additives, Engine Oil ................................ 389
Adjusting
Armrest ................................................... 149
Front Seats .............................................. 140
Head Restraints........................................ 142
Headlights ............................................... 399
Mirrors .................................................... 138
Rear Seats................................................ 146
Steering Wheel ........................................ 137
Adjusting the Sound......................... 187, 209
Air Conditioning System
Climate Control System ........................... 165
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows ....................................... 164, 168
Dust and Pollen Filter ............................... 424
Heating and Cooling System.................... 161
Air Conditioning System (Climate Control
System)
Synchronized Mode ................................. 172
Air Conditioning System (Heating and
Cooling System)
Cooling ................................................... 164
Heating ................................................... 163
Air Pressure....................................... 412, 467
Airbags........................................................ 44
Advanced Airbags ..................................... 50
Airbag Care............................................... 56
Event Data Recorder.................................... 0
Front Airbags (SRS).................................... 47
Indicator.............................................. 54, 77
Passenger Airbag Off Indicator .................. 55
Sensors ..................................................... 44
Side Airbags .............................................. 51
Side Curtain Airbags.................................. 53
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) ............................ 358
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) .................. 369
Indicator.................................................... 77
Armrest ..................................................... 149
Audio Remote Controls ........................... 180
Audio System............................................ 176
Adjusting the Sound........................ 187, 209
Auxiliary Input Jack.................................. 178
Error Messages........................................ 231
General Information ................................ 235
HDMI® Port ............................................. 178
iPod ................................................ 194, 217
MP3/WMA/AAC.............................. 197, 222
Recommended CDs................................. 235
Recommended Devices............................ 237
Remote Controls ................................. 5, 180
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
478
Security Code ......................................... 179
Theft Protection ...................................... 179
USB Flash Drives...................................... 237
USB Port(s).............................................. 177
Audio/Information Screen ............... 183, 204
Authorized Manuals ................................ 475
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking ................ 109
Customize .............................................. 110
Automatic Brake Hold ............................. 366
Indicator ........................................... 74, 366
Automatic Brake Hold System
Indicator ........................................... 73, 366
Automatic Climate Control Sensors ........ 173
Auxiliary Input Jack ................................. 178
Average Fuel Economy .............................. 90
B
Battery ...................................................... 420
Charging System Indicator ................ 75, 451
Jump Starting ......................................... 446
Maintenance (Checking the Battery) ....... 420
Maintenance (Replacing)......................... 422
Belts (Seat).................................................. 35
Beverage Holders ..................................... 153
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®............. 260, 283
Booster Seats (For Children) ...................... 68
Brake System ............................................ 363
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) .................. 369
Automatic Brake Hold............................. 366
Brake Assist System................................. 370
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 479 ページ
2015年6月29日
Fluid ....................................................... 397
Foot Brake .............................................. 365
Indicator (Amber)...................................... 72
Indicator (Red) .................................. 72, 453
Parking Brake.......................................... 363
Brake System Indicator (Amber) ............... 72
Brake System Indicator (Red) .................... 72
Brightness Control (Instrument Panel) ... 134
Bulb Replacement.................................... 399
Back-Up Light ......................................... 404
Brake/Tail/Rear Side Marker Lights........... 405
Fog Lights ............................................... 401
Front Side Marker Lights ......................... 401
Front Turn Signal/Parking Lights .............. 400
Headlights .............................................. 399
High-Mount Brake Light.......................... 405
Rear License Plate Lights ......................... 406
Rear Turn Signal Lights............................ 403
Side Turn Signal, Emergency Indicator
Lights.................................................... 402
Bulb Specifications................................... 466
C
午前11時36分
Child Safety................................................. 57
Childproof Door Locks ............................. 108
Child Seat .................................................... 57
Booster Seats............................................. 68
Child Seat for Infants ................................. 59
Child Seat for Small Children ..................... 60
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat
Belt.......................................................... 64
Larger Children.......................................... 67
Rear-facing Child Seat ............................... 59
Selecting a Child Seat ................................ 61
Childproof Door Locks ............................. 108
Cleaning the Exterior ............................... 427
Cleaning the Interior ................................ 425
Climate Control System ............................ 165
Synchronized Mode ................................. 172
Clock ............................................................ 94
Coat Hook ................................................. 157
Compact Spare Tire .......................... 434, 467
Continuously Variable Transmission ....... 333
7-Speed Manual Shift Mode .................... 338
Creeping ................................................. 333
Fluid ........................................................ 396
Kickdown ................................................ 333
Operating the Shift Lever ........... 21, 335, 337
Shift Lever Does Not Move ...................... 448
Shifting ........................................... 334, 336
Controls ....................................................... 93
Coolant (Engine)....................................... 394
Adding to the Radiator ............................ 395
Adding to the Reserve Tank ..................... 394
High Temperature Indicator....................... 77
Low Temperature Indicator........................ 77
Overheating ............................................ 449
Creeping (Continuously Variable
Transmission) .......................................... 333
Cruise Control........................................... 344
Indicator.................................................... 82
Cup Holders .............................................. 153
Customer Service Information................. 476
D
Daytime Running Lights .......................... 131
Dead Battery............................................. 446
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows ......................................... 164, 168
Devices that Emit Radio Waves ............... 469
Dimming
Headlights............................................... 127
Rearview Mirror....................................... 138
Dipstick (Engine Oil)................................. 390
Directional Signals (Turn Signal) ............. 127
Display Setup .................................... 188, 210
Door Mirrors ............................................. 139
Doors........................................................... 96
Auto Door Locking .................................. 109
Auto Door Unlocking .............................. 109
Door and Tailgate Open Indicator........ 34, 78
Keys .......................................................... 96
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from
the Inside .............................................. 105
Index
Carbon Monoxide Gas ............................... 69
Cargo Floor Box ....................................... 155
Carrying Cargo ................................. 315, 317
CD Player .......................................... 191, 214
Certification Label ................................... 468
Changing Bulbs ........................................ 399
Charging System Indicator ................ 75, 451
月曜日
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
479
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 480 ページ
2015年6月29日
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from
the Outside.............................................. 99
Lockout Prevention System ...................... 104
DOT Tire Quality Grading ........................ 414
Driving....................................................... 313
Braking.................................................... 363
Continuously Variable Transmission ......... 333
Cruise Control ......................................... 344
Shifting Gear ........................... 334, 336, 340
Starting the Engine .......................... 325, 328
Dust and Pollen Filter ............................... 424
E
Index
ECO Assist System ......................................... 9
ECON Button............................................. 343
ECON Mode Indicator................................. 81
Electric Parking Brake
Indicator .................................................... 73
Electric Parking Brake System
Indicator ............................................ 73, 454
Electric Power Steering (EPS) System
Indicator ............................................ 78, 453
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) ............. 354
Emergency................................................. 461
Emissions Testing (Readiness Codes) ....... 471
Engine
Coolant ................................................... 394
Jump Starting .......................................... 446
Number ................................................... 468
Oil ........................................................... 389
月曜日
午前11時36分
Starting ........................................... 325, 328
Switch Buzzer.......................................... 122
Engine Coolant......................................... 394
Adding to the Radiator............................ 395
Adding to the Reserve Tank..................... 394
High Temperature Indicator....................... 77
Low Temperature Indicator........................ 77
Overheating ............................................ 449
Engine Oil ................................................. 389
Adding.................................................... 391
Checking................................................. 390
Displaying Oil Life.................................... 383
Low Oil Pressure Indicator ................. 75, 451
Recommended Engine Oil ....................... 389
Exhaust Gas Hazard (Carbon
Monoxide)................................................. 69
Exterior Care (Cleaning)........................... 427
Exterior Mirrors ........................................ 139
F
Features ....................................................
Filters
Dust and Pollen .......................................
Oil...........................................................
Flat Tire .....................................................
Floor Mats.................................................
Fluids
Brake ......................................................
Continuously Variable Transmission.........
Engine Coolant .......................................
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
480
175
424
392
434
426
397
396
394
Manual Transmission .............................. 396
Windshield Washer ................................. 398
FM/AM Radio ................................... 189, 211
Fog Light Indicator .................................... 80
Folding Down the Rear Seats .................. 147
Folding the Rear Seat Up ........................ 148
Foot Brake ................................................ 365
Forward Collision Warning (FCW) .......... 347
Indicator ................................................... 83
Front Airbags (SRS) .................................... 47
Front Seats................................................ 140
Adjusting ................................................ 140
Fuel ..................................................... 22, 374
Economy................................................. 376
Gauge ...................................................... 91
Low Fuel Indicator..................................... 76
Recommendation.................................... 374
Refueling .......................................... 22, 374
Fuel Economy ........................................... 376
Fuel Fill Cap ........................................ 22, 375
Message ................................................. 452
Fuel Fill Door ...................................... 22, 375
Fuses ......................................................... 456
Inspecting and Changing ........................ 460
Locations ................................................ 456
G
Gasoline (Fuel)
Economy................................................. 376
Gauge ...................................................... 91
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 481 ページ
2015年6月29日
Information............................................. 374
Low Fuel Indicator..................................... 76
Refueling ................................................ 374
Gauges........................................................ 88
Gear Shift Lever Positions
Continuously Variable
Transmission ................................. 334, 336
Manual Transmission .............................. 341
Glass (care) ....................................... 425, 428
Glove Box ................................................. 152
H
午前11時36分
Heating ................................................... 163
HFL (HandsFreeLink®) ....................... 260, 283
High Beam Indicator .................................. 80
Hill Start Assist System ..................... 327, 331
I
Identification Numbers ............................ 468
Engine and Transmission ......................... 468
Vehicle Identification ............................... 468
Ignition Switch.......................................... 122
Illumination Control ................................. 134
Knob ....................................................... 134
Immobilizer System .................................. 116
Indicator .................................................... 81
Important Handling Information .............. 32
Indicators .................................................... 72
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) .............................. 82
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) ..................... 77
Automatic Brake Hold ....................... 74, 366
Automatic Brake Hold System............ 73, 366
Brake Depressing ....................................... 74
Brake System (Amber) ............................... 72
Brake System (Red) ............................ 72, 453
Charging System ............................... 75, 451
CRUISE CONTROL.............................. 82, 345
CRUISE MAIN .................................... 82, 344
Door and Tailgate Open ...................... 34, 78
ECON Mode .............................................. 81
Electric Parking Brake ................................ 73
Electric Parking Brake System............. 73, 454
Electric Power Steering (EPS)
System ............................................ 78, 453
Fog Light................................................... 80
Forward Collision Warning (FCW).............. 83
High Beam ................................................ 80
High Temperature ..................................... 77
Immobilizer System ................................... 81
Lane Departure Warning (LDW)................. 84
Lights On .................................................. 80
Low Fuel ................................................... 76
Low Oil Pressure................................ 75, 451
Low Temperature ...................................... 77
Low Tire Pressure .............................. 79, 359
Maintenance MinderTM ...................... 82, 383
Malfunction Indicator Lamp............... 75, 452
Seat Belt Reminder .............................. 36, 76
Security System Alarm ............................... 82
Shift Lever Position .................................... 75
Smart Entry System ................................... 79
Starter System ........................................... 80
Supplemental Restraint System............ 54, 77
TPMS ........................................................ 79
Transmission ............................................. 76
Turn Signal................................................ 80
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®)
System ............................................ 78, 354
VSA® OFF .......................................... 78, 355
Washer Level............................................. 82
Information .............................................. 465
Information Display ................................... 89
Index
Halogen Bulbs .................................. 399, 401
Handling the Unexpected ....................... 431
HandsFreeLink® (HFL) ...................... 260, 283
Menus ............................................ 262, 286
Phone Setup ................................... 266, 291
Hazard Warning Button .............................. 4
Head Restraints ........................................ 142
Headlights ................................................ 127
Aiming.................................................... 399
Dimming......................................... 127, 131
Operating ............................................... 127
Heated Door Mirrors ............................... 135
Heated Windshield .................................. 136
Heating and Cooling System................... 161
Cooling................................................... 164
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows .............................................. 164
Dust and Pollen Filter .............................. 424
月曜日
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
481
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 482 ページ
2015年6月29日
Instrument Panel ........................................ 71
Brightness Control ................................... 134
Interior Lights ........................................... 150
Interior Rearview Mirror .......................... 138
Internet Radio................................... 220, 221
J
Jack (Wheel Nut Wrench)................. 432, 438
Jump Starting............................................ 446
K
Keyless Lockout Prevention ..................... 104
Keys ............................................................. 96
Lockout Prevention .................................. 104
Number Tag .............................................. 97
Rear Door Won’t Open ............................ 108
Remote Transmitter ................................... 99
Types and Functions .................................. 96
Won’t Turn................................................ 25
Kickdown (Continuously Variable
Transmission)........................................... 333
Index
L
Lane Departure Warning (LDW).............. 351
Indicator .................................................... 84
LaneWatchTM ............................................. 356
LATCH (Child Seats) .................................... 62
月曜日
午前11時36分
Lights................................................. 127, 399
Bulb Replacement ................................... 399
Daytime Running Lights........................... 131
Fog Lights ............................................... 130
High Beam Indicator.................................. 80
Interior .................................................... 150
Light Switches ......................................... 127
Lights On Indicator .................................... 80
Turn Signals ............................................ 127
Load Limits................................................ 317
Locking/Unlocking...................................... 96
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking.................. 109
Childproof Door Locks............................. 108
From Inside ............................................. 105
From Outside ............................................ 99
Keys .......................................................... 96
Lockout Prevention System...................... 104
Using a Key ............................................. 103
Lockout Prevention System ..................... 104
Low Battery Charge ................................. 451
Low Fuel Indicator...................................... 76
Low Oil Pressure Indicator ................. 75, 451
Lower Anchors............................................ 62
Lubricant Specifications Chart................. 467
Luggage (Maximum Load Limit) ............. 317
M
Maintenance............................................. 379
Battery .................................................... 420
Brake Fluid .............................................. 397
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
482
Cleaning ................................................. 425
Coolant .................................................. 394
Heating and Cooling System/Climate Control
System .................................................. 424
Maintenance MinderTM ............................ 383
Oil .......................................................... 390
Precautions ............................................. 381
Radiator.................................................. 395
Remote Transmitter ................................ 422
Replacing Light Bulbs .............................. 399
Safety ..................................................... 381
Service Items........................................... 385
Tires........................................................ 411
Transmission Fluid ................................... 396
Under the Hood...................................... 387
Malfunction Indicator Lamp ............. 75, 452
Manual Transmission ............................... 340
Reverse Lockout ...................................... 342
Map Lights................................................ 151
Maximum Load Limit............................... 317
Meters, Gauges .......................................... 88
Mirrors ...................................................... 138
Adjusting ................................................ 138
Door ....................................................... 139
Exterior ................................................... 139
Interior Rearview ..................................... 138
Modifications (and Accessories) .............. 377
Moonroof ................................................. 121
MP3................................... 191, 197, 214, 222
Multi-View Rear Camera ......................... 372
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 483 ページ
2015年6月29日
N
Numbers (Identification) ......................... 468
O
Odometer ................................................... 90
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines............. 323
Oil (Engine) .............................................. 389
Adding ................................................... 391
Checking ................................................ 390
Displaying Oil Life ................................... 383
Low Oil Pressure Indicator ................. 75, 451
Recommended Engine Oil ....................... 389
Viscosity.................................................. 389
Opening and Closing the Moonroof ...... 121
Opening/Closing
Hood ...................................................... 388
Moonroof ............................................... 121
Power Windows...................................... 119
Tailgate................................................... 113
Overheating ............................................. 449
P
午前11時36分
Passenger Airbag Off Indicator ................. 55
Passing Indicators ..................................... 127
Playing Bluetooth® Audio ................ 200, 225
Power Windows........................................ 119
Precautions While Driving ....................... 332
Driving Guidelines for Your Utility
Vehicle .................................................. 332
Rain......................................................... 332
Pregnant Women ....................................... 42
Puncture (Tire) .......................................... 434
R
Radiator .................................................... 395
Radio (FM/AM).................................. 189, 211
Radio Data System (RDS).................. 190, 212
RDS (Radio Data System).................. 190, 212
Readiness Codes (Emissions Testing) ....... 471
Real Time AWD with Intelligent Control
SystemTM .................................................. 358
Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror
Button ..................................................... 135
Rear Seats (Folding Down)....................... 147
Rearview Mirror........................................ 138
Refueling................................................... 374
Fuel Gauge ................................................ 91
Gasoline .......................................... 374, 466
Low Fuel Indicator ..................................... 76
Regulations ............................... 361, 414, 469
Remote Transmitter ................................... 99
Replacement
Battery .................................................... 422
Bulbs....................................................... 399
Fuses............................................... 456, 458
Tires ........................................................ 417
Wiper Blade Rubber ........................ 407, 409
Reporting Safety Defects ......................... 470
Resetting a Trip Meter ............................... 90
S
Safe Driving ................................................ 29
Safety Check ............................................... 34
Safety Labels............................................... 70
Safety Message............................................. 1
Seat Belts .................................................... 35
Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor.................. 40
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners ................. 37
Checking................................................... 43
Detachable Anchor.................................... 41
Fastening .................................................. 38
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat
Belt ......................................................... 64
Pregnant Women ...................................... 42
Reminder .................................................. 36
Warning Indicator ............................... 36, 76
Seat Heaters.............................................. 160
Seats .......................................................... 140
Adjusting ................................................ 140
Front Seats .............................................. 140
Rear Seats ............................................... 146
Index
Paddle Shifters (7-Speed Manual Shift
Mode) ....................................... 21, 338, 339
Pandora® .................................................. 221
Panic Mode............................................... 118
Parking ..................................................... 371
Parking Brake........................................... 363
月曜日
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
483
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 484 ページ
2015年6月29日
Index
Security System ......................................... 116
Immobilizer System Indicator ..................... 81
Security System Alarm Indicator ................. 82
Select Lever ................................. 21, 334, 340
Operation .......................... 21, 335, 336, 337
Releasing ................................................. 448
Won’t Move ............................................ 448
Select/Reset Knob ....................................... 89
Selecting a Child Seat ................................. 61
Selector Knob (Audio) .............................. 182
Setting the Clock ........................................ 94
Shift Lever ........................... 21, 334, 336, 340
Shift Lever Position Indicator..... 75, 335, 337
Shifting (Transmission) ............. 334, 336, 340
Shoulder Anchor......................................... 40
Side Airbags ................................................ 51
Side Curtain Airbags................................... 53
Siri Eyes Free ............................................. 230
Snow Tires ................................................. 419
Spare Tire .......................................... 434, 467
Spark Plugs................................................ 466
Specifications ............................................ 466
Specified Fuel.................................... 374, 466
Speedometer............................................... 88
SRS Airbags (Airbags) ................................. 47
Starter System Indicator ............................. 80
Starting the Engine .......................... 325, 328
Does Not Start ......................................... 443
Engine Switch Buzzer............................... 122
Jump Starting .......................................... 446
月曜日
午前11時36分
Steering Wheel......................................... 137
Adjusting ................................................ 137
Stopping ................................................... 371
Summer Tires ............................................ 419
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)........ 47
Switches (Around the Steering
Wheel)............................................. 4, 5, 122
T
Tachometer................................................. 88
Tailgate ..................................................... 113
Unable to Open....................................... 462
Temperature
High Temperature Indicator....................... 77
Low Temperature Indicator........................ 77
Tie-down Hooks ....................................... 158
Time (Setting) ............................................. 94
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) ..................................................... 359
Indicator.................................................... 79
Tires........................................................... 411
Air Pressure ..................................... 412, 467
Checking and Maintaining ...................... 411
Inspection ............................................... 411
Labeling .................................................. 412
Puncture (Flat Tire) .................................. 434
Regulations ............................................. 414
Rotation .................................................. 418
Spare Tire........................................ 434, 467
Summer .................................................. 419
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
484
Tire Chains.............................................. 419
Wear Indicators....................................... 416
Winter .................................................... 419
Tonneau Cover......................................... 159
Tools ......................................................... 432
Towing a Trailer....................................... 319
Towing Your Vehicle ............................... 320
Emergency.............................................. 461
TPMS (Tire Pressure Monitoring
System).................................................... 359
Indicator ................................................... 79
Transmission............................. 334, 336, 340
7-Speed Manual Shift Mode ................... 338
Continuously Variable ............................. 333
Fluid ....................................................... 396
Manual ................................................... 340
Number .................................................. 468
Shift Lever Position Indicator ..... 75, 335, 337
Trip Meter .................................................. 90
Troubleshooting ...................................... 431
Blown Fuse ..................................... 456, 458
Brake Pedal Vibrates ................................. 25
Buzzer Sounds When Opening Door ......... 26
Emergency Towing ................................. 461
Engine Won’t Start ................................. 443
Noise When Braking ................................. 26
Overheating............................................ 449
Puncture/Flat Tire .................................... 434
Rear Door Won’t Open ..................... 26, 108
Shift Lever Won’t Move .......................... 448
Warning Indicators.................................... 72
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 485 ページ
2015年6月29日
Turn Signals.............................................. 127
Indicators (Instrument Panel) ..................... 80
U
Unlocking the Doors.......................... 99, 105
USB Flash Drives ....................................... 237
USB Port(s)................................................ 177
V
Vanity Mirrors .............................................. 7
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) ...... 468
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®) ................. 354
Off Button .............................................. 355
Off Indicator ............................................. 78
System Indicator ....................................... 78
Viscosity (Oil).................................... 389, 467
VSA® (Vehicle Stability Assist) ................. 354
月曜日
午前11時36分
Window Washers...................................... 132
Adding/Refilling Fluid............................... 398
Switch ..................................................... 132
Windshield ................................................ 132
Cleaning.......................................... 425, 428
Defrosting/Defogging .............. 136, 164, 168
Washer Fluid ........................................... 398
Wiper Blades ........................................... 407
Wipers and Washers ................................ 132
Winter Tires .............................................. 419
Snow Tires............................................... 419
Tire Chains .............................................. 419
Wipers and Washers ................................. 132
Checking and Replacing Wiper
Blades............................................ 407, 409
WMA ................................. 191, 197, 214, 222
Worn Tires......................................... 411, 416
W
Index
Wallpaper......................................... 185, 207
Warning Indicator On/Blinking............... 451
Warning Labels .......................................... 70
Warranties (Warranty Manual provided
separately) .............................................. 473
Watts ........................................................ 466
Wear Indicators (Tire) .............................. 416
Wheel Nut Wrench (Jack Handle)... 432, 438
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
485
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 486 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 487 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
15 HR-V GAS-31T7A6000.book 488 ページ
2015年6月29日
月曜日
午前11時36分
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby: